1 //===- CodeGenPrepare.cpp - Prepare a function for code generation --------===//
2 //
3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions.
4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information.
5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception
6 //
7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8 //
9 // This pass munges the code in the input function to better prepare it for
10 // SelectionDAG-based code generation. This works around limitations in it's
11 // basic-block-at-a-time approach. It should eventually be removed.
12 //
13 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
14
15 #include "llvm/CodeGen/CodeGenPrepare.h"
16 #include "llvm/ADT/APInt.h"
17 #include "llvm/ADT/ArrayRef.h"
18 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
19 #include "llvm/ADT/MapVector.h"
20 #include "llvm/ADT/PointerIntPair.h"
21 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
22 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
23 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
24 #include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
25 #include "llvm/Analysis/BlockFrequencyInfo.h"
26 #include "llvm/Analysis/BranchProbabilityInfo.h"
27 #include "llvm/Analysis/FloatingPointPredicateUtils.h"
28 #include "llvm/Analysis/InstructionSimplify.h"
29 #include "llvm/Analysis/LoopInfo.h"
30 #include "llvm/Analysis/ProfileSummaryInfo.h"
31 #include "llvm/Analysis/ScalarEvolutionExpressions.h"
32 #include "llvm/Analysis/TargetLibraryInfo.h"
33 #include "llvm/Analysis/TargetTransformInfo.h"
34 #include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
35 #include "llvm/Analysis/VectorUtils.h"
36 #include "llvm/CodeGen/Analysis.h"
37 #include "llvm/CodeGen/BasicBlockSectionsProfileReader.h"
38 #include "llvm/CodeGen/ISDOpcodes.h"
39 #include "llvm/CodeGen/SelectionDAGNodes.h"
40 #include "llvm/CodeGen/TargetLowering.h"
41 #include "llvm/CodeGen/TargetPassConfig.h"
42 #include "llvm/CodeGen/TargetSubtargetInfo.h"
43 #include "llvm/CodeGen/ValueTypes.h"
44 #include "llvm/CodeGenTypes/MachineValueType.h"
45 #include "llvm/Config/llvm-config.h"
46 #include "llvm/IR/Argument.h"
47 #include "llvm/IR/Attributes.h"
48 #include "llvm/IR/BasicBlock.h"
49 #include "llvm/IR/Constant.h"
50 #include "llvm/IR/Constants.h"
51 #include "llvm/IR/DataLayout.h"
52 #include "llvm/IR/DebugInfo.h"
53 #include "llvm/IR/DerivedTypes.h"
54 #include "llvm/IR/Dominators.h"
55 #include "llvm/IR/Function.h"
56 #include "llvm/IR/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
57 #include "llvm/IR/GlobalValue.h"
58 #include "llvm/IR/GlobalVariable.h"
59 #include "llvm/IR/IRBuilder.h"
60 #include "llvm/IR/InlineAsm.h"
61 #include "llvm/IR/InstrTypes.h"
62 #include "llvm/IR/Instruction.h"
63 #include "llvm/IR/Instructions.h"
64 #include "llvm/IR/IntrinsicInst.h"
65 #include "llvm/IR/Intrinsics.h"
66 #include "llvm/IR/IntrinsicsAArch64.h"
67 #include "llvm/IR/LLVMContext.h"
68 #include "llvm/IR/MDBuilder.h"
69 #include "llvm/IR/Module.h"
70 #include "llvm/IR/Operator.h"
71 #include "llvm/IR/PatternMatch.h"
72 #include "llvm/IR/ProfDataUtils.h"
73 #include "llvm/IR/Statepoint.h"
74 #include "llvm/IR/Type.h"
75 #include "llvm/IR/Use.h"
76 #include "llvm/IR/User.h"
77 #include "llvm/IR/Value.h"
78 #include "llvm/IR/ValueHandle.h"
79 #include "llvm/IR/ValueMap.h"
80 #include "llvm/InitializePasses.h"
81 #include "llvm/Pass.h"
82 #include "llvm/Support/BlockFrequency.h"
83 #include "llvm/Support/BranchProbability.h"
84 #include "llvm/Support/Casting.h"
85 #include "llvm/Support/CommandLine.h"
86 #include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
87 #include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
88 #include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h"
89 #include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
90 #include "llvm/Target/TargetMachine.h"
91 #include "llvm/Target/TargetOptions.h"
92 #include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
93 #include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BypassSlowDivision.h"
94 #include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
95 #include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/SimplifyLibCalls.h"
96 #include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/SizeOpts.h"
97 #include <algorithm>
98 #include <cassert>
99 #include <cstdint>
100 #include <iterator>
101 #include <limits>
102 #include <memory>
103 #include <optional>
104 #include <utility>
105 #include <vector>
106
107 using namespace llvm;
108 using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
109
110 #define DEBUG_TYPE "codegenprepare"
111
112 STATISTIC(NumBlocksElim, "Number of blocks eliminated");
113 STATISTIC(NumPHIsElim, "Number of trivial PHIs eliminated");
114 STATISTIC(NumGEPsElim, "Number of GEPs converted to casts");
115 STATISTIC(NumCmpUses, "Number of uses of Cmp expressions replaced with uses of "
116 "sunken Cmps");
117 STATISTIC(NumCastUses, "Number of uses of Cast expressions replaced with uses "
118 "of sunken Casts");
119 STATISTIC(NumMemoryInsts, "Number of memory instructions whose address "
120 "computations were sunk");
121 STATISTIC(NumMemoryInstsPhiCreated,
122 "Number of phis created when address "
123 "computations were sunk to memory instructions");
124 STATISTIC(NumMemoryInstsSelectCreated,
125 "Number of select created when address "
126 "computations were sunk to memory instructions");
127 STATISTIC(NumExtsMoved, "Number of [s|z]ext instructions combined with loads");
128 STATISTIC(NumExtUses, "Number of uses of [s|z]ext instructions optimized");
129 STATISTIC(NumAndsAdded,
130 "Number of and mask instructions added to form ext loads");
131 STATISTIC(NumAndUses, "Number of uses of and mask instructions optimized");
132 STATISTIC(NumRetsDup, "Number of return instructions duplicated");
133 STATISTIC(NumDbgValueMoved, "Number of debug value instructions moved");
134 STATISTIC(NumSelectsExpanded, "Number of selects turned into branches");
135 STATISTIC(NumStoreExtractExposed, "Number of store(extractelement) exposed");
136
137 static cl::opt<bool> DisableBranchOpts(
138 "disable-cgp-branch-opts", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
139 cl::desc("Disable branch optimizations in CodeGenPrepare"));
140
141 static cl::opt<bool>
142 DisableGCOpts("disable-cgp-gc-opts", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
143 cl::desc("Disable GC optimizations in CodeGenPrepare"));
144
145 static cl::opt<bool>
146 DisableSelectToBranch("disable-cgp-select2branch", cl::Hidden,
147 cl::init(false),
148 cl::desc("Disable select to branch conversion."));
149
150 static cl::opt<bool>
151 AddrSinkUsingGEPs("addr-sink-using-gep", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
152 cl::desc("Address sinking in CGP using GEPs."));
153
154 static cl::opt<bool>
155 EnableAndCmpSinking("enable-andcmp-sinking", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
156 cl::desc("Enable sinking and/cmp into branches."));
157
158 static cl::opt<bool> DisableStoreExtract(
159 "disable-cgp-store-extract", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
160 cl::desc("Disable store(extract) optimizations in CodeGenPrepare"));
161
162 static cl::opt<bool> StressStoreExtract(
163 "stress-cgp-store-extract", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
164 cl::desc("Stress test store(extract) optimizations in CodeGenPrepare"));
165
166 static cl::opt<bool> DisableExtLdPromotion(
167 "disable-cgp-ext-ld-promotion", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
168 cl::desc("Disable ext(promotable(ld)) -> promoted(ext(ld)) optimization in "
169 "CodeGenPrepare"));
170
171 static cl::opt<bool> StressExtLdPromotion(
172 "stress-cgp-ext-ld-promotion", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
173 cl::desc("Stress test ext(promotable(ld)) -> promoted(ext(ld)) "
174 "optimization in CodeGenPrepare"));
175
176 static cl::opt<bool> DisablePreheaderProtect(
177 "disable-preheader-prot", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
178 cl::desc("Disable protection against removing loop preheaders"));
179
180 static cl::opt<bool> ProfileGuidedSectionPrefix(
181 "profile-guided-section-prefix", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
182 cl::desc("Use profile info to add section prefix for hot/cold functions"));
183
184 static cl::opt<bool> ProfileUnknownInSpecialSection(
185 "profile-unknown-in-special-section", cl::Hidden,
186 cl::desc("In profiling mode like sampleFDO, if a function doesn't have "
187 "profile, we cannot tell the function is cold for sure because "
188 "it may be a function newly added without ever being sampled. "
189 "With the flag enabled, compiler can put such profile unknown "
190 "functions into a special section, so runtime system can choose "
191 "to handle it in a different way than .text section, to save "
192 "RAM for example. "));
193
194 static cl::opt<bool> BBSectionsGuidedSectionPrefix(
195 "bbsections-guided-section-prefix", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
196 cl::desc("Use the basic-block-sections profile to determine the text "
197 "section prefix for hot functions. Functions with "
198 "basic-block-sections profile will be placed in `.text.hot` "
199 "regardless of their FDO profile info. Other functions won't be "
200 "impacted, i.e., their prefixes will be decided by FDO/sampleFDO "
201 "profiles."));
202
203 static cl::opt<uint64_t> FreqRatioToSkipMerge(
204 "cgp-freq-ratio-to-skip-merge", cl::Hidden, cl::init(2),
205 cl::desc("Skip merging empty blocks if (frequency of empty block) / "
206 "(frequency of destination block) is greater than this ratio"));
207
208 static cl::opt<bool> ForceSplitStore(
209 "force-split-store", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
210 cl::desc("Force store splitting no matter what the target query says."));
211
212 static cl::opt<bool> EnableTypePromotionMerge(
213 "cgp-type-promotion-merge", cl::Hidden,
214 cl::desc("Enable merging of redundant sexts when one is dominating"
215 " the other."),
216 cl::init(true));
217
218 static cl::opt<bool> DisableComplexAddrModes(
219 "disable-complex-addr-modes", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
220 cl::desc("Disables combining addressing modes with different parts "
221 "in optimizeMemoryInst."));
222
223 static cl::opt<bool>
224 AddrSinkNewPhis("addr-sink-new-phis", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
225 cl::desc("Allow creation of Phis in Address sinking."));
226
227 static cl::opt<bool> AddrSinkNewSelects(
228 "addr-sink-new-select", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
229 cl::desc("Allow creation of selects in Address sinking."));
230
231 static cl::opt<bool> AddrSinkCombineBaseReg(
232 "addr-sink-combine-base-reg", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
233 cl::desc("Allow combining of BaseReg field in Address sinking."));
234
235 static cl::opt<bool> AddrSinkCombineBaseGV(
236 "addr-sink-combine-base-gv", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
237 cl::desc("Allow combining of BaseGV field in Address sinking."));
238
239 static cl::opt<bool> AddrSinkCombineBaseOffs(
240 "addr-sink-combine-base-offs", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
241 cl::desc("Allow combining of BaseOffs field in Address sinking."));
242
243 static cl::opt<bool> AddrSinkCombineScaledReg(
244 "addr-sink-combine-scaled-reg", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
245 cl::desc("Allow combining of ScaledReg field in Address sinking."));
246
247 static cl::opt<bool>
248 EnableGEPOffsetSplit("cgp-split-large-offset-gep", cl::Hidden,
249 cl::init(true),
250 cl::desc("Enable splitting large offset of GEP."));
251
252 static cl::opt<bool> EnableICMP_EQToICMP_ST(
253 "cgp-icmp-eq2icmp-st", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
254 cl::desc("Enable ICMP_EQ to ICMP_S(L|G)T conversion."));
255
256 static cl::opt<bool>
257 VerifyBFIUpdates("cgp-verify-bfi-updates", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
258 cl::desc("Enable BFI update verification for "
259 "CodeGenPrepare."));
260
261 static cl::opt<bool>
262 OptimizePhiTypes("cgp-optimize-phi-types", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
263 cl::desc("Enable converting phi types in CodeGenPrepare"));
264
265 static cl::opt<unsigned>
266 HugeFuncThresholdInCGPP("cgpp-huge-func", cl::init(10000), cl::Hidden,
267 cl::desc("Least BB number of huge function."));
268
269 static cl::opt<unsigned>
270 MaxAddressUsersToScan("cgp-max-address-users-to-scan", cl::init(100),
271 cl::Hidden,
272 cl::desc("Max number of address users to look at"));
273
274 static cl::opt<bool>
275 DisableDeletePHIs("disable-cgp-delete-phis", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
276 cl::desc("Disable elimination of dead PHI nodes."));
277
278 namespace {
279
280 enum ExtType {
281 ZeroExtension, // Zero extension has been seen.
282 SignExtension, // Sign extension has been seen.
283 BothExtension // This extension type is used if we saw sext after
284 // ZeroExtension had been set, or if we saw zext after
285 // SignExtension had been set. It makes the type
286 // information of a promoted instruction invalid.
287 };
288
289 enum ModifyDT {
290 NotModifyDT, // Not Modify any DT.
291 ModifyBBDT, // Modify the Basic Block Dominator Tree.
292 ModifyInstDT // Modify the Instruction Dominator in a Basic Block,
293 // This usually means we move/delete/insert instruction
294 // in a Basic Block. So we should re-iterate instructions
295 // in such Basic Block.
296 };
297
298 using SetOfInstrs = SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 16>;
299 using TypeIsSExt = PointerIntPair<Type *, 2, ExtType>;
300 using InstrToOrigTy = DenseMap<Instruction *, TypeIsSExt>;
301 using SExts = SmallVector<Instruction *, 16>;
302 using ValueToSExts = MapVector<Value *, SExts>;
303
304 class TypePromotionTransaction;
305
306 class CodeGenPrepare {
307 friend class CodeGenPrepareLegacyPass;
308 const TargetMachine *TM = nullptr;
309 const TargetSubtargetInfo *SubtargetInfo = nullptr;
310 const TargetLowering *TLI = nullptr;
311 const TargetRegisterInfo *TRI = nullptr;
312 const TargetTransformInfo *TTI = nullptr;
313 const BasicBlockSectionsProfileReader *BBSectionsProfileReader = nullptr;
314 const TargetLibraryInfo *TLInfo = nullptr;
315 LoopInfo *LI = nullptr;
316 std::unique_ptr<BlockFrequencyInfo> BFI;
317 std::unique_ptr<BranchProbabilityInfo> BPI;
318 ProfileSummaryInfo *PSI = nullptr;
319
320 /// As we scan instructions optimizing them, this is the next instruction
321 /// to optimize. Transforms that can invalidate this should update it.
322 BasicBlock::iterator CurInstIterator;
323
324 /// Keeps track of non-local addresses that have been sunk into a block.
325 /// This allows us to avoid inserting duplicate code for blocks with
326 /// multiple load/stores of the same address. The usage of WeakTrackingVH
327 /// enables SunkAddrs to be treated as a cache whose entries can be
328 /// invalidated if a sunken address computation has been erased.
329 ValueMap<Value *, WeakTrackingVH> SunkAddrs;
330
331 /// Keeps track of all instructions inserted for the current function.
332 SetOfInstrs InsertedInsts;
333
334 /// Keeps track of the type of the related instruction before their
335 /// promotion for the current function.
336 InstrToOrigTy PromotedInsts;
337
338 /// Keep track of instructions removed during promotion.
339 SetOfInstrs RemovedInsts;
340
341 /// Keep track of sext chains based on their initial value.
342 DenseMap<Value *, Instruction *> SeenChainsForSExt;
343
344 /// Keep track of GEPs accessing the same data structures such as structs or
345 /// arrays that are candidates to be split later because of their large
346 /// size.
347 MapVector<AssertingVH<Value>,
348 SmallVector<std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t>, 32>>
349 LargeOffsetGEPMap;
350
351 /// Keep track of new GEP base after splitting the GEPs having large offset.
352 SmallSet<AssertingVH<Value>, 2> NewGEPBases;
353
354 /// Map serial numbers to Large offset GEPs.
355 DenseMap<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int> LargeOffsetGEPID;
356
357 /// Keep track of SExt promoted.
358 ValueToSExts ValToSExtendedUses;
359
360 /// True if the function has the OptSize attribute.
361 bool OptSize;
362
363 /// DataLayout for the Function being processed.
364 const DataLayout *DL = nullptr;
365
366 /// Building the dominator tree can be expensive, so we only build it
367 /// lazily and update it when required.
368 std::unique_ptr<DominatorTree> DT;
369
370 public:
CodeGenPrepare()371 CodeGenPrepare(){};
CodeGenPrepare(const TargetMachine * TM)372 CodeGenPrepare(const TargetMachine *TM) : TM(TM){};
373 /// If encounter huge function, we need to limit the build time.
374 bool IsHugeFunc = false;
375
376 /// FreshBBs is like worklist, it collected the updated BBs which need
377 /// to be optimized again.
378 /// Note: Consider building time in this pass, when a BB updated, we need
379 /// to insert such BB into FreshBBs for huge function.
380 SmallSet<BasicBlock *, 32> FreshBBs;
381
releaseMemory()382 void releaseMemory() {
383 // Clear per function information.
384 InsertedInsts.clear();
385 PromotedInsts.clear();
386 FreshBBs.clear();
387 BPI.reset();
388 BFI.reset();
389 }
390
391 bool run(Function &F, FunctionAnalysisManager &AM);
392
393 private:
394 template <typename F>
resetIteratorIfInvalidatedWhileCalling(BasicBlock * BB,F f)395 void resetIteratorIfInvalidatedWhileCalling(BasicBlock *BB, F f) {
396 // Substituting can cause recursive simplifications, which can invalidate
397 // our iterator. Use a WeakTrackingVH to hold onto it in case this
398 // happens.
399 Value *CurValue = &*CurInstIterator;
400 WeakTrackingVH IterHandle(CurValue);
401
402 f();
403
404 // If the iterator instruction was recursively deleted, start over at the
405 // start of the block.
406 if (IterHandle != CurValue) {
407 CurInstIterator = BB->begin();
408 SunkAddrs.clear();
409 }
410 }
411
412 // Get the DominatorTree, building if necessary.
getDT(Function & F)413 DominatorTree &getDT(Function &F) {
414 if (!DT)
415 DT = std::make_unique<DominatorTree>(F);
416 return *DT;
417 }
418
419 void removeAllAssertingVHReferences(Value *V);
420 bool eliminateAssumptions(Function &F);
421 bool eliminateFallThrough(Function &F, DominatorTree *DT = nullptr);
422 bool eliminateMostlyEmptyBlocks(Function &F);
423 BasicBlock *findDestBlockOfMergeableEmptyBlock(BasicBlock *BB);
424 bool canMergeBlocks(const BasicBlock *BB, const BasicBlock *DestBB) const;
425 void eliminateMostlyEmptyBlock(BasicBlock *BB);
426 bool isMergingEmptyBlockProfitable(BasicBlock *BB, BasicBlock *DestBB,
427 bool isPreheader);
428 bool makeBitReverse(Instruction &I);
429 bool optimizeBlock(BasicBlock &BB, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT);
430 bool optimizeInst(Instruction *I, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT);
431 bool optimizeMemoryInst(Instruction *MemoryInst, Value *Addr, Type *AccessTy,
432 unsigned AddrSpace);
433 bool optimizeGatherScatterInst(Instruction *MemoryInst, Value *Ptr);
434 bool optimizeInlineAsmInst(CallInst *CS);
435 bool optimizeCallInst(CallInst *CI, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT);
436 bool optimizeExt(Instruction *&I);
437 bool optimizeExtUses(Instruction *I);
438 bool optimizeLoadExt(LoadInst *Load);
439 bool optimizeShiftInst(BinaryOperator *BO);
440 bool optimizeFunnelShift(IntrinsicInst *Fsh);
441 bool optimizeSelectInst(SelectInst *SI);
442 bool optimizeShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst *SVI);
443 bool optimizeSwitchType(SwitchInst *SI);
444 bool optimizeSwitchPhiConstants(SwitchInst *SI);
445 bool optimizeSwitchInst(SwitchInst *SI);
446 bool optimizeExtractElementInst(Instruction *Inst);
447 bool dupRetToEnableTailCallOpts(BasicBlock *BB, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT);
448 bool fixupDbgValue(Instruction *I);
449 bool fixupDbgVariableRecord(DbgVariableRecord &I);
450 bool fixupDbgVariableRecordsOnInst(Instruction &I);
451 bool placeDbgValues(Function &F);
452 bool placePseudoProbes(Function &F);
453 bool canFormExtLd(const SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &MovedExts,
454 LoadInst *&LI, Instruction *&Inst, bool HasPromoted);
455 bool tryToPromoteExts(TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
456 const SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &Exts,
457 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &ProfitablyMovedExts,
458 unsigned CreatedInstsCost = 0);
459 bool mergeSExts(Function &F);
460 bool splitLargeGEPOffsets();
461 bool optimizePhiType(PHINode *Inst, SmallPtrSetImpl<PHINode *> &Visited,
462 SmallPtrSetImpl<Instruction *> &DeletedInstrs);
463 bool optimizePhiTypes(Function &F);
464 bool performAddressTypePromotion(
465 Instruction *&Inst, bool AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader,
466 bool HasPromoted, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
467 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &SpeculativelyMovedExts);
468 bool splitBranchCondition(Function &F, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT);
469 bool simplifyOffsetableRelocate(GCStatepointInst &I);
470
471 bool tryToSinkFreeOperands(Instruction *I);
472 bool replaceMathCmpWithIntrinsic(BinaryOperator *BO, Value *Arg0, Value *Arg1,
473 CmpInst *Cmp, Intrinsic::ID IID);
474 bool optimizeCmp(CmpInst *Cmp, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT);
475 bool optimizeURem(Instruction *Rem);
476 bool combineToUSubWithOverflow(CmpInst *Cmp, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT);
477 bool combineToUAddWithOverflow(CmpInst *Cmp, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT);
478 bool unfoldPowerOf2Test(CmpInst *Cmp);
479 void verifyBFIUpdates(Function &F);
480 bool _run(Function &F);
481 };
482
483 class CodeGenPrepareLegacyPass : public FunctionPass {
484 public:
485 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
486
CodeGenPrepareLegacyPass()487 CodeGenPrepareLegacyPass() : FunctionPass(ID) {
488 initializeCodeGenPrepareLegacyPassPass(*PassRegistry::getPassRegistry());
489 }
490
491 bool runOnFunction(Function &F) override;
492
getPassName() const493 StringRef getPassName() const override { return "CodeGen Prepare"; }
494
getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage & AU) const495 void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const override {
496 // FIXME: When we can selectively preserve passes, preserve the domtree.
497 AU.addRequired<ProfileSummaryInfoWrapperPass>();
498 AU.addRequired<TargetLibraryInfoWrapperPass>();
499 AU.addRequired<TargetPassConfig>();
500 AU.addRequired<TargetTransformInfoWrapperPass>();
501 AU.addRequired<LoopInfoWrapperPass>();
502 AU.addUsedIfAvailable<BasicBlockSectionsProfileReaderWrapperPass>();
503 }
504 };
505
506 } // end anonymous namespace
507
508 char CodeGenPrepareLegacyPass::ID = 0;
509
runOnFunction(Function & F)510 bool CodeGenPrepareLegacyPass::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
511 if (skipFunction(F))
512 return false;
513 auto TM = &getAnalysis<TargetPassConfig>().getTM<TargetMachine>();
514 CodeGenPrepare CGP(TM);
515 CGP.DL = &F.getDataLayout();
516 CGP.SubtargetInfo = TM->getSubtargetImpl(F);
517 CGP.TLI = CGP.SubtargetInfo->getTargetLowering();
518 CGP.TRI = CGP.SubtargetInfo->getRegisterInfo();
519 CGP.TLInfo = &getAnalysis<TargetLibraryInfoWrapperPass>().getTLI(F);
520 CGP.TTI = &getAnalysis<TargetTransformInfoWrapperPass>().getTTI(F);
521 CGP.LI = &getAnalysis<LoopInfoWrapperPass>().getLoopInfo();
522 CGP.BPI.reset(new BranchProbabilityInfo(F, *CGP.LI));
523 CGP.BFI.reset(new BlockFrequencyInfo(F, *CGP.BPI, *CGP.LI));
524 CGP.PSI = &getAnalysis<ProfileSummaryInfoWrapperPass>().getPSI();
525 auto BBSPRWP =
526 getAnalysisIfAvailable<BasicBlockSectionsProfileReaderWrapperPass>();
527 CGP.BBSectionsProfileReader = BBSPRWP ? &BBSPRWP->getBBSPR() : nullptr;
528
529 return CGP._run(F);
530 }
531
532 INITIALIZE_PASS_BEGIN(CodeGenPrepareLegacyPass, DEBUG_TYPE,
533 "Optimize for code generation", false, false)
INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(BasicBlockSectionsProfileReaderWrapperPass)534 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(BasicBlockSectionsProfileReaderWrapperPass)
535 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(LoopInfoWrapperPass)
536 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(ProfileSummaryInfoWrapperPass)
537 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(TargetLibraryInfoWrapperPass)
538 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(TargetPassConfig)
539 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(TargetTransformInfoWrapperPass)
540 INITIALIZE_PASS_END(CodeGenPrepareLegacyPass, DEBUG_TYPE,
541 "Optimize for code generation", false, false)
542
543 FunctionPass *llvm::createCodeGenPrepareLegacyPass() {
544 return new CodeGenPrepareLegacyPass();
545 }
546
run(Function & F,FunctionAnalysisManager & AM)547 PreservedAnalyses CodeGenPreparePass::run(Function &F,
548 FunctionAnalysisManager &AM) {
549 CodeGenPrepare CGP(TM);
550
551 bool Changed = CGP.run(F, AM);
552 if (!Changed)
553 return PreservedAnalyses::all();
554
555 PreservedAnalyses PA;
556 PA.preserve<TargetLibraryAnalysis>();
557 PA.preserve<TargetIRAnalysis>();
558 PA.preserve<LoopAnalysis>();
559 return PA;
560 }
561
run(Function & F,FunctionAnalysisManager & AM)562 bool CodeGenPrepare::run(Function &F, FunctionAnalysisManager &AM) {
563 DL = &F.getDataLayout();
564 SubtargetInfo = TM->getSubtargetImpl(F);
565 TLI = SubtargetInfo->getTargetLowering();
566 TRI = SubtargetInfo->getRegisterInfo();
567 TLInfo = &AM.getResult<TargetLibraryAnalysis>(F);
568 TTI = &AM.getResult<TargetIRAnalysis>(F);
569 LI = &AM.getResult<LoopAnalysis>(F);
570 BPI.reset(new BranchProbabilityInfo(F, *LI));
571 BFI.reset(new BlockFrequencyInfo(F, *BPI, *LI));
572 auto &MAMProxy = AM.getResult<ModuleAnalysisManagerFunctionProxy>(F);
573 PSI = MAMProxy.getCachedResult<ProfileSummaryAnalysis>(*F.getParent());
574 BBSectionsProfileReader =
575 AM.getCachedResult<BasicBlockSectionsProfileReaderAnalysis>(F);
576 return _run(F);
577 }
578
_run(Function & F)579 bool CodeGenPrepare::_run(Function &F) {
580 bool EverMadeChange = false;
581
582 OptSize = F.hasOptSize();
583 // Use the basic-block-sections profile to promote hot functions to .text.hot
584 // if requested.
585 if (BBSectionsGuidedSectionPrefix && BBSectionsProfileReader &&
586 BBSectionsProfileReader->isFunctionHot(F.getName())) {
587 F.setSectionPrefix("hot");
588 } else if (ProfileGuidedSectionPrefix) {
589 // The hot attribute overwrites profile count based hotness while profile
590 // counts based hotness overwrite the cold attribute.
591 // This is a conservative behabvior.
592 if (F.hasFnAttribute(Attribute::Hot) ||
593 PSI->isFunctionHotInCallGraph(&F, *BFI))
594 F.setSectionPrefix("hot");
595 // If PSI shows this function is not hot, we will placed the function
596 // into unlikely section if (1) PSI shows this is a cold function, or
597 // (2) the function has a attribute of cold.
598 else if (PSI->isFunctionColdInCallGraph(&F, *BFI) ||
599 F.hasFnAttribute(Attribute::Cold))
600 F.setSectionPrefix("unlikely");
601 else if (ProfileUnknownInSpecialSection && PSI->hasPartialSampleProfile() &&
602 PSI->isFunctionHotnessUnknown(F))
603 F.setSectionPrefix("unknown");
604 }
605
606 /// This optimization identifies DIV instructions that can be
607 /// profitably bypassed and carried out with a shorter, faster divide.
608 if (!OptSize && !PSI->hasHugeWorkingSetSize() && TLI->isSlowDivBypassed()) {
609 const DenseMap<unsigned int, unsigned int> &BypassWidths =
610 TLI->getBypassSlowDivWidths();
611 BasicBlock *BB = &*F.begin();
612 while (BB != nullptr) {
613 // bypassSlowDivision may create new BBs, but we don't want to reapply the
614 // optimization to those blocks.
615 BasicBlock *Next = BB->getNextNode();
616 if (!llvm::shouldOptimizeForSize(BB, PSI, BFI.get()))
617 EverMadeChange |= bypassSlowDivision(BB, BypassWidths);
618 BB = Next;
619 }
620 }
621
622 // Get rid of @llvm.assume builtins before attempting to eliminate empty
623 // blocks, since there might be blocks that only contain @llvm.assume calls
624 // (plus arguments that we can get rid of).
625 EverMadeChange |= eliminateAssumptions(F);
626
627 // Eliminate blocks that contain only PHI nodes and an
628 // unconditional branch.
629 EverMadeChange |= eliminateMostlyEmptyBlocks(F);
630
631 ModifyDT ModifiedDT = ModifyDT::NotModifyDT;
632 if (!DisableBranchOpts)
633 EverMadeChange |= splitBranchCondition(F, ModifiedDT);
634
635 // Split some critical edges where one of the sources is an indirect branch,
636 // to help generate sane code for PHIs involving such edges.
637 EverMadeChange |=
638 SplitIndirectBrCriticalEdges(F, /*IgnoreBlocksWithoutPHI=*/true);
639
640 // If we are optimzing huge function, we need to consider the build time.
641 // Because the basic algorithm's complex is near O(N!).
642 IsHugeFunc = F.size() > HugeFuncThresholdInCGPP;
643
644 // Transformations above may invalidate dominator tree and/or loop info.
645 DT.reset();
646 LI->releaseMemory();
647 LI->analyze(getDT(F));
648
649 bool MadeChange = true;
650 bool FuncIterated = false;
651 while (MadeChange) {
652 MadeChange = false;
653
654 for (BasicBlock &BB : llvm::make_early_inc_range(F)) {
655 if (FuncIterated && !FreshBBs.contains(&BB))
656 continue;
657
658 ModifyDT ModifiedDTOnIteration = ModifyDT::NotModifyDT;
659 bool Changed = optimizeBlock(BB, ModifiedDTOnIteration);
660
661 if (ModifiedDTOnIteration == ModifyDT::ModifyBBDT)
662 DT.reset();
663
664 MadeChange |= Changed;
665 if (IsHugeFunc) {
666 // If the BB is updated, it may still has chance to be optimized.
667 // This usually happen at sink optimization.
668 // For example:
669 //
670 // bb0:
671 // %and = and i32 %a, 4
672 // %cmp = icmp eq i32 %and, 0
673 //
674 // If the %cmp sink to other BB, the %and will has chance to sink.
675 if (Changed)
676 FreshBBs.insert(&BB);
677 else if (FuncIterated)
678 FreshBBs.erase(&BB);
679 } else {
680 // For small/normal functions, we restart BB iteration if the dominator
681 // tree of the Function was changed.
682 if (ModifiedDTOnIteration != ModifyDT::NotModifyDT)
683 break;
684 }
685 }
686 // We have iterated all the BB in the (only work for huge) function.
687 FuncIterated = IsHugeFunc;
688
689 if (EnableTypePromotionMerge && !ValToSExtendedUses.empty())
690 MadeChange |= mergeSExts(F);
691 if (!LargeOffsetGEPMap.empty())
692 MadeChange |= splitLargeGEPOffsets();
693 MadeChange |= optimizePhiTypes(F);
694
695 if (MadeChange)
696 eliminateFallThrough(F, DT.get());
697
698 #ifndef NDEBUG
699 if (MadeChange && VerifyLoopInfo)
700 LI->verify(getDT(F));
701 #endif
702
703 // Really free removed instructions during promotion.
704 for (Instruction *I : RemovedInsts)
705 I->deleteValue();
706
707 EverMadeChange |= MadeChange;
708 SeenChainsForSExt.clear();
709 ValToSExtendedUses.clear();
710 RemovedInsts.clear();
711 LargeOffsetGEPMap.clear();
712 LargeOffsetGEPID.clear();
713 }
714
715 NewGEPBases.clear();
716 SunkAddrs.clear();
717
718 if (!DisableBranchOpts) {
719 MadeChange = false;
720 // Use a set vector to get deterministic iteration order. The order the
721 // blocks are removed may affect whether or not PHI nodes in successors
722 // are removed.
723 SmallSetVector<BasicBlock *, 8> WorkList;
724 for (BasicBlock &BB : F) {
725 SmallVector<BasicBlock *, 2> Successors(successors(&BB));
726 MadeChange |= ConstantFoldTerminator(&BB, true);
727 if (!MadeChange)
728 continue;
729
730 for (BasicBlock *Succ : Successors)
731 if (pred_empty(Succ))
732 WorkList.insert(Succ);
733 }
734
735 // Delete the dead blocks and any of their dead successors.
736 MadeChange |= !WorkList.empty();
737 while (!WorkList.empty()) {
738 BasicBlock *BB = WorkList.pop_back_val();
739 SmallVector<BasicBlock *, 2> Successors(successors(BB));
740
741 DeleteDeadBlock(BB);
742
743 for (BasicBlock *Succ : Successors)
744 if (pred_empty(Succ))
745 WorkList.insert(Succ);
746 }
747
748 // Merge pairs of basic blocks with unconditional branches, connected by
749 // a single edge.
750 if (EverMadeChange || MadeChange)
751 MadeChange |= eliminateFallThrough(F);
752
753 EverMadeChange |= MadeChange;
754 }
755
756 if (!DisableGCOpts) {
757 SmallVector<GCStatepointInst *, 2> Statepoints;
758 for (BasicBlock &BB : F)
759 for (Instruction &I : BB)
760 if (auto *SP = dyn_cast<GCStatepointInst>(&I))
761 Statepoints.push_back(SP);
762 for (auto &I : Statepoints)
763 EverMadeChange |= simplifyOffsetableRelocate(*I);
764 }
765
766 // Do this last to clean up use-before-def scenarios introduced by other
767 // preparatory transforms.
768 EverMadeChange |= placeDbgValues(F);
769 EverMadeChange |= placePseudoProbes(F);
770
771 #ifndef NDEBUG
772 if (VerifyBFIUpdates)
773 verifyBFIUpdates(F);
774 #endif
775
776 return EverMadeChange;
777 }
778
eliminateAssumptions(Function & F)779 bool CodeGenPrepare::eliminateAssumptions(Function &F) {
780 bool MadeChange = false;
781 for (BasicBlock &BB : F) {
782 CurInstIterator = BB.begin();
783 while (CurInstIterator != BB.end()) {
784 Instruction *I = &*(CurInstIterator++);
785 if (auto *Assume = dyn_cast<AssumeInst>(I)) {
786 MadeChange = true;
787 Value *Operand = Assume->getOperand(0);
788 Assume->eraseFromParent();
789
790 resetIteratorIfInvalidatedWhileCalling(&BB, [&]() {
791 RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(Operand, TLInfo, nullptr);
792 });
793 }
794 }
795 }
796 return MadeChange;
797 }
798
799 /// An instruction is about to be deleted, so remove all references to it in our
800 /// GEP-tracking data strcutures.
removeAllAssertingVHReferences(Value * V)801 void CodeGenPrepare::removeAllAssertingVHReferences(Value *V) {
802 LargeOffsetGEPMap.erase(V);
803 NewGEPBases.erase(V);
804
805 auto GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(V);
806 if (!GEP)
807 return;
808
809 LargeOffsetGEPID.erase(GEP);
810
811 auto VecI = LargeOffsetGEPMap.find(GEP->getPointerOperand());
812 if (VecI == LargeOffsetGEPMap.end())
813 return;
814
815 auto &GEPVector = VecI->second;
816 llvm::erase_if(GEPVector, [=](auto &Elt) { return Elt.first == GEP; });
817
818 if (GEPVector.empty())
819 LargeOffsetGEPMap.erase(VecI);
820 }
821
822 // Verify BFI has been updated correctly by recomputing BFI and comparing them.
verifyBFIUpdates(Function & F)823 void LLVM_ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED CodeGenPrepare::verifyBFIUpdates(Function &F) {
824 DominatorTree NewDT(F);
825 LoopInfo NewLI(NewDT);
826 BranchProbabilityInfo NewBPI(F, NewLI, TLInfo);
827 BlockFrequencyInfo NewBFI(F, NewBPI, NewLI);
828 NewBFI.verifyMatch(*BFI);
829 }
830
831 /// Merge basic blocks which are connected by a single edge, where one of the
832 /// basic blocks has a single successor pointing to the other basic block,
833 /// which has a single predecessor.
eliminateFallThrough(Function & F,DominatorTree * DT)834 bool CodeGenPrepare::eliminateFallThrough(Function &F, DominatorTree *DT) {
835 bool Changed = false;
836 // Scan all of the blocks in the function, except for the entry block.
837 // Use a temporary array to avoid iterator being invalidated when
838 // deleting blocks.
839 SmallVector<WeakTrackingVH, 16> Blocks(
840 llvm::make_pointer_range(llvm::drop_begin(F)));
841
842 SmallSet<WeakTrackingVH, 16> Preds;
843 for (auto &Block : Blocks) {
844 auto *BB = cast_or_null<BasicBlock>(Block);
845 if (!BB)
846 continue;
847 // If the destination block has a single pred, then this is a trivial
848 // edge, just collapse it.
849 BasicBlock *SinglePred = BB->getSinglePredecessor();
850
851 // Don't merge if BB's address is taken.
852 if (!SinglePred || SinglePred == BB || BB->hasAddressTaken())
853 continue;
854
855 // Make an effort to skip unreachable blocks.
856 if (DT && !DT->isReachableFromEntry(BB))
857 continue;
858
859 BranchInst *Term = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(SinglePred->getTerminator());
860 if (Term && !Term->isConditional()) {
861 Changed = true;
862 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "To merge:\n" << *BB << "\n\n\n");
863
864 // Merge BB into SinglePred and delete it.
865 MergeBlockIntoPredecessor(BB, /* DTU */ nullptr, LI, /* MSSAU */ nullptr,
866 /* MemDep */ nullptr,
867 /* PredecessorWithTwoSuccessors */ false, DT);
868 Preds.insert(SinglePred);
869
870 if (IsHugeFunc) {
871 // Update FreshBBs to optimize the merged BB.
872 FreshBBs.insert(SinglePred);
873 FreshBBs.erase(BB);
874 }
875 }
876 }
877
878 // (Repeatedly) merging blocks into their predecessors can create redundant
879 // debug intrinsics.
880 for (const auto &Pred : Preds)
881 if (auto *BB = cast_or_null<BasicBlock>(Pred))
882 RemoveRedundantDbgInstrs(BB);
883
884 return Changed;
885 }
886
887 /// Find a destination block from BB if BB is mergeable empty block.
findDestBlockOfMergeableEmptyBlock(BasicBlock * BB)888 BasicBlock *CodeGenPrepare::findDestBlockOfMergeableEmptyBlock(BasicBlock *BB) {
889 // If this block doesn't end with an uncond branch, ignore it.
890 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BB->getTerminator());
891 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional())
892 return nullptr;
893
894 // If the instruction before the branch (skipping debug info) isn't a phi
895 // node, then other stuff is happening here.
896 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BI->getIterator();
897 if (BBI != BB->begin()) {
898 --BBI;
899 if (!isa<PHINode>(BBI))
900 return nullptr;
901 }
902
903 // Do not break infinite loops.
904 BasicBlock *DestBB = BI->getSuccessor(0);
905 if (DestBB == BB)
906 return nullptr;
907
908 if (!canMergeBlocks(BB, DestBB))
909 DestBB = nullptr;
910
911 return DestBB;
912 }
913
914 /// Eliminate blocks that contain only PHI nodes, debug info directives, and an
915 /// unconditional branch. Passes before isel (e.g. LSR/loopsimplify) often split
916 /// edges in ways that are non-optimal for isel. Start by eliminating these
917 /// blocks so we can split them the way we want them.
eliminateMostlyEmptyBlocks(Function & F)918 bool CodeGenPrepare::eliminateMostlyEmptyBlocks(Function &F) {
919 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock *, 16> Preheaders;
920 SmallVector<Loop *, 16> LoopList(LI->begin(), LI->end());
921 while (!LoopList.empty()) {
922 Loop *L = LoopList.pop_back_val();
923 llvm::append_range(LoopList, *L);
924 if (BasicBlock *Preheader = L->getLoopPreheader())
925 Preheaders.insert(Preheader);
926 }
927
928 bool MadeChange = false;
929 // Copy blocks into a temporary array to avoid iterator invalidation issues
930 // as we remove them.
931 // Note that this intentionally skips the entry block.
932 SmallVector<WeakTrackingVH, 16> Blocks;
933 for (auto &Block : llvm::drop_begin(F)) {
934 // Delete phi nodes that could block deleting other empty blocks.
935 if (!DisableDeletePHIs)
936 MadeChange |= DeleteDeadPHIs(&Block, TLInfo);
937 Blocks.push_back(&Block);
938 }
939
940 for (auto &Block : Blocks) {
941 BasicBlock *BB = cast_or_null<BasicBlock>(Block);
942 if (!BB)
943 continue;
944 BasicBlock *DestBB = findDestBlockOfMergeableEmptyBlock(BB);
945 if (!DestBB ||
946 !isMergingEmptyBlockProfitable(BB, DestBB, Preheaders.count(BB)))
947 continue;
948
949 eliminateMostlyEmptyBlock(BB);
950 MadeChange = true;
951 }
952 return MadeChange;
953 }
954
isMergingEmptyBlockProfitable(BasicBlock * BB,BasicBlock * DestBB,bool isPreheader)955 bool CodeGenPrepare::isMergingEmptyBlockProfitable(BasicBlock *BB,
956 BasicBlock *DestBB,
957 bool isPreheader) {
958 // Do not delete loop preheaders if doing so would create a critical edge.
959 // Loop preheaders can be good locations to spill registers. If the
960 // preheader is deleted and we create a critical edge, registers may be
961 // spilled in the loop body instead.
962 if (!DisablePreheaderProtect && isPreheader &&
963 !(BB->getSinglePredecessor() &&
964 BB->getSinglePredecessor()->getSingleSuccessor()))
965 return false;
966
967 // Skip merging if the block's successor is also a successor to any callbr
968 // that leads to this block.
969 // FIXME: Is this really needed? Is this a correctness issue?
970 for (BasicBlock *Pred : predecessors(BB)) {
971 if (isa<CallBrInst>(Pred->getTerminator()) &&
972 llvm::is_contained(successors(Pred), DestBB))
973 return false;
974 }
975
976 // Try to skip merging if the unique predecessor of BB is terminated by a
977 // switch or indirect branch instruction, and BB is used as an incoming block
978 // of PHIs in DestBB. In such case, merging BB and DestBB would cause ISel to
979 // add COPY instructions in the predecessor of BB instead of BB (if it is not
980 // merged). Note that the critical edge created by merging such blocks wont be
981 // split in MachineSink because the jump table is not analyzable. By keeping
982 // such empty block (BB), ISel will place COPY instructions in BB, not in the
983 // predecessor of BB.
984 BasicBlock *Pred = BB->getUniquePredecessor();
985 if (!Pred || !(isa<SwitchInst>(Pred->getTerminator()) ||
986 isa<IndirectBrInst>(Pred->getTerminator())))
987 return true;
988
989 if (BB->getTerminator() != &*BB->getFirstNonPHIOrDbg())
990 return true;
991
992 // We use a simple cost heuristic which determine skipping merging is
993 // profitable if the cost of skipping merging is less than the cost of
994 // merging : Cost(skipping merging) < Cost(merging BB), where the
995 // Cost(skipping merging) is Freq(BB) * (Cost(Copy) + Cost(Branch)), and
996 // the Cost(merging BB) is Freq(Pred) * Cost(Copy).
997 // Assuming Cost(Copy) == Cost(Branch), we could simplify it to :
998 // Freq(Pred) / Freq(BB) > 2.
999 // Note that if there are multiple empty blocks sharing the same incoming
1000 // value for the PHIs in the DestBB, we consider them together. In such
1001 // case, Cost(merging BB) will be the sum of their frequencies.
1002
1003 if (!isa<PHINode>(DestBB->begin()))
1004 return true;
1005
1006 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock *, 16> SameIncomingValueBBs;
1007
1008 // Find all other incoming blocks from which incoming values of all PHIs in
1009 // DestBB are the same as the ones from BB.
1010 for (BasicBlock *DestBBPred : predecessors(DestBB)) {
1011 if (DestBBPred == BB)
1012 continue;
1013
1014 if (llvm::all_of(DestBB->phis(), [&](const PHINode &DestPN) {
1015 return DestPN.getIncomingValueForBlock(BB) ==
1016 DestPN.getIncomingValueForBlock(DestBBPred);
1017 }))
1018 SameIncomingValueBBs.insert(DestBBPred);
1019 }
1020
1021 // See if all BB's incoming values are same as the value from Pred. In this
1022 // case, no reason to skip merging because COPYs are expected to be place in
1023 // Pred already.
1024 if (SameIncomingValueBBs.count(Pred))
1025 return true;
1026
1027 BlockFrequency PredFreq = BFI->getBlockFreq(Pred);
1028 BlockFrequency BBFreq = BFI->getBlockFreq(BB);
1029
1030 for (auto *SameValueBB : SameIncomingValueBBs)
1031 if (SameValueBB->getUniquePredecessor() == Pred &&
1032 DestBB == findDestBlockOfMergeableEmptyBlock(SameValueBB))
1033 BBFreq += BFI->getBlockFreq(SameValueBB);
1034
1035 std::optional<BlockFrequency> Limit = BBFreq.mul(FreqRatioToSkipMerge);
1036 return !Limit || PredFreq <= *Limit;
1037 }
1038
1039 /// Return true if we can merge BB into DestBB if there is a single
1040 /// unconditional branch between them, and BB contains no other non-phi
1041 /// instructions.
canMergeBlocks(const BasicBlock * BB,const BasicBlock * DestBB) const1042 bool CodeGenPrepare::canMergeBlocks(const BasicBlock *BB,
1043 const BasicBlock *DestBB) const {
1044 // We only want to eliminate blocks whose phi nodes are used by phi nodes in
1045 // the successor. If there are more complex condition (e.g. preheaders),
1046 // don't mess around with them.
1047 for (const PHINode &PN : BB->phis()) {
1048 for (const User *U : PN.users()) {
1049 const Instruction *UI = cast<Instruction>(U);
1050 if (UI->getParent() != DestBB || !isa<PHINode>(UI))
1051 return false;
1052 // If User is inside DestBB block and it is a PHINode then check
1053 // incoming value. If incoming value is not from BB then this is
1054 // a complex condition (e.g. preheaders) we want to avoid here.
1055 if (UI->getParent() == DestBB) {
1056 if (const PHINode *UPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(UI))
1057 for (unsigned I = 0, E = UPN->getNumIncomingValues(); I != E; ++I) {
1058 Instruction *Insn = dyn_cast<Instruction>(UPN->getIncomingValue(I));
1059 if (Insn && Insn->getParent() == BB &&
1060 Insn->getParent() != UPN->getIncomingBlock(I))
1061 return false;
1062 }
1063 }
1064 }
1065 }
1066
1067 // If BB and DestBB contain any common predecessors, then the phi nodes in BB
1068 // and DestBB may have conflicting incoming values for the block. If so, we
1069 // can't merge the block.
1070 const PHINode *DestBBPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(DestBB->begin());
1071 if (!DestBBPN)
1072 return true; // no conflict.
1073
1074 // Collect the preds of BB.
1075 SmallPtrSet<const BasicBlock *, 16> BBPreds;
1076 if (const PHINode *BBPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(BB->begin())) {
1077 // It is faster to get preds from a PHI than with pred_iterator.
1078 for (unsigned i = 0, e = BBPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
1079 BBPreds.insert(BBPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
1080 } else {
1081 BBPreds.insert_range(predecessors(BB));
1082 }
1083
1084 // Walk the preds of DestBB.
1085 for (unsigned i = 0, e = DestBBPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
1086 BasicBlock *Pred = DestBBPN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1087 if (BBPreds.count(Pred)) { // Common predecessor?
1088 for (const PHINode &PN : DestBB->phis()) {
1089 const Value *V1 = PN.getIncomingValueForBlock(Pred);
1090 const Value *V2 = PN.getIncomingValueForBlock(BB);
1091
1092 // If V2 is a phi node in BB, look up what the mapped value will be.
1093 if (const PHINode *V2PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V2))
1094 if (V2PN->getParent() == BB)
1095 V2 = V2PN->getIncomingValueForBlock(Pred);
1096
1097 // If there is a conflict, bail out.
1098 if (V1 != V2)
1099 return false;
1100 }
1101 }
1102 }
1103
1104 return true;
1105 }
1106
1107 /// Replace all old uses with new ones, and push the updated BBs into FreshBBs.
replaceAllUsesWith(Value * Old,Value * New,SmallSet<BasicBlock *,32> & FreshBBs,bool IsHuge)1108 static void replaceAllUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New,
1109 SmallSet<BasicBlock *, 32> &FreshBBs,
1110 bool IsHuge) {
1111 auto *OldI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old);
1112 if (OldI) {
1113 for (Value::user_iterator UI = OldI->user_begin(), E = OldI->user_end();
1114 UI != E; ++UI) {
1115 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI);
1116 if (IsHuge)
1117 FreshBBs.insert(User->getParent());
1118 }
1119 }
1120 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
1121 }
1122
1123 /// Eliminate a basic block that has only phi's and an unconditional branch in
1124 /// it.
eliminateMostlyEmptyBlock(BasicBlock * BB)1125 void CodeGenPrepare::eliminateMostlyEmptyBlock(BasicBlock *BB) {
1126 BranchInst *BI = cast<BranchInst>(BB->getTerminator());
1127 BasicBlock *DestBB = BI->getSuccessor(0);
1128
1129 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "MERGING MOSTLY EMPTY BLOCKS - BEFORE:\n"
1130 << *BB << *DestBB);
1131
1132 // If the destination block has a single pred, then this is a trivial edge,
1133 // just collapse it.
1134 if (BasicBlock *SinglePred = DestBB->getSinglePredecessor()) {
1135 if (SinglePred != DestBB) {
1136 assert(SinglePred == BB &&
1137 "Single predecessor not the same as predecessor");
1138 // Merge DestBB into SinglePred/BB and delete it.
1139 MergeBlockIntoPredecessor(DestBB);
1140 // Note: BB(=SinglePred) will not be deleted on this path.
1141 // DestBB(=its single successor) is the one that was deleted.
1142 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "AFTER:\n" << *SinglePred << "\n\n\n");
1143
1144 if (IsHugeFunc) {
1145 // Update FreshBBs to optimize the merged BB.
1146 FreshBBs.insert(SinglePred);
1147 FreshBBs.erase(DestBB);
1148 }
1149 return;
1150 }
1151 }
1152
1153 // Otherwise, we have multiple predecessors of BB. Update the PHIs in DestBB
1154 // to handle the new incoming edges it is about to have.
1155 for (PHINode &PN : DestBB->phis()) {
1156 // Remove the incoming value for BB, and remember it.
1157 Value *InVal = PN.removeIncomingValue(BB, false);
1158
1159 // Two options: either the InVal is a phi node defined in BB or it is some
1160 // value that dominates BB.
1161 PHINode *InValPhi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(InVal);
1162 if (InValPhi && InValPhi->getParent() == BB) {
1163 // Add all of the input values of the input PHI as inputs of this phi.
1164 for (unsigned i = 0, e = InValPhi->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
1165 PN.addIncoming(InValPhi->getIncomingValue(i),
1166 InValPhi->getIncomingBlock(i));
1167 } else {
1168 // Otherwise, add one instance of the dominating value for each edge that
1169 // we will be adding.
1170 if (PHINode *BBPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(BB->begin())) {
1171 for (unsigned i = 0, e = BBPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
1172 PN.addIncoming(InVal, BBPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
1173 } else {
1174 for (BasicBlock *Pred : predecessors(BB))
1175 PN.addIncoming(InVal, Pred);
1176 }
1177 }
1178 }
1179
1180 // Preserve loop Metadata.
1181 if (BI->hasMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_loop)) {
1182 for (auto *Pred : predecessors(BB))
1183 Pred->getTerminator()->copyMetadata(*BI, LLVMContext::MD_loop);
1184 }
1185
1186 // The PHIs are now updated, change everything that refers to BB to use
1187 // DestBB and remove BB.
1188 BB->replaceAllUsesWith(DestBB);
1189 BB->eraseFromParent();
1190 ++NumBlocksElim;
1191
1192 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "AFTER:\n" << *DestBB << "\n\n\n");
1193 }
1194
1195 // Computes a map of base pointer relocation instructions to corresponding
1196 // derived pointer relocation instructions given a vector of all relocate calls
computeBaseDerivedRelocateMap(const SmallVectorImpl<GCRelocateInst * > & AllRelocateCalls,MapVector<GCRelocateInst *,SmallVector<GCRelocateInst *,0>> & RelocateInstMap)1197 static void computeBaseDerivedRelocateMap(
1198 const SmallVectorImpl<GCRelocateInst *> &AllRelocateCalls,
1199 MapVector<GCRelocateInst *, SmallVector<GCRelocateInst *, 0>>
1200 &RelocateInstMap) {
1201 // Collect information in two maps: one primarily for locating the base object
1202 // while filling the second map; the second map is the final structure holding
1203 // a mapping between Base and corresponding Derived relocate calls
1204 MapVector<std::pair<unsigned, unsigned>, GCRelocateInst *> RelocateIdxMap;
1205 for (auto *ThisRelocate : AllRelocateCalls) {
1206 auto K = std::make_pair(ThisRelocate->getBasePtrIndex(),
1207 ThisRelocate->getDerivedPtrIndex());
1208 RelocateIdxMap.insert(std::make_pair(K, ThisRelocate));
1209 }
1210 for (auto &Item : RelocateIdxMap) {
1211 std::pair<unsigned, unsigned> Key = Item.first;
1212 if (Key.first == Key.second)
1213 // Base relocation: nothing to insert
1214 continue;
1215
1216 GCRelocateInst *I = Item.second;
1217 auto BaseKey = std::make_pair(Key.first, Key.first);
1218
1219 // We're iterating over RelocateIdxMap so we cannot modify it.
1220 auto MaybeBase = RelocateIdxMap.find(BaseKey);
1221 if (MaybeBase == RelocateIdxMap.end())
1222 // TODO: We might want to insert a new base object relocate and gep off
1223 // that, if there are enough derived object relocates.
1224 continue;
1225
1226 RelocateInstMap[MaybeBase->second].push_back(I);
1227 }
1228 }
1229
1230 // Accepts a GEP and extracts the operands into a vector provided they're all
1231 // small integer constants
getGEPSmallConstantIntOffsetV(GetElementPtrInst * GEP,SmallVectorImpl<Value * > & OffsetV)1232 static bool getGEPSmallConstantIntOffsetV(GetElementPtrInst *GEP,
1233 SmallVectorImpl<Value *> &OffsetV) {
1234 for (unsigned i = 1; i < GEP->getNumOperands(); i++) {
1235 // Only accept small constant integer operands
1236 auto *Op = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
1237 if (!Op || Op->getZExtValue() > 20)
1238 return false;
1239 }
1240
1241 for (unsigned i = 1; i < GEP->getNumOperands(); i++)
1242 OffsetV.push_back(GEP->getOperand(i));
1243 return true;
1244 }
1245
1246 // Takes a RelocatedBase (base pointer relocation instruction) and Targets to
1247 // replace, computes a replacement, and affects it.
1248 static bool
simplifyRelocatesOffABase(GCRelocateInst * RelocatedBase,const SmallVectorImpl<GCRelocateInst * > & Targets)1249 simplifyRelocatesOffABase(GCRelocateInst *RelocatedBase,
1250 const SmallVectorImpl<GCRelocateInst *> &Targets) {
1251 bool MadeChange = false;
1252 // We must ensure the relocation of derived pointer is defined after
1253 // relocation of base pointer. If we find a relocation corresponding to base
1254 // defined earlier than relocation of base then we move relocation of base
1255 // right before found relocation. We consider only relocation in the same
1256 // basic block as relocation of base. Relocations from other basic block will
1257 // be skipped by optimization and we do not care about them.
1258 for (auto R = RelocatedBase->getParent()->getFirstInsertionPt();
1259 &*R != RelocatedBase; ++R)
1260 if (auto *RI = dyn_cast<GCRelocateInst>(R))
1261 if (RI->getStatepoint() == RelocatedBase->getStatepoint())
1262 if (RI->getBasePtrIndex() == RelocatedBase->getBasePtrIndex()) {
1263 RelocatedBase->moveBefore(RI->getIterator());
1264 MadeChange = true;
1265 break;
1266 }
1267
1268 for (GCRelocateInst *ToReplace : Targets) {
1269 assert(ToReplace->getBasePtrIndex() == RelocatedBase->getBasePtrIndex() &&
1270 "Not relocating a derived object of the original base object");
1271 if (ToReplace->getBasePtrIndex() == ToReplace->getDerivedPtrIndex()) {
1272 // A duplicate relocate call. TODO: coalesce duplicates.
1273 continue;
1274 }
1275
1276 if (RelocatedBase->getParent() != ToReplace->getParent()) {
1277 // Base and derived relocates are in different basic blocks.
1278 // In this case transform is only valid when base dominates derived
1279 // relocate. However it would be too expensive to check dominance
1280 // for each such relocate, so we skip the whole transformation.
1281 continue;
1282 }
1283
1284 Value *Base = ToReplace->getBasePtr();
1285 auto *Derived = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(ToReplace->getDerivedPtr());
1286 if (!Derived || Derived->getPointerOperand() != Base)
1287 continue;
1288
1289 SmallVector<Value *, 2> OffsetV;
1290 if (!getGEPSmallConstantIntOffsetV(Derived, OffsetV))
1291 continue;
1292
1293 // Create a Builder and replace the target callsite with a gep
1294 assert(RelocatedBase->getNextNode() &&
1295 "Should always have one since it's not a terminator");
1296
1297 // Insert after RelocatedBase
1298 IRBuilder<> Builder(RelocatedBase->getNextNode());
1299 Builder.SetCurrentDebugLocation(ToReplace->getDebugLoc());
1300
1301 // If gc_relocate does not match the actual type, cast it to the right type.
1302 // In theory, there must be a bitcast after gc_relocate if the type does not
1303 // match, and we should reuse it to get the derived pointer. But it could be
1304 // cases like this:
1305 // bb1:
1306 // ...
1307 // %g1 = call coldcc i8 addrspace(1)*
1308 // @llvm.experimental.gc.relocate.p1i8(...) br label %merge
1309 //
1310 // bb2:
1311 // ...
1312 // %g2 = call coldcc i8 addrspace(1)*
1313 // @llvm.experimental.gc.relocate.p1i8(...) br label %merge
1314 //
1315 // merge:
1316 // %p1 = phi i8 addrspace(1)* [ %g1, %bb1 ], [ %g2, %bb2 ]
1317 // %cast = bitcast i8 addrspace(1)* %p1 in to i32 addrspace(1)*
1318 //
1319 // In this case, we can not find the bitcast any more. So we insert a new
1320 // bitcast no matter there is already one or not. In this way, we can handle
1321 // all cases, and the extra bitcast should be optimized away in later
1322 // passes.
1323 Value *ActualRelocatedBase = RelocatedBase;
1324 if (RelocatedBase->getType() != Base->getType()) {
1325 ActualRelocatedBase =
1326 Builder.CreateBitCast(RelocatedBase, Base->getType());
1327 }
1328 Value *Replacement =
1329 Builder.CreateGEP(Derived->getSourceElementType(), ActualRelocatedBase,
1330 ArrayRef(OffsetV));
1331 Replacement->takeName(ToReplace);
1332 // If the newly generated derived pointer's type does not match the original
1333 // derived pointer's type, cast the new derived pointer to match it. Same
1334 // reasoning as above.
1335 Value *ActualReplacement = Replacement;
1336 if (Replacement->getType() != ToReplace->getType()) {
1337 ActualReplacement =
1338 Builder.CreateBitCast(Replacement, ToReplace->getType());
1339 }
1340 ToReplace->replaceAllUsesWith(ActualReplacement);
1341 ToReplace->eraseFromParent();
1342
1343 MadeChange = true;
1344 }
1345 return MadeChange;
1346 }
1347
1348 // Turns this:
1349 //
1350 // %base = ...
1351 // %ptr = gep %base + 15
1352 // %tok = statepoint (%fun, i32 0, i32 0, i32 0, %base, %ptr)
1353 // %base' = relocate(%tok, i32 4, i32 4)
1354 // %ptr' = relocate(%tok, i32 4, i32 5)
1355 // %val = load %ptr'
1356 //
1357 // into this:
1358 //
1359 // %base = ...
1360 // %ptr = gep %base + 15
1361 // %tok = statepoint (%fun, i32 0, i32 0, i32 0, %base, %ptr)
1362 // %base' = gc.relocate(%tok, i32 4, i32 4)
1363 // %ptr' = gep %base' + 15
1364 // %val = load %ptr'
simplifyOffsetableRelocate(GCStatepointInst & I)1365 bool CodeGenPrepare::simplifyOffsetableRelocate(GCStatepointInst &I) {
1366 bool MadeChange = false;
1367 SmallVector<GCRelocateInst *, 2> AllRelocateCalls;
1368 for (auto *U : I.users())
1369 if (GCRelocateInst *Relocate = dyn_cast<GCRelocateInst>(U))
1370 // Collect all the relocate calls associated with a statepoint
1371 AllRelocateCalls.push_back(Relocate);
1372
1373 // We need at least one base pointer relocation + one derived pointer
1374 // relocation to mangle
1375 if (AllRelocateCalls.size() < 2)
1376 return false;
1377
1378 // RelocateInstMap is a mapping from the base relocate instruction to the
1379 // corresponding derived relocate instructions
1380 MapVector<GCRelocateInst *, SmallVector<GCRelocateInst *, 0>> RelocateInstMap;
1381 computeBaseDerivedRelocateMap(AllRelocateCalls, RelocateInstMap);
1382 if (RelocateInstMap.empty())
1383 return false;
1384
1385 for (auto &Item : RelocateInstMap)
1386 // Item.first is the RelocatedBase to offset against
1387 // Item.second is the vector of Targets to replace
1388 MadeChange = simplifyRelocatesOffABase(Item.first, Item.second);
1389 return MadeChange;
1390 }
1391
1392 /// Sink the specified cast instruction into its user blocks.
SinkCast(CastInst * CI)1393 static bool SinkCast(CastInst *CI) {
1394 BasicBlock *DefBB = CI->getParent();
1395
1396 /// InsertedCasts - Only insert a cast in each block once.
1397 DenseMap<BasicBlock *, CastInst *> InsertedCasts;
1398
1399 bool MadeChange = false;
1400 for (Value::user_iterator UI = CI->user_begin(), E = CI->user_end();
1401 UI != E;) {
1402 Use &TheUse = UI.getUse();
1403 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI);
1404
1405 // Figure out which BB this cast is used in. For PHI's this is the
1406 // appropriate predecessor block.
1407 BasicBlock *UserBB = User->getParent();
1408 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(User)) {
1409 UserBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(TheUse);
1410 }
1411
1412 // Preincrement use iterator so we don't invalidate it.
1413 ++UI;
1414
1415 // The first insertion point of a block containing an EH pad is after the
1416 // pad. If the pad is the user, we cannot sink the cast past the pad.
1417 if (User->isEHPad())
1418 continue;
1419
1420 // If the block selected to receive the cast is an EH pad that does not
1421 // allow non-PHI instructions before the terminator, we can't sink the
1422 // cast.
1423 if (UserBB->getTerminator()->isEHPad())
1424 continue;
1425
1426 // If this user is in the same block as the cast, don't change the cast.
1427 if (UserBB == DefBB)
1428 continue;
1429
1430 // If we have already inserted a cast into this block, use it.
1431 CastInst *&InsertedCast = InsertedCasts[UserBB];
1432
1433 if (!InsertedCast) {
1434 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPt = UserBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
1435 assert(InsertPt != UserBB->end());
1436 InsertedCast = cast<CastInst>(CI->clone());
1437 InsertedCast->insertBefore(*UserBB, InsertPt);
1438 }
1439
1440 // Replace a use of the cast with a use of the new cast.
1441 TheUse = InsertedCast;
1442 MadeChange = true;
1443 ++NumCastUses;
1444 }
1445
1446 // If we removed all uses, nuke the cast.
1447 if (CI->use_empty()) {
1448 salvageDebugInfo(*CI);
1449 CI->eraseFromParent();
1450 MadeChange = true;
1451 }
1452
1453 return MadeChange;
1454 }
1455
1456 /// If the specified cast instruction is a noop copy (e.g. it's casting from
1457 /// one pointer type to another, i32->i8 on PPC), sink it into user blocks to
1458 /// reduce the number of virtual registers that must be created and coalesced.
1459 ///
1460 /// Return true if any changes are made.
OptimizeNoopCopyExpression(CastInst * CI,const TargetLowering & TLI,const DataLayout & DL)1461 static bool OptimizeNoopCopyExpression(CastInst *CI, const TargetLowering &TLI,
1462 const DataLayout &DL) {
1463 // Sink only "cheap" (or nop) address-space casts. This is a weaker condition
1464 // than sinking only nop casts, but is helpful on some platforms.
1465 if (auto *ASC = dyn_cast<AddrSpaceCastInst>(CI)) {
1466 if (!TLI.isFreeAddrSpaceCast(ASC->getSrcAddressSpace(),
1467 ASC->getDestAddressSpace()))
1468 return false;
1469 }
1470
1471 // If this is a noop copy,
1472 EVT SrcVT = TLI.getValueType(DL, CI->getOperand(0)->getType());
1473 EVT DstVT = TLI.getValueType(DL, CI->getType());
1474
1475 // This is an fp<->int conversion?
1476 if (SrcVT.isInteger() != DstVT.isInteger())
1477 return false;
1478
1479 // If this is an extension, it will be a zero or sign extension, which
1480 // isn't a noop.
1481 if (SrcVT.bitsLT(DstVT))
1482 return false;
1483
1484 // If these values will be promoted, find out what they will be promoted
1485 // to. This helps us consider truncates on PPC as noop copies when they
1486 // are.
1487 if (TLI.getTypeAction(CI->getContext(), SrcVT) ==
1488 TargetLowering::TypePromoteInteger)
1489 SrcVT = TLI.getTypeToTransformTo(CI->getContext(), SrcVT);
1490 if (TLI.getTypeAction(CI->getContext(), DstVT) ==
1491 TargetLowering::TypePromoteInteger)
1492 DstVT = TLI.getTypeToTransformTo(CI->getContext(), DstVT);
1493
1494 // If, after promotion, these are the same types, this is a noop copy.
1495 if (SrcVT != DstVT)
1496 return false;
1497
1498 return SinkCast(CI);
1499 }
1500
1501 // Match a simple increment by constant operation. Note that if a sub is
1502 // matched, the step is negated (as if the step had been canonicalized to
1503 // an add, even though we leave the instruction alone.)
matchIncrement(const Instruction * IVInc,Instruction * & LHS,Constant * & Step)1504 static bool matchIncrement(const Instruction *IVInc, Instruction *&LHS,
1505 Constant *&Step) {
1506 if (match(IVInc, m_Add(m_Instruction(LHS), m_Constant(Step))) ||
1507 match(IVInc, m_ExtractValue<0>(m_Intrinsic<Intrinsic::uadd_with_overflow>(
1508 m_Instruction(LHS), m_Constant(Step)))))
1509 return true;
1510 if (match(IVInc, m_Sub(m_Instruction(LHS), m_Constant(Step))) ||
1511 match(IVInc, m_ExtractValue<0>(m_Intrinsic<Intrinsic::usub_with_overflow>(
1512 m_Instruction(LHS), m_Constant(Step))))) {
1513 Step = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Step);
1514 return true;
1515 }
1516 return false;
1517 }
1518
1519 /// If given \p PN is an inductive variable with value IVInc coming from the
1520 /// backedge, and on each iteration it gets increased by Step, return pair
1521 /// <IVInc, Step>. Otherwise, return std::nullopt.
1522 static std::optional<std::pair<Instruction *, Constant *>>
getIVIncrement(const PHINode * PN,const LoopInfo * LI)1523 getIVIncrement(const PHINode *PN, const LoopInfo *LI) {
1524 const Loop *L = LI->getLoopFor(PN->getParent());
1525 if (!L || L->getHeader() != PN->getParent() || !L->getLoopLatch())
1526 return std::nullopt;
1527 auto *IVInc =
1528 dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN->getIncomingValueForBlock(L->getLoopLatch()));
1529 if (!IVInc || LI->getLoopFor(IVInc->getParent()) != L)
1530 return std::nullopt;
1531 Instruction *LHS = nullptr;
1532 Constant *Step = nullptr;
1533 if (matchIncrement(IVInc, LHS, Step) && LHS == PN)
1534 return std::make_pair(IVInc, Step);
1535 return std::nullopt;
1536 }
1537
isIVIncrement(const Value * V,const LoopInfo * LI)1538 static bool isIVIncrement(const Value *V, const LoopInfo *LI) {
1539 auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1540 if (!I)
1541 return false;
1542 Instruction *LHS = nullptr;
1543 Constant *Step = nullptr;
1544 if (!matchIncrement(I, LHS, Step))
1545 return false;
1546 if (auto *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(LHS))
1547 if (auto IVInc = getIVIncrement(PN, LI))
1548 return IVInc->first == I;
1549 return false;
1550 }
1551
replaceMathCmpWithIntrinsic(BinaryOperator * BO,Value * Arg0,Value * Arg1,CmpInst * Cmp,Intrinsic::ID IID)1552 bool CodeGenPrepare::replaceMathCmpWithIntrinsic(BinaryOperator *BO,
1553 Value *Arg0, Value *Arg1,
1554 CmpInst *Cmp,
1555 Intrinsic::ID IID) {
1556 auto IsReplacableIVIncrement = [this, &Cmp](BinaryOperator *BO) {
1557 if (!isIVIncrement(BO, LI))
1558 return false;
1559 const Loop *L = LI->getLoopFor(BO->getParent());
1560 assert(L && "L should not be null after isIVIncrement()");
1561 // Do not risk on moving increment into a child loop.
1562 if (LI->getLoopFor(Cmp->getParent()) != L)
1563 return false;
1564
1565 // Finally, we need to ensure that the insert point will dominate all
1566 // existing uses of the increment.
1567
1568 auto &DT = getDT(*BO->getParent()->getParent());
1569 if (DT.dominates(Cmp->getParent(), BO->getParent()))
1570 // If we're moving up the dom tree, all uses are trivially dominated.
1571 // (This is the common case for code produced by LSR.)
1572 return true;
1573
1574 // Otherwise, special case the single use in the phi recurrence.
1575 return BO->hasOneUse() && DT.dominates(Cmp->getParent(), L->getLoopLatch());
1576 };
1577 if (BO->getParent() != Cmp->getParent() && !IsReplacableIVIncrement(BO)) {
1578 // We used to use a dominator tree here to allow multi-block optimization.
1579 // But that was problematic because:
1580 // 1. It could cause a perf regression by hoisting the math op into the
1581 // critical path.
1582 // 2. It could cause a perf regression by creating a value that was live
1583 // across multiple blocks and increasing register pressure.
1584 // 3. Use of a dominator tree could cause large compile-time regression.
1585 // This is because we recompute the DT on every change in the main CGP
1586 // run-loop. The recomputing is probably unnecessary in many cases, so if
1587 // that was fixed, using a DT here would be ok.
1588 //
1589 // There is one important particular case we still want to handle: if BO is
1590 // the IV increment. Important properties that make it profitable:
1591 // - We can speculate IV increment anywhere in the loop (as long as the
1592 // indvar Phi is its only user);
1593 // - Upon computing Cmp, we effectively compute something equivalent to the
1594 // IV increment (despite it loops differently in the IR). So moving it up
1595 // to the cmp point does not really increase register pressure.
1596 return false;
1597 }
1598
1599 // We allow matching the canonical IR (add X, C) back to (usubo X, -C).
1600 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
1601 IID == Intrinsic::usub_with_overflow) {
1602 assert(isa<Constant>(Arg1) && "Unexpected input for usubo");
1603 Arg1 = ConstantExpr::getNeg(cast<Constant>(Arg1));
1604 }
1605
1606 // Insert at the first instruction of the pair.
1607 Instruction *InsertPt = nullptr;
1608 for (Instruction &Iter : *Cmp->getParent()) {
1609 // If BO is an XOR, it is not guaranteed that it comes after both inputs to
1610 // the overflow intrinsic are defined.
1611 if ((BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::Xor && &Iter == BO) || &Iter == Cmp) {
1612 InsertPt = &Iter;
1613 break;
1614 }
1615 }
1616 assert(InsertPt != nullptr && "Parent block did not contain cmp or binop");
1617
1618 IRBuilder<> Builder(InsertPt);
1619 Value *MathOV = Builder.CreateBinaryIntrinsic(IID, Arg0, Arg1);
1620 if (BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::Xor) {
1621 Value *Math = Builder.CreateExtractValue(MathOV, 0, "math");
1622 replaceAllUsesWith(BO, Math, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
1623 } else
1624 assert(BO->hasOneUse() &&
1625 "Patterns with XOr should use the BO only in the compare");
1626 Value *OV = Builder.CreateExtractValue(MathOV, 1, "ov");
1627 replaceAllUsesWith(Cmp, OV, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
1628 Cmp->eraseFromParent();
1629 BO->eraseFromParent();
1630 return true;
1631 }
1632
1633 /// Match special-case patterns that check for unsigned add overflow.
matchUAddWithOverflowConstantEdgeCases(CmpInst * Cmp,BinaryOperator * & Add)1634 static bool matchUAddWithOverflowConstantEdgeCases(CmpInst *Cmp,
1635 BinaryOperator *&Add) {
1636 // Add = add A, 1; Cmp = icmp eq A,-1 (overflow if A is max val)
1637 // Add = add A,-1; Cmp = icmp ne A, 0 (overflow if A is non-zero)
1638 Value *A = Cmp->getOperand(0), *B = Cmp->getOperand(1);
1639
1640 // We are not expecting non-canonical/degenerate code. Just bail out.
1641 if (isa<Constant>(A))
1642 return false;
1643
1644 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = Cmp->getPredicate();
1645 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ && match(B, m_AllOnes()))
1646 B = ConstantInt::get(B->getType(), 1);
1647 else if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE && match(B, m_ZeroInt()))
1648 B = Constant::getAllOnesValue(B->getType());
1649 else
1650 return false;
1651
1652 // Check the users of the variable operand of the compare looking for an add
1653 // with the adjusted constant.
1654 for (User *U : A->users()) {
1655 if (match(U, m_Add(m_Specific(A), m_Specific(B)))) {
1656 Add = cast<BinaryOperator>(U);
1657 return true;
1658 }
1659 }
1660 return false;
1661 }
1662
1663 /// Try to combine the compare into a call to the llvm.uadd.with.overflow
1664 /// intrinsic. Return true if any changes were made.
combineToUAddWithOverflow(CmpInst * Cmp,ModifyDT & ModifiedDT)1665 bool CodeGenPrepare::combineToUAddWithOverflow(CmpInst *Cmp,
1666 ModifyDT &ModifiedDT) {
1667 bool EdgeCase = false;
1668 Value *A, *B;
1669 BinaryOperator *Add;
1670 if (!match(Cmp, m_UAddWithOverflow(m_Value(A), m_Value(B), m_BinOp(Add)))) {
1671 if (!matchUAddWithOverflowConstantEdgeCases(Cmp, Add))
1672 return false;
1673 // Set A and B in case we match matchUAddWithOverflowConstantEdgeCases.
1674 A = Add->getOperand(0);
1675 B = Add->getOperand(1);
1676 EdgeCase = true;
1677 }
1678
1679 if (!TLI->shouldFormOverflowOp(ISD::UADDO,
1680 TLI->getValueType(*DL, Add->getType()),
1681 Add->hasNUsesOrMore(EdgeCase ? 1 : 2)))
1682 return false;
1683
1684 // We don't want to move around uses of condition values this late, so we
1685 // check if it is legal to create the call to the intrinsic in the basic
1686 // block containing the icmp.
1687 if (Add->getParent() != Cmp->getParent() && !Add->hasOneUse())
1688 return false;
1689
1690 if (!replaceMathCmpWithIntrinsic(Add, A, B, Cmp,
1691 Intrinsic::uadd_with_overflow))
1692 return false;
1693
1694 // Reset callers - do not crash by iterating over a dead instruction.
1695 ModifiedDT = ModifyDT::ModifyInstDT;
1696 return true;
1697 }
1698
combineToUSubWithOverflow(CmpInst * Cmp,ModifyDT & ModifiedDT)1699 bool CodeGenPrepare::combineToUSubWithOverflow(CmpInst *Cmp,
1700 ModifyDT &ModifiedDT) {
1701 // We are not expecting non-canonical/degenerate code. Just bail out.
1702 Value *A = Cmp->getOperand(0), *B = Cmp->getOperand(1);
1703 if (isa<Constant>(A) && isa<Constant>(B))
1704 return false;
1705
1706 // Convert (A u> B) to (A u< B) to simplify pattern matching.
1707 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = Cmp->getPredicate();
1708 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT) {
1709 std::swap(A, B);
1710 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
1711 }
1712 // Convert special-case: (A == 0) is the same as (A u< 1).
1713 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ && match(B, m_ZeroInt())) {
1714 B = ConstantInt::get(B->getType(), 1);
1715 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
1716 }
1717 // Convert special-case: (A != 0) is the same as (0 u< A).
1718 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE && match(B, m_ZeroInt())) {
1719 std::swap(A, B);
1720 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
1721 }
1722 if (Pred != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT)
1723 return false;
1724
1725 // Walk the users of a variable operand of a compare looking for a subtract or
1726 // add with that same operand. Also match the 2nd operand of the compare to
1727 // the add/sub, but that may be a negated constant operand of an add.
1728 Value *CmpVariableOperand = isa<Constant>(A) ? B : A;
1729 BinaryOperator *Sub = nullptr;
1730 for (User *U : CmpVariableOperand->users()) {
1731 // A - B, A u< B --> usubo(A, B)
1732 if (match(U, m_Sub(m_Specific(A), m_Specific(B)))) {
1733 Sub = cast<BinaryOperator>(U);
1734 break;
1735 }
1736
1737 // A + (-C), A u< C (canonicalized form of (sub A, C))
1738 const APInt *CmpC, *AddC;
1739 if (match(U, m_Add(m_Specific(A), m_APInt(AddC))) &&
1740 match(B, m_APInt(CmpC)) && *AddC == -(*CmpC)) {
1741 Sub = cast<BinaryOperator>(U);
1742 break;
1743 }
1744 }
1745 if (!Sub)
1746 return false;
1747
1748 if (!TLI->shouldFormOverflowOp(ISD::USUBO,
1749 TLI->getValueType(*DL, Sub->getType()),
1750 Sub->hasNUsesOrMore(1)))
1751 return false;
1752
1753 if (!replaceMathCmpWithIntrinsic(Sub, Sub->getOperand(0), Sub->getOperand(1),
1754 Cmp, Intrinsic::usub_with_overflow))
1755 return false;
1756
1757 // Reset callers - do not crash by iterating over a dead instruction.
1758 ModifiedDT = ModifyDT::ModifyInstDT;
1759 return true;
1760 }
1761
1762 // Decanonicalizes icmp+ctpop power-of-two test if ctpop is slow.
1763 // The same transformation exists in DAG combiner, but we repeat it here because
1764 // DAG builder can break the pattern by moving icmp into a successor block.
unfoldPowerOf2Test(CmpInst * Cmp)1765 bool CodeGenPrepare::unfoldPowerOf2Test(CmpInst *Cmp) {
1766 CmpPredicate Pred;
1767 Value *X;
1768 const APInt *C;
1769
1770 // (icmp (ctpop x), c)
1771 if (!match(Cmp, m_ICmp(Pred, m_Intrinsic<Intrinsic::ctpop>(m_Value(X)),
1772 m_APIntAllowPoison(C))))
1773 return false;
1774
1775 // We're only interested in "is power of 2 [or zero]" patterns.
1776 bool IsStrictlyPowerOf2Test = ICmpInst::isEquality(Pred) && *C == 1;
1777 bool IsPowerOf2OrZeroTest = (Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_ULT && *C == 2) ||
1778 (Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_UGT && *C == 1);
1779 if (!IsStrictlyPowerOf2Test && !IsPowerOf2OrZeroTest)
1780 return false;
1781
1782 // Some targets have better codegen for `ctpop(x) u</u>= 2/1`than for
1783 // `ctpop(x) ==/!= 1`. If ctpop is fast, only try changing the comparison,
1784 // and otherwise expand ctpop into a few simple instructions.
1785 Type *OpTy = X->getType();
1786 if (TLI->isCtpopFast(TLI->getValueType(*DL, OpTy))) {
1787 // Look for `ctpop(x) ==/!= 1`, where `ctpop(x)` is known to be non-zero.
1788 if (!IsStrictlyPowerOf2Test || !isKnownNonZero(Cmp->getOperand(0), *DL))
1789 return false;
1790
1791 // ctpop(x) == 1 -> ctpop(x) u< 2
1792 // ctpop(x) != 1 -> ctpop(x) u> 1
1793 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ) {
1794 Cmp->setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(OpTy, 2));
1795 Cmp->setPredicate(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
1796 } else {
1797 Cmp->setPredicate(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
1798 }
1799 return true;
1800 }
1801
1802 Value *NewCmp;
1803 if (IsPowerOf2OrZeroTest ||
1804 (IsStrictlyPowerOf2Test && isKnownNonZero(Cmp->getOperand(0), *DL))) {
1805 // ctpop(x) u< 2 -> (x & (x - 1)) == 0
1806 // ctpop(x) u> 1 -> (x & (x - 1)) != 0
1807 IRBuilder<> Builder(Cmp);
1808 Value *Sub = Builder.CreateAdd(X, Constant::getAllOnesValue(OpTy));
1809 Value *And = Builder.CreateAnd(X, Sub);
1810 CmpInst::Predicate NewPred =
1811 (Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_ULT || Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
1812 ? CmpInst::ICMP_EQ
1813 : CmpInst::ICMP_NE;
1814 NewCmp = Builder.CreateICmp(NewPred, And, ConstantInt::getNullValue(OpTy));
1815 } else {
1816 // ctpop(x) == 1 -> (x ^ (x - 1)) u> (x - 1)
1817 // ctpop(x) != 1 -> (x ^ (x - 1)) u<= (x - 1)
1818 IRBuilder<> Builder(Cmp);
1819 Value *Sub = Builder.CreateAdd(X, Constant::getAllOnesValue(OpTy));
1820 Value *Xor = Builder.CreateXor(X, Sub);
1821 CmpInst::Predicate NewPred =
1822 Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_EQ ? CmpInst::ICMP_UGT : CmpInst::ICMP_ULE;
1823 NewCmp = Builder.CreateICmp(NewPred, Xor, Sub);
1824 }
1825
1826 Cmp->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCmp);
1827 RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(Cmp);
1828 return true;
1829 }
1830
1831 /// Sink the given CmpInst into user blocks to reduce the number of virtual
1832 /// registers that must be created and coalesced. This is a clear win except on
1833 /// targets with multiple condition code registers (PowerPC), where it might
1834 /// lose; some adjustment may be wanted there.
1835 ///
1836 /// Return true if any changes are made.
sinkCmpExpression(CmpInst * Cmp,const TargetLowering & TLI)1837 static bool sinkCmpExpression(CmpInst *Cmp, const TargetLowering &TLI) {
1838 if (TLI.hasMultipleConditionRegisters())
1839 return false;
1840
1841 // Avoid sinking soft-FP comparisons, since this can move them into a loop.
1842 if (TLI.useSoftFloat() && isa<FCmpInst>(Cmp))
1843 return false;
1844
1845 // Only insert a cmp in each block once.
1846 DenseMap<BasicBlock *, CmpInst *> InsertedCmps;
1847
1848 bool MadeChange = false;
1849 for (Value::user_iterator UI = Cmp->user_begin(), E = Cmp->user_end();
1850 UI != E;) {
1851 Use &TheUse = UI.getUse();
1852 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI);
1853
1854 // Preincrement use iterator so we don't invalidate it.
1855 ++UI;
1856
1857 // Don't bother for PHI nodes.
1858 if (isa<PHINode>(User))
1859 continue;
1860
1861 // Figure out which BB this cmp is used in.
1862 BasicBlock *UserBB = User->getParent();
1863 BasicBlock *DefBB = Cmp->getParent();
1864
1865 // If this user is in the same block as the cmp, don't change the cmp.
1866 if (UserBB == DefBB)
1867 continue;
1868
1869 // If we have already inserted a cmp into this block, use it.
1870 CmpInst *&InsertedCmp = InsertedCmps[UserBB];
1871
1872 if (!InsertedCmp) {
1873 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPt = UserBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
1874 assert(InsertPt != UserBB->end());
1875 InsertedCmp = CmpInst::Create(Cmp->getOpcode(), Cmp->getPredicate(),
1876 Cmp->getOperand(0), Cmp->getOperand(1), "");
1877 InsertedCmp->insertBefore(*UserBB, InsertPt);
1878 // Propagate the debug info.
1879 InsertedCmp->setDebugLoc(Cmp->getDebugLoc());
1880 }
1881
1882 // Replace a use of the cmp with a use of the new cmp.
1883 TheUse = InsertedCmp;
1884 MadeChange = true;
1885 ++NumCmpUses;
1886 }
1887
1888 // If we removed all uses, nuke the cmp.
1889 if (Cmp->use_empty()) {
1890 Cmp->eraseFromParent();
1891 MadeChange = true;
1892 }
1893
1894 return MadeChange;
1895 }
1896
1897 /// For pattern like:
1898 ///
1899 /// DomCond = icmp sgt/slt CmpOp0, CmpOp1 (might not be in DomBB)
1900 /// ...
1901 /// DomBB:
1902 /// ...
1903 /// br DomCond, TrueBB, CmpBB
1904 /// CmpBB: (with DomBB being the single predecessor)
1905 /// ...
1906 /// Cmp = icmp eq CmpOp0, CmpOp1
1907 /// ...
1908 ///
1909 /// It would use two comparison on targets that lowering of icmp sgt/slt is
1910 /// different from lowering of icmp eq (PowerPC). This function try to convert
1911 /// 'Cmp = icmp eq CmpOp0, CmpOp1' to ' Cmp = icmp slt/sgt CmpOp0, CmpOp1'.
1912 /// After that, DomCond and Cmp can use the same comparison so reduce one
1913 /// comparison.
1914 ///
1915 /// Return true if any changes are made.
foldICmpWithDominatingICmp(CmpInst * Cmp,const TargetLowering & TLI)1916 static bool foldICmpWithDominatingICmp(CmpInst *Cmp,
1917 const TargetLowering &TLI) {
1918 if (!EnableICMP_EQToICMP_ST && TLI.isEqualityCmpFoldedWithSignedCmp())
1919 return false;
1920
1921 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = Cmp->getPredicate();
1922 if (Pred != ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
1923 return false;
1924
1925 // If icmp eq has users other than BranchInst and SelectInst, converting it to
1926 // icmp slt/sgt would introduce more redundant LLVM IR.
1927 for (User *U : Cmp->users()) {
1928 if (isa<BranchInst>(U))
1929 continue;
1930 if (isa<SelectInst>(U) && cast<SelectInst>(U)->getCondition() == Cmp)
1931 continue;
1932 return false;
1933 }
1934
1935 // This is a cheap/incomplete check for dominance - just match a single
1936 // predecessor with a conditional branch.
1937 BasicBlock *CmpBB = Cmp->getParent();
1938 BasicBlock *DomBB = CmpBB->getSinglePredecessor();
1939 if (!DomBB)
1940 return false;
1941
1942 // We want to ensure that the only way control gets to the comparison of
1943 // interest is that a less/greater than comparison on the same operands is
1944 // false.
1945 Value *DomCond;
1946 BasicBlock *TrueBB, *FalseBB;
1947 if (!match(DomBB->getTerminator(), m_Br(m_Value(DomCond), TrueBB, FalseBB)))
1948 return false;
1949 if (CmpBB != FalseBB)
1950 return false;
1951
1952 Value *CmpOp0 = Cmp->getOperand(0), *CmpOp1 = Cmp->getOperand(1);
1953 CmpPredicate DomPred;
1954 if (!match(DomCond, m_ICmp(DomPred, m_Specific(CmpOp0), m_Specific(CmpOp1))))
1955 return false;
1956 if (DomPred != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && DomPred != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
1957 return false;
1958
1959 // Convert the equality comparison to the opposite of the dominating
1960 // comparison and swap the direction for all branch/select users.
1961 // We have conceptually converted:
1962 // Res = (a < b) ? <LT_RES> : (a == b) ? <EQ_RES> : <GT_RES>;
1963 // to
1964 // Res = (a < b) ? <LT_RES> : (a > b) ? <GT_RES> : <EQ_RES>;
1965 // And similarly for branches.
1966 for (User *U : Cmp->users()) {
1967 if (auto *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(U)) {
1968 assert(BI->isConditional() && "Must be conditional");
1969 BI->swapSuccessors();
1970 continue;
1971 }
1972 if (auto *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(U)) {
1973 // Swap operands
1974 SI->swapValues();
1975 SI->swapProfMetadata();
1976 continue;
1977 }
1978 llvm_unreachable("Must be a branch or a select");
1979 }
1980 Cmp->setPredicate(CmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(DomPred));
1981 return true;
1982 }
1983
1984 /// Many architectures use the same instruction for both subtract and cmp. Try
1985 /// to swap cmp operands to match subtract operations to allow for CSE.
swapICmpOperandsToExposeCSEOpportunities(CmpInst * Cmp)1986 static bool swapICmpOperandsToExposeCSEOpportunities(CmpInst *Cmp) {
1987 Value *Op0 = Cmp->getOperand(0);
1988 Value *Op1 = Cmp->getOperand(1);
1989 if (!Op0->getType()->isIntegerTy() || isa<Constant>(Op0) ||
1990 isa<Constant>(Op1) || Op0 == Op1)
1991 return false;
1992
1993 // If a subtract already has the same operands as a compare, swapping would be
1994 // bad. If a subtract has the same operands as a compare but in reverse order,
1995 // then swapping is good.
1996 int GoodToSwap = 0;
1997 unsigned NumInspected = 0;
1998 for (const User *U : Op0->users()) {
1999 // Avoid walking many users.
2000 if (++NumInspected > 128)
2001 return false;
2002 if (match(U, m_Sub(m_Specific(Op1), m_Specific(Op0))))
2003 GoodToSwap++;
2004 else if (match(U, m_Sub(m_Specific(Op0), m_Specific(Op1))))
2005 GoodToSwap--;
2006 }
2007
2008 if (GoodToSwap > 0) {
2009 Cmp->swapOperands();
2010 return true;
2011 }
2012 return false;
2013 }
2014
foldFCmpToFPClassTest(CmpInst * Cmp,const TargetLowering & TLI,const DataLayout & DL)2015 static bool foldFCmpToFPClassTest(CmpInst *Cmp, const TargetLowering &TLI,
2016 const DataLayout &DL) {
2017 FCmpInst *FCmp = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Cmp);
2018 if (!FCmp)
2019 return false;
2020
2021 // Don't fold if the target offers free fabs and the predicate is legal.
2022 EVT VT = TLI.getValueType(DL, Cmp->getOperand(0)->getType());
2023 if (TLI.isFAbsFree(VT) &&
2024 TLI.isCondCodeLegal(getFCmpCondCode(FCmp->getPredicate()),
2025 VT.getSimpleVT()))
2026 return false;
2027
2028 // Reverse the canonicalization if it is a FP class test
2029 auto ShouldReverseTransform = [](FPClassTest ClassTest) {
2030 return ClassTest == fcInf || ClassTest == (fcInf | fcNan);
2031 };
2032 auto [ClassVal, ClassTest] =
2033 fcmpToClassTest(FCmp->getPredicate(), *FCmp->getParent()->getParent(),
2034 FCmp->getOperand(0), FCmp->getOperand(1));
2035 if (!ClassVal)
2036 return false;
2037
2038 if (!ShouldReverseTransform(ClassTest) && !ShouldReverseTransform(~ClassTest))
2039 return false;
2040
2041 IRBuilder<> Builder(Cmp);
2042 Value *IsFPClass = Builder.createIsFPClass(ClassVal, ClassTest);
2043 Cmp->replaceAllUsesWith(IsFPClass);
2044 RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(Cmp);
2045 return true;
2046 }
2047
isRemOfLoopIncrementWithLoopInvariant(Instruction * Rem,const LoopInfo * LI,Value * & RemAmtOut,Value * & AddInstOut,Value * & AddOffsetOut,PHINode * & LoopIncrPNOut)2048 static bool isRemOfLoopIncrementWithLoopInvariant(
2049 Instruction *Rem, const LoopInfo *LI, Value *&RemAmtOut, Value *&AddInstOut,
2050 Value *&AddOffsetOut, PHINode *&LoopIncrPNOut) {
2051 Value *Incr, *RemAmt;
2052 // NB: If RemAmt is a power of 2 it *should* have been transformed by now.
2053 if (!match(Rem, m_URem(m_Value(Incr), m_Value(RemAmt))))
2054 return false;
2055
2056 Value *AddInst, *AddOffset;
2057 // Find out loop increment PHI.
2058 auto *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Incr);
2059 if (PN != nullptr) {
2060 AddInst = nullptr;
2061 AddOffset = nullptr;
2062 } else {
2063 // Search through a NUW add on top of the loop increment.
2064 Value *V0, *V1;
2065 if (!match(Incr, m_NUWAdd(m_Value(V0), m_Value(V1))))
2066 return false;
2067
2068 AddInst = Incr;
2069 PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V0);
2070 if (PN != nullptr) {
2071 AddOffset = V1;
2072 } else {
2073 PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V1);
2074 AddOffset = V0;
2075 }
2076 }
2077
2078 if (!PN)
2079 return false;
2080
2081 // This isn't strictly necessary, what we really need is one increment and any
2082 // amount of initial values all being the same.
2083 if (PN->getNumIncomingValues() != 2)
2084 return false;
2085
2086 // Only trivially analyzable loops.
2087 Loop *L = LI->getLoopFor(PN->getParent());
2088 if (!L || !L->getLoopPreheader() || !L->getLoopLatch())
2089 return false;
2090
2091 // Req that the remainder is in the loop
2092 if (!L->contains(Rem))
2093 return false;
2094
2095 // Only works if the remainder amount is a loop invaraint
2096 if (!L->isLoopInvariant(RemAmt))
2097 return false;
2098
2099 // Only works if the AddOffset is a loop invaraint
2100 if (AddOffset && !L->isLoopInvariant(AddOffset))
2101 return false;
2102
2103 // Is the PHI a loop increment?
2104 auto LoopIncrInfo = getIVIncrement(PN, LI);
2105 if (!LoopIncrInfo)
2106 return false;
2107
2108 // We need remainder_amount % increment_amount to be zero. Increment of one
2109 // satisfies that without any special logic and is overwhelmingly the common
2110 // case.
2111 if (!match(LoopIncrInfo->second, m_One()))
2112 return false;
2113
2114 // Need the increment to not overflow.
2115 if (!match(LoopIncrInfo->first, m_c_NUWAdd(m_Specific(PN), m_Value())))
2116 return false;
2117
2118 // Set output variables.
2119 RemAmtOut = RemAmt;
2120 LoopIncrPNOut = PN;
2121 AddInstOut = AddInst;
2122 AddOffsetOut = AddOffset;
2123
2124 return true;
2125 }
2126
2127 // Try to transform:
2128 //
2129 // for(i = Start; i < End; ++i)
2130 // Rem = (i nuw+ IncrLoopInvariant) u% RemAmtLoopInvariant;
2131 //
2132 // ->
2133 //
2134 // Rem = (Start nuw+ IncrLoopInvariant) % RemAmtLoopInvariant;
2135 // for(i = Start; i < End; ++i, ++rem)
2136 // Rem = rem == RemAmtLoopInvariant ? 0 : Rem;
foldURemOfLoopIncrement(Instruction * Rem,const DataLayout * DL,const LoopInfo * LI,SmallSet<BasicBlock *,32> & FreshBBs,bool IsHuge)2137 static bool foldURemOfLoopIncrement(Instruction *Rem, const DataLayout *DL,
2138 const LoopInfo *LI,
2139 SmallSet<BasicBlock *, 32> &FreshBBs,
2140 bool IsHuge) {
2141 Value *AddOffset, *RemAmt, *AddInst;
2142 PHINode *LoopIncrPN;
2143 if (!isRemOfLoopIncrementWithLoopInvariant(Rem, LI, RemAmt, AddInst,
2144 AddOffset, LoopIncrPN))
2145 return false;
2146
2147 // Only non-constant remainder as the extra IV is probably not profitable
2148 // in that case.
2149 //
2150 // Potential TODO(1): `urem` of a const ends up as `mul` + `shift` + `add`. If
2151 // we can rule out register pressure and ensure this `urem` is executed each
2152 // iteration, its probably profitable to handle the const case as well.
2153 //
2154 // Potential TODO(2): Should we have a check for how "nested" this remainder
2155 // operation is? The new code runs every iteration so if the remainder is
2156 // guarded behind unlikely conditions this might not be worth it.
2157 if (match(RemAmt, m_ImmConstant()))
2158 return false;
2159
2160 Loop *L = LI->getLoopFor(LoopIncrPN->getParent());
2161 Value *Start = LoopIncrPN->getIncomingValueForBlock(L->getLoopPreheader());
2162 // If we have add create initial value for remainder.
2163 // The logic here is:
2164 // (urem (add nuw Start, IncrLoopInvariant), RemAmtLoopInvariant
2165 //
2166 // Only proceed if the expression simplifies (otherwise we can't fully
2167 // optimize out the urem).
2168 if (AddInst) {
2169 assert(AddOffset && "We found an add but missing values");
2170 // Without dom-condition/assumption cache we aren't likely to get much out
2171 // of a context instruction.
2172 Start = simplifyAddInst(Start, AddOffset,
2173 match(AddInst, m_NSWAdd(m_Value(), m_Value())),
2174 /*IsNUW=*/true, *DL);
2175 if (!Start)
2176 return false;
2177 }
2178
2179 // If we can't fully optimize out the `rem`, skip this transform.
2180 Start = simplifyURemInst(Start, RemAmt, *DL);
2181 if (!Start)
2182 return false;
2183
2184 // Create new remainder with induction variable.
2185 Type *Ty = Rem->getType();
2186 IRBuilder<> Builder(Rem->getContext());
2187
2188 Builder.SetInsertPoint(LoopIncrPN);
2189 PHINode *NewRem = Builder.CreatePHI(Ty, 2);
2190
2191 Builder.SetInsertPoint(cast<Instruction>(
2192 LoopIncrPN->getIncomingValueForBlock(L->getLoopLatch())));
2193 // `(add (urem x, y), 1)` is always nuw.
2194 Value *RemAdd = Builder.CreateNUWAdd(NewRem, ConstantInt::get(Ty, 1));
2195 Value *RemCmp = Builder.CreateICmp(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, RemAdd, RemAmt);
2196 Value *RemSel =
2197 Builder.CreateSelect(RemCmp, Constant::getNullValue(Ty), RemAdd);
2198
2199 NewRem->addIncoming(Start, L->getLoopPreheader());
2200 NewRem->addIncoming(RemSel, L->getLoopLatch());
2201
2202 // Insert all touched BBs.
2203 FreshBBs.insert(LoopIncrPN->getParent());
2204 FreshBBs.insert(L->getLoopLatch());
2205 FreshBBs.insert(Rem->getParent());
2206 if (AddInst)
2207 FreshBBs.insert(cast<Instruction>(AddInst)->getParent());
2208 replaceAllUsesWith(Rem, NewRem, FreshBBs, IsHuge);
2209 Rem->eraseFromParent();
2210 if (AddInst && AddInst->use_empty())
2211 cast<Instruction>(AddInst)->eraseFromParent();
2212 return true;
2213 }
2214
optimizeURem(Instruction * Rem)2215 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeURem(Instruction *Rem) {
2216 if (foldURemOfLoopIncrement(Rem, DL, LI, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc))
2217 return true;
2218 return false;
2219 }
2220
optimizeCmp(CmpInst * Cmp,ModifyDT & ModifiedDT)2221 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeCmp(CmpInst *Cmp, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT) {
2222 if (sinkCmpExpression(Cmp, *TLI))
2223 return true;
2224
2225 if (combineToUAddWithOverflow(Cmp, ModifiedDT))
2226 return true;
2227
2228 if (combineToUSubWithOverflow(Cmp, ModifiedDT))
2229 return true;
2230
2231 if (unfoldPowerOf2Test(Cmp))
2232 return true;
2233
2234 if (foldICmpWithDominatingICmp(Cmp, *TLI))
2235 return true;
2236
2237 if (swapICmpOperandsToExposeCSEOpportunities(Cmp))
2238 return true;
2239
2240 if (foldFCmpToFPClassTest(Cmp, *TLI, *DL))
2241 return true;
2242
2243 return false;
2244 }
2245
2246 /// Duplicate and sink the given 'and' instruction into user blocks where it is
2247 /// used in a compare to allow isel to generate better code for targets where
2248 /// this operation can be combined.
2249 ///
2250 /// Return true if any changes are made.
sinkAndCmp0Expression(Instruction * AndI,const TargetLowering & TLI,SetOfInstrs & InsertedInsts)2251 static bool sinkAndCmp0Expression(Instruction *AndI, const TargetLowering &TLI,
2252 SetOfInstrs &InsertedInsts) {
2253 // Double-check that we're not trying to optimize an instruction that was
2254 // already optimized by some other part of this pass.
2255 assert(!InsertedInsts.count(AndI) &&
2256 "Attempting to optimize already optimized and instruction");
2257 (void)InsertedInsts;
2258
2259 // Nothing to do for single use in same basic block.
2260 if (AndI->hasOneUse() &&
2261 AndI->getParent() == cast<Instruction>(*AndI->user_begin())->getParent())
2262 return false;
2263
2264 // Try to avoid cases where sinking/duplicating is likely to increase register
2265 // pressure.
2266 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(AndI->getOperand(0)) &&
2267 !isa<ConstantInt>(AndI->getOperand(1)) &&
2268 AndI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && AndI->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse())
2269 return false;
2270
2271 for (auto *U : AndI->users()) {
2272 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(U);
2273
2274 // Only sink 'and' feeding icmp with 0.
2275 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(User))
2276 return false;
2277
2278 auto *CmpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(User->getOperand(1));
2279 if (!CmpC || !CmpC->isZero())
2280 return false;
2281 }
2282
2283 if (!TLI.isMaskAndCmp0FoldingBeneficial(*AndI))
2284 return false;
2285
2286 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "found 'and' feeding only icmp 0;\n");
2287 LLVM_DEBUG(AndI->getParent()->dump());
2288
2289 // Push the 'and' into the same block as the icmp 0. There should only be
2290 // one (icmp (and, 0)) in each block, since CSE/GVN should have removed any
2291 // others, so we don't need to keep track of which BBs we insert into.
2292 for (Value::user_iterator UI = AndI->user_begin(), E = AndI->user_end();
2293 UI != E;) {
2294 Use &TheUse = UI.getUse();
2295 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI);
2296
2297 // Preincrement use iterator so we don't invalidate it.
2298 ++UI;
2299
2300 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "sinking 'and' use: " << *User << "\n");
2301
2302 // Keep the 'and' in the same place if the use is already in the same block.
2303 Instruction *InsertPt =
2304 User->getParent() == AndI->getParent() ? AndI : User;
2305 Instruction *InsertedAnd = BinaryOperator::Create(
2306 Instruction::And, AndI->getOperand(0), AndI->getOperand(1), "",
2307 InsertPt->getIterator());
2308 // Propagate the debug info.
2309 InsertedAnd->setDebugLoc(AndI->getDebugLoc());
2310
2311 // Replace a use of the 'and' with a use of the new 'and'.
2312 TheUse = InsertedAnd;
2313 ++NumAndUses;
2314 LLVM_DEBUG(User->getParent()->dump());
2315 }
2316
2317 // We removed all uses, nuke the and.
2318 AndI->eraseFromParent();
2319 return true;
2320 }
2321
2322 /// Check if the candidates could be combined with a shift instruction, which
2323 /// includes:
2324 /// 1. Truncate instruction
2325 /// 2. And instruction and the imm is a mask of the low bits:
2326 /// imm & (imm+1) == 0
isExtractBitsCandidateUse(Instruction * User)2327 static bool isExtractBitsCandidateUse(Instruction *User) {
2328 if (!isa<TruncInst>(User)) {
2329 if (User->getOpcode() != Instruction::And ||
2330 !isa<ConstantInt>(User->getOperand(1)))
2331 return false;
2332
2333 const APInt &Cimm = cast<ConstantInt>(User->getOperand(1))->getValue();
2334
2335 if ((Cimm & (Cimm + 1)).getBoolValue())
2336 return false;
2337 }
2338 return true;
2339 }
2340
2341 /// Sink both shift and truncate instruction to the use of truncate's BB.
2342 static bool
SinkShiftAndTruncate(BinaryOperator * ShiftI,Instruction * User,ConstantInt * CI,DenseMap<BasicBlock *,BinaryOperator * > & InsertedShifts,const TargetLowering & TLI,const DataLayout & DL)2343 SinkShiftAndTruncate(BinaryOperator *ShiftI, Instruction *User, ConstantInt *CI,
2344 DenseMap<BasicBlock *, BinaryOperator *> &InsertedShifts,
2345 const TargetLowering &TLI, const DataLayout &DL) {
2346 BasicBlock *UserBB = User->getParent();
2347 DenseMap<BasicBlock *, CastInst *> InsertedTruncs;
2348 auto *TruncI = cast<TruncInst>(User);
2349 bool MadeChange = false;
2350
2351 for (Value::user_iterator TruncUI = TruncI->user_begin(),
2352 TruncE = TruncI->user_end();
2353 TruncUI != TruncE;) {
2354
2355 Use &TruncTheUse = TruncUI.getUse();
2356 Instruction *TruncUser = cast<Instruction>(*TruncUI);
2357 // Preincrement use iterator so we don't invalidate it.
2358
2359 ++TruncUI;
2360
2361 int ISDOpcode = TLI.InstructionOpcodeToISD(TruncUser->getOpcode());
2362 if (!ISDOpcode)
2363 continue;
2364
2365 // If the use is actually a legal node, there will not be an
2366 // implicit truncate.
2367 // FIXME: always querying the result type is just an
2368 // approximation; some nodes' legality is determined by the
2369 // operand or other means. There's no good way to find out though.
2370 if (TLI.isOperationLegalOrCustom(
2371 ISDOpcode, TLI.getValueType(DL, TruncUser->getType(), true)))
2372 continue;
2373
2374 // Don't bother for PHI nodes.
2375 if (isa<PHINode>(TruncUser))
2376 continue;
2377
2378 BasicBlock *TruncUserBB = TruncUser->getParent();
2379
2380 if (UserBB == TruncUserBB)
2381 continue;
2382
2383 BinaryOperator *&InsertedShift = InsertedShifts[TruncUserBB];
2384 CastInst *&InsertedTrunc = InsertedTruncs[TruncUserBB];
2385
2386 if (!InsertedShift && !InsertedTrunc) {
2387 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPt = TruncUserBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
2388 assert(InsertPt != TruncUserBB->end());
2389 // Sink the shift
2390 if (ShiftI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
2391 InsertedShift =
2392 BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(ShiftI->getOperand(0), CI, "");
2393 else
2394 InsertedShift =
2395 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShiftI->getOperand(0), CI, "");
2396 InsertedShift->setDebugLoc(ShiftI->getDebugLoc());
2397 InsertedShift->insertBefore(*TruncUserBB, InsertPt);
2398
2399 // Sink the trunc
2400 BasicBlock::iterator TruncInsertPt = TruncUserBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
2401 TruncInsertPt++;
2402 // It will go ahead of any debug-info.
2403 TruncInsertPt.setHeadBit(true);
2404 assert(TruncInsertPt != TruncUserBB->end());
2405
2406 InsertedTrunc = CastInst::Create(TruncI->getOpcode(), InsertedShift,
2407 TruncI->getType(), "");
2408 InsertedTrunc->insertBefore(*TruncUserBB, TruncInsertPt);
2409 InsertedTrunc->setDebugLoc(TruncI->getDebugLoc());
2410
2411 MadeChange = true;
2412
2413 TruncTheUse = InsertedTrunc;
2414 }
2415 }
2416 return MadeChange;
2417 }
2418
2419 /// Sink the shift *right* instruction into user blocks if the uses could
2420 /// potentially be combined with this shift instruction and generate BitExtract
2421 /// instruction. It will only be applied if the architecture supports BitExtract
2422 /// instruction. Here is an example:
2423 /// BB1:
2424 /// %x.extract.shift = lshr i64 %arg1, 32
2425 /// BB2:
2426 /// %x.extract.trunc = trunc i64 %x.extract.shift to i16
2427 /// ==>
2428 ///
2429 /// BB2:
2430 /// %x.extract.shift.1 = lshr i64 %arg1, 32
2431 /// %x.extract.trunc = trunc i64 %x.extract.shift.1 to i16
2432 ///
2433 /// CodeGen will recognize the pattern in BB2 and generate BitExtract
2434 /// instruction.
2435 /// Return true if any changes are made.
OptimizeExtractBits(BinaryOperator * ShiftI,ConstantInt * CI,const TargetLowering & TLI,const DataLayout & DL)2436 static bool OptimizeExtractBits(BinaryOperator *ShiftI, ConstantInt *CI,
2437 const TargetLowering &TLI,
2438 const DataLayout &DL) {
2439 BasicBlock *DefBB = ShiftI->getParent();
2440
2441 /// Only insert instructions in each block once.
2442 DenseMap<BasicBlock *, BinaryOperator *> InsertedShifts;
2443
2444 bool shiftIsLegal = TLI.isTypeLegal(TLI.getValueType(DL, ShiftI->getType()));
2445
2446 bool MadeChange = false;
2447 for (Value::user_iterator UI = ShiftI->user_begin(), E = ShiftI->user_end();
2448 UI != E;) {
2449 Use &TheUse = UI.getUse();
2450 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI);
2451 // Preincrement use iterator so we don't invalidate it.
2452 ++UI;
2453
2454 // Don't bother for PHI nodes.
2455 if (isa<PHINode>(User))
2456 continue;
2457
2458 if (!isExtractBitsCandidateUse(User))
2459 continue;
2460
2461 BasicBlock *UserBB = User->getParent();
2462
2463 if (UserBB == DefBB) {
2464 // If the shift and truncate instruction are in the same BB. The use of
2465 // the truncate(TruncUse) may still introduce another truncate if not
2466 // legal. In this case, we would like to sink both shift and truncate
2467 // instruction to the BB of TruncUse.
2468 // for example:
2469 // BB1:
2470 // i64 shift.result = lshr i64 opnd, imm
2471 // trunc.result = trunc shift.result to i16
2472 //
2473 // BB2:
2474 // ----> We will have an implicit truncate here if the architecture does
2475 // not have i16 compare.
2476 // cmp i16 trunc.result, opnd2
2477 //
2478 if (isa<TruncInst>(User) &&
2479 shiftIsLegal
2480 // If the type of the truncate is legal, no truncate will be
2481 // introduced in other basic blocks.
2482 && (!TLI.isTypeLegal(TLI.getValueType(DL, User->getType()))))
2483 MadeChange =
2484 SinkShiftAndTruncate(ShiftI, User, CI, InsertedShifts, TLI, DL);
2485
2486 continue;
2487 }
2488 // If we have already inserted a shift into this block, use it.
2489 BinaryOperator *&InsertedShift = InsertedShifts[UserBB];
2490
2491 if (!InsertedShift) {
2492 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPt = UserBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
2493 assert(InsertPt != UserBB->end());
2494
2495 if (ShiftI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
2496 InsertedShift =
2497 BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(ShiftI->getOperand(0), CI, "");
2498 else
2499 InsertedShift =
2500 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShiftI->getOperand(0), CI, "");
2501 InsertedShift->insertBefore(*UserBB, InsertPt);
2502 InsertedShift->setDebugLoc(ShiftI->getDebugLoc());
2503
2504 MadeChange = true;
2505 }
2506
2507 // Replace a use of the shift with a use of the new shift.
2508 TheUse = InsertedShift;
2509 }
2510
2511 // If we removed all uses, or there are none, nuke the shift.
2512 if (ShiftI->use_empty()) {
2513 salvageDebugInfo(*ShiftI);
2514 ShiftI->eraseFromParent();
2515 MadeChange = true;
2516 }
2517
2518 return MadeChange;
2519 }
2520
2521 /// If counting leading or trailing zeros is an expensive operation and a zero
2522 /// input is defined, add a check for zero to avoid calling the intrinsic.
2523 ///
2524 /// We want to transform:
2525 /// %z = call i64 @llvm.cttz.i64(i64 %A, i1 false)
2526 ///
2527 /// into:
2528 /// entry:
2529 /// %cmpz = icmp eq i64 %A, 0
2530 /// br i1 %cmpz, label %cond.end, label %cond.false
2531 /// cond.false:
2532 /// %z = call i64 @llvm.cttz.i64(i64 %A, i1 true)
2533 /// br label %cond.end
2534 /// cond.end:
2535 /// %ctz = phi i64 [ 64, %entry ], [ %z, %cond.false ]
2536 ///
2537 /// If the transform is performed, return true and set ModifiedDT to true.
despeculateCountZeros(IntrinsicInst * CountZeros,LoopInfo & LI,const TargetLowering * TLI,const DataLayout * DL,ModifyDT & ModifiedDT,SmallSet<BasicBlock *,32> & FreshBBs,bool IsHugeFunc)2538 static bool despeculateCountZeros(IntrinsicInst *CountZeros,
2539 LoopInfo &LI,
2540 const TargetLowering *TLI,
2541 const DataLayout *DL, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT,
2542 SmallSet<BasicBlock *, 32> &FreshBBs,
2543 bool IsHugeFunc) {
2544 // If a zero input is undefined, it doesn't make sense to despeculate that.
2545 if (match(CountZeros->getOperand(1), m_One()))
2546 return false;
2547
2548 // If it's cheap to speculate, there's nothing to do.
2549 Type *Ty = CountZeros->getType();
2550 auto IntrinsicID = CountZeros->getIntrinsicID();
2551 if ((IntrinsicID == Intrinsic::cttz && TLI->isCheapToSpeculateCttz(Ty)) ||
2552 (IntrinsicID == Intrinsic::ctlz && TLI->isCheapToSpeculateCtlz(Ty)))
2553 return false;
2554
2555 // Only handle scalar cases. Anything else requires too much work.
2556 unsigned SizeInBits = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
2557 if (Ty->isVectorTy())
2558 return false;
2559
2560 // Bail if the value is never zero.
2561 Use &Op = CountZeros->getOperandUse(0);
2562 if (isKnownNonZero(Op, *DL))
2563 return false;
2564
2565 // The intrinsic will be sunk behind a compare against zero and branch.
2566 BasicBlock *StartBlock = CountZeros->getParent();
2567 BasicBlock *CallBlock = StartBlock->splitBasicBlock(CountZeros, "cond.false");
2568 if (IsHugeFunc)
2569 FreshBBs.insert(CallBlock);
2570
2571 // Create another block after the count zero intrinsic. A PHI will be added
2572 // in this block to select the result of the intrinsic or the bit-width
2573 // constant if the input to the intrinsic is zero.
2574 BasicBlock::iterator SplitPt = std::next(BasicBlock::iterator(CountZeros));
2575 // Any debug-info after CountZeros should not be included.
2576 SplitPt.setHeadBit(true);
2577 BasicBlock *EndBlock = CallBlock->splitBasicBlock(SplitPt, "cond.end");
2578 if (IsHugeFunc)
2579 FreshBBs.insert(EndBlock);
2580
2581 // Update the LoopInfo. The new blocks are in the same loop as the start
2582 // block.
2583 if (Loop *L = LI.getLoopFor(StartBlock)) {
2584 L->addBasicBlockToLoop(CallBlock, LI);
2585 L->addBasicBlockToLoop(EndBlock, LI);
2586 }
2587
2588 // Set up a builder to create a compare, conditional branch, and PHI.
2589 IRBuilder<> Builder(CountZeros->getContext());
2590 Builder.SetInsertPoint(StartBlock->getTerminator());
2591 Builder.SetCurrentDebugLocation(CountZeros->getDebugLoc());
2592
2593 // Replace the unconditional branch that was created by the first split with
2594 // a compare against zero and a conditional branch.
2595 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(Ty);
2596 // Avoid introducing branch on poison. This also replaces the ctz operand.
2597 if (!isGuaranteedNotToBeUndefOrPoison(Op))
2598 Op = Builder.CreateFreeze(Op, Op->getName() + ".fr");
2599 Value *Cmp = Builder.CreateICmpEQ(Op, Zero, "cmpz");
2600 Builder.CreateCondBr(Cmp, EndBlock, CallBlock);
2601 StartBlock->getTerminator()->eraseFromParent();
2602
2603 // Create a PHI in the end block to select either the output of the intrinsic
2604 // or the bit width of the operand.
2605 Builder.SetInsertPoint(EndBlock, EndBlock->begin());
2606 PHINode *PN = Builder.CreatePHI(Ty, 2, "ctz");
2607 replaceAllUsesWith(CountZeros, PN, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
2608 Value *BitWidth = Builder.getInt(APInt(SizeInBits, SizeInBits));
2609 PN->addIncoming(BitWidth, StartBlock);
2610 PN->addIncoming(CountZeros, CallBlock);
2611
2612 // We are explicitly handling the zero case, so we can set the intrinsic's
2613 // undefined zero argument to 'true'. This will also prevent reprocessing the
2614 // intrinsic; we only despeculate when a zero input is defined.
2615 CountZeros->setArgOperand(1, Builder.getTrue());
2616 ModifiedDT = ModifyDT::ModifyBBDT;
2617 return true;
2618 }
2619
optimizeCallInst(CallInst * CI,ModifyDT & ModifiedDT)2620 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeCallInst(CallInst *CI, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT) {
2621 BasicBlock *BB = CI->getParent();
2622
2623 // Lower inline assembly if we can.
2624 // If we found an inline asm expession, and if the target knows how to
2625 // lower it to normal LLVM code, do so now.
2626 if (CI->isInlineAsm()) {
2627 if (TLI->ExpandInlineAsm(CI)) {
2628 // Avoid invalidating the iterator.
2629 CurInstIterator = BB->begin();
2630 // Avoid processing instructions out of order, which could cause
2631 // reuse before a value is defined.
2632 SunkAddrs.clear();
2633 return true;
2634 }
2635 // Sink address computing for memory operands into the block.
2636 if (optimizeInlineAsmInst(CI))
2637 return true;
2638 }
2639
2640 // Align the pointer arguments to this call if the target thinks it's a good
2641 // idea
2642 unsigned MinSize;
2643 Align PrefAlign;
2644 if (TLI->shouldAlignPointerArgs(CI, MinSize, PrefAlign)) {
2645 for (auto &Arg : CI->args()) {
2646 // We want to align both objects whose address is used directly and
2647 // objects whose address is used in casts and GEPs, though it only makes
2648 // sense for GEPs if the offset is a multiple of the desired alignment and
2649 // if size - offset meets the size threshold.
2650 if (!Arg->getType()->isPointerTy())
2651 continue;
2652 APInt Offset(DL->getIndexSizeInBits(
2653 cast<PointerType>(Arg->getType())->getAddressSpace()),
2654 0);
2655 Value *Val = Arg->stripAndAccumulateInBoundsConstantOffsets(*DL, Offset);
2656 uint64_t Offset2 = Offset.getLimitedValue();
2657 if (!isAligned(PrefAlign, Offset2))
2658 continue;
2659 AllocaInst *AI;
2660 if ((AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(Val)) && AI->getAlign() < PrefAlign &&
2661 DL->getTypeAllocSize(AI->getAllocatedType()) >= MinSize + Offset2)
2662 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
2663 // Global variables can only be aligned if they are defined in this
2664 // object (i.e. they are uniquely initialized in this object), and
2665 // over-aligning global variables that have an explicit section is
2666 // forbidden.
2667 GlobalVariable *GV;
2668 if ((GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Val)) && GV->canIncreaseAlignment() &&
2669 GV->getPointerAlignment(*DL) < PrefAlign &&
2670 DL->getTypeAllocSize(GV->getValueType()) >= MinSize + Offset2)
2671 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
2672 }
2673 }
2674 // If this is a memcpy (or similar) then we may be able to improve the
2675 // alignment.
2676 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(CI)) {
2677 Align DestAlign = getKnownAlignment(MI->getDest(), *DL);
2678 MaybeAlign MIDestAlign = MI->getDestAlign();
2679 if (!MIDestAlign || DestAlign > *MIDestAlign)
2680 MI->setDestAlignment(DestAlign);
2681 if (MemTransferInst *MTI = dyn_cast<MemTransferInst>(MI)) {
2682 MaybeAlign MTISrcAlign = MTI->getSourceAlign();
2683 Align SrcAlign = getKnownAlignment(MTI->getSource(), *DL);
2684 if (!MTISrcAlign || SrcAlign > *MTISrcAlign)
2685 MTI->setSourceAlignment(SrcAlign);
2686 }
2687 }
2688
2689 // If we have a cold call site, try to sink addressing computation into the
2690 // cold block. This interacts with our handling for loads and stores to
2691 // ensure that we can fold all uses of a potential addressing computation
2692 // into their uses. TODO: generalize this to work over profiling data
2693 if (CI->hasFnAttr(Attribute::Cold) &&
2694 !llvm::shouldOptimizeForSize(BB, PSI, BFI.get()))
2695 for (auto &Arg : CI->args()) {
2696 if (!Arg->getType()->isPointerTy())
2697 continue;
2698 unsigned AS = Arg->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace();
2699 if (optimizeMemoryInst(CI, Arg, Arg->getType(), AS))
2700 return true;
2701 }
2702
2703 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(CI);
2704 if (II) {
2705 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
2706 default:
2707 break;
2708 case Intrinsic::assume:
2709 llvm_unreachable("llvm.assume should have been removed already");
2710 case Intrinsic::allow_runtime_check:
2711 case Intrinsic::allow_ubsan_check:
2712 case Intrinsic::experimental_widenable_condition: {
2713 // Give up on future widening opportunities so that we can fold away dead
2714 // paths and merge blocks before going into block-local instruction
2715 // selection.
2716 if (II->use_empty()) {
2717 II->eraseFromParent();
2718 return true;
2719 }
2720 Constant *RetVal = ConstantInt::getTrue(II->getContext());
2721 resetIteratorIfInvalidatedWhileCalling(BB, [&]() {
2722 replaceAndRecursivelySimplify(CI, RetVal, TLInfo, nullptr);
2723 });
2724 return true;
2725 }
2726 case Intrinsic::objectsize:
2727 llvm_unreachable("llvm.objectsize.* should have been lowered already");
2728 case Intrinsic::is_constant:
2729 llvm_unreachable("llvm.is.constant.* should have been lowered already");
2730 case Intrinsic::aarch64_stlxr:
2731 case Intrinsic::aarch64_stxr: {
2732 ZExtInst *ExtVal = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(CI->getArgOperand(0));
2733 if (!ExtVal || !ExtVal->hasOneUse() ||
2734 ExtVal->getParent() == CI->getParent())
2735 return false;
2736 // Sink a zext feeding stlxr/stxr before it, so it can be folded into it.
2737 ExtVal->moveBefore(CI->getIterator());
2738 // Mark this instruction as "inserted by CGP", so that other
2739 // optimizations don't touch it.
2740 InsertedInsts.insert(ExtVal);
2741 return true;
2742 }
2743
2744 case Intrinsic::launder_invariant_group:
2745 case Intrinsic::strip_invariant_group: {
2746 Value *ArgVal = II->getArgOperand(0);
2747 auto it = LargeOffsetGEPMap.find(II);
2748 if (it != LargeOffsetGEPMap.end()) {
2749 // Merge entries in LargeOffsetGEPMap to reflect the RAUW.
2750 // Make sure not to have to deal with iterator invalidation
2751 // after possibly adding ArgVal to LargeOffsetGEPMap.
2752 auto GEPs = std::move(it->second);
2753 LargeOffsetGEPMap[ArgVal].append(GEPs.begin(), GEPs.end());
2754 LargeOffsetGEPMap.erase(II);
2755 }
2756
2757 replaceAllUsesWith(II, ArgVal, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
2758 II->eraseFromParent();
2759 return true;
2760 }
2761 case Intrinsic::cttz:
2762 case Intrinsic::ctlz:
2763 // If counting zeros is expensive, try to avoid it.
2764 return despeculateCountZeros(II, *LI, TLI, DL, ModifiedDT, FreshBBs,
2765 IsHugeFunc);
2766 case Intrinsic::fshl:
2767 case Intrinsic::fshr:
2768 return optimizeFunnelShift(II);
2769 case Intrinsic::dbg_assign:
2770 case Intrinsic::dbg_value:
2771 return fixupDbgValue(II);
2772 case Intrinsic::masked_gather:
2773 return optimizeGatherScatterInst(II, II->getArgOperand(0));
2774 case Intrinsic::masked_scatter:
2775 return optimizeGatherScatterInst(II, II->getArgOperand(1));
2776 }
2777
2778 SmallVector<Value *, 2> PtrOps;
2779 Type *AccessTy;
2780 if (TLI->getAddrModeArguments(II, PtrOps, AccessTy))
2781 while (!PtrOps.empty()) {
2782 Value *PtrVal = PtrOps.pop_back_val();
2783 unsigned AS = PtrVal->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace();
2784 if (optimizeMemoryInst(II, PtrVal, AccessTy, AS))
2785 return true;
2786 }
2787 }
2788
2789 // From here on out we're working with named functions.
2790 auto *Callee = CI->getCalledFunction();
2791 if (!Callee)
2792 return false;
2793
2794 // Lower all default uses of _chk calls. This is very similar
2795 // to what InstCombineCalls does, but here we are only lowering calls
2796 // to fortified library functions (e.g. __memcpy_chk) that have the default
2797 // "don't know" as the objectsize. Anything else should be left alone.
2798 FortifiedLibCallSimplifier Simplifier(TLInfo, true);
2799 IRBuilder<> Builder(CI);
2800 if (Value *V = Simplifier.optimizeCall(CI, Builder)) {
2801 replaceAllUsesWith(CI, V, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
2802 CI->eraseFromParent();
2803 return true;
2804 }
2805
2806 // SCCP may have propagated, among other things, C++ static variables across
2807 // calls. If this happens to be the case, we may want to undo it in order to
2808 // avoid redundant pointer computation of the constant, as the function method
2809 // returning the constant needs to be executed anyways.
2810 auto GetUniformReturnValue = [](const Function *F) -> GlobalVariable * {
2811 if (!F->getReturnType()->isPointerTy())
2812 return nullptr;
2813
2814 GlobalVariable *UniformValue = nullptr;
2815 for (auto &BB : *F) {
2816 if (auto *RI = dyn_cast<ReturnInst>(BB.getTerminator())) {
2817 if (auto *V = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(RI->getReturnValue())) {
2818 if (!UniformValue)
2819 UniformValue = V;
2820 else if (V != UniformValue)
2821 return nullptr;
2822 } else {
2823 return nullptr;
2824 }
2825 }
2826 }
2827
2828 return UniformValue;
2829 };
2830
2831 if (Callee->hasExactDefinition()) {
2832 if (GlobalVariable *RV = GetUniformReturnValue(Callee)) {
2833 bool MadeChange = false;
2834 for (Use &U : make_early_inc_range(RV->uses())) {
2835 auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(U.getUser());
2836 if (!I || I->getParent() != CI->getParent()) {
2837 // Limit to the same basic block to avoid extending the call-site live
2838 // range, which otherwise could increase register pressure.
2839 continue;
2840 }
2841 if (CI->comesBefore(I)) {
2842 U.set(CI);
2843 MadeChange = true;
2844 }
2845 }
2846
2847 return MadeChange;
2848 }
2849 }
2850
2851 return false;
2852 }
2853
isIntrinsicOrLFToBeTailCalled(const TargetLibraryInfo * TLInfo,const CallInst * CI)2854 static bool isIntrinsicOrLFToBeTailCalled(const TargetLibraryInfo *TLInfo,
2855 const CallInst *CI) {
2856 assert(CI && CI->use_empty());
2857
2858 if (const auto *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(CI))
2859 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
2860 case Intrinsic::memset:
2861 case Intrinsic::memcpy:
2862 case Intrinsic::memmove:
2863 return true;
2864 default:
2865 return false;
2866 }
2867
2868 LibFunc LF;
2869 Function *Callee = CI->getCalledFunction();
2870 if (Callee && TLInfo && TLInfo->getLibFunc(*Callee, LF))
2871 switch (LF) {
2872 case LibFunc_strcpy:
2873 case LibFunc_strncpy:
2874 case LibFunc_strcat:
2875 case LibFunc_strncat:
2876 return true;
2877 default:
2878 return false;
2879 }
2880
2881 return false;
2882 }
2883
2884 /// Look for opportunities to duplicate return instructions to the predecessor
2885 /// to enable tail call optimizations. The case it is currently looking for is
2886 /// the following one. Known intrinsics or library function that may be tail
2887 /// called are taken into account as well.
2888 /// @code
2889 /// bb0:
2890 /// %tmp0 = tail call i32 @f0()
2891 /// br label %return
2892 /// bb1:
2893 /// %tmp1 = tail call i32 @f1()
2894 /// br label %return
2895 /// bb2:
2896 /// %tmp2 = tail call i32 @f2()
2897 /// br label %return
2898 /// return:
2899 /// %retval = phi i32 [ %tmp0, %bb0 ], [ %tmp1, %bb1 ], [ %tmp2, %bb2 ]
2900 /// ret i32 %retval
2901 /// @endcode
2902 ///
2903 /// =>
2904 ///
2905 /// @code
2906 /// bb0:
2907 /// %tmp0 = tail call i32 @f0()
2908 /// ret i32 %tmp0
2909 /// bb1:
2910 /// %tmp1 = tail call i32 @f1()
2911 /// ret i32 %tmp1
2912 /// bb2:
2913 /// %tmp2 = tail call i32 @f2()
2914 /// ret i32 %tmp2
2915 /// @endcode
dupRetToEnableTailCallOpts(BasicBlock * BB,ModifyDT & ModifiedDT)2916 bool CodeGenPrepare::dupRetToEnableTailCallOpts(BasicBlock *BB,
2917 ModifyDT &ModifiedDT) {
2918 if (!BB->getTerminator())
2919 return false;
2920
2921 ReturnInst *RetI = dyn_cast<ReturnInst>(BB->getTerminator());
2922 if (!RetI)
2923 return false;
2924
2925 assert(LI->getLoopFor(BB) == nullptr && "A return block cannot be in a loop");
2926
2927 PHINode *PN = nullptr;
2928 ExtractValueInst *EVI = nullptr;
2929 BitCastInst *BCI = nullptr;
2930 Value *V = RetI->getReturnValue();
2931 if (V) {
2932 BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V);
2933 if (BCI)
2934 V = BCI->getOperand(0);
2935
2936 EVI = dyn_cast<ExtractValueInst>(V);
2937 if (EVI) {
2938 V = EVI->getOperand(0);
2939 if (!llvm::all_of(EVI->indices(), [](unsigned idx) { return idx == 0; }))
2940 return false;
2941 }
2942
2943 PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V);
2944 }
2945
2946 if (PN && PN->getParent() != BB)
2947 return false;
2948
2949 auto isLifetimeEndOrBitCastFor = [](const Instruction *Inst) {
2950 const BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Inst);
2951 if (BC && BC->hasOneUse())
2952 Inst = BC->user_back();
2953
2954 if (const IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(Inst))
2955 return II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::lifetime_end;
2956 return false;
2957 };
2958
2959 SmallVector<const IntrinsicInst *, 4> FakeUses;
2960
2961 auto isFakeUse = [&FakeUses](const Instruction *Inst) {
2962 if (auto *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(Inst);
2963 II && II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::fake_use) {
2964 // Record the instruction so it can be preserved when the exit block is
2965 // removed. Do not preserve the fake use that uses the result of the
2966 // PHI instruction.
2967 // Do not copy fake uses that use the result of a PHI node.
2968 // FIXME: If we do want to copy the fake use into the return blocks, we
2969 // have to figure out which of the PHI node operands to use for each
2970 // copy.
2971 if (!isa<PHINode>(II->getOperand(0))) {
2972 FakeUses.push_back(II);
2973 }
2974 return true;
2975 }
2976
2977 return false;
2978 };
2979
2980 // Make sure there are no instructions between the first instruction
2981 // and return.
2982 BasicBlock::const_iterator BI = BB->getFirstNonPHIIt();
2983 // Skip over pseudo-probes and the bitcast.
2984 while (&*BI == BCI || &*BI == EVI || isa<PseudoProbeInst>(BI) ||
2985 isLifetimeEndOrBitCastFor(&*BI) || isFakeUse(&*BI))
2986 BI = std::next(BI);
2987 if (&*BI != RetI)
2988 return false;
2989
2990 /// Only dup the ReturnInst if the CallInst is likely to be emitted as a tail
2991 /// call.
2992 const Function *F = BB->getParent();
2993 SmallVector<BasicBlock *, 4> TailCallBBs;
2994 // Record the call instructions so we can insert any fake uses
2995 // that need to be preserved before them.
2996 SmallVector<CallInst *, 4> CallInsts;
2997 if (PN) {
2998 for (unsigned I = 0, E = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); I != E; ++I) {
2999 // Look through bitcasts.
3000 Value *IncomingVal = PN->getIncomingValue(I)->stripPointerCasts();
3001 CallInst *CI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(IncomingVal);
3002 BasicBlock *PredBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(I);
3003 // Make sure the phi value is indeed produced by the tail call.
3004 if (CI && CI->hasOneUse() && CI->getParent() == PredBB &&
3005 TLI->mayBeEmittedAsTailCall(CI) &&
3006 attributesPermitTailCall(F, CI, RetI, *TLI)) {
3007 TailCallBBs.push_back(PredBB);
3008 CallInsts.push_back(CI);
3009 } else {
3010 // Consider the cases in which the phi value is indirectly produced by
3011 // the tail call, for example when encountering memset(), memmove(),
3012 // strcpy(), whose return value may have been optimized out. In such
3013 // cases, the value needs to be the first function argument.
3014 //
3015 // bb0:
3016 // tail call void @llvm.memset.p0.i64(ptr %0, i8 0, i64 %1)
3017 // br label %return
3018 // return:
3019 // %phi = phi ptr [ %0, %bb0 ], [ %2, %entry ]
3020 if (PredBB && PredBB->getSingleSuccessor() == BB)
3021 CI = dyn_cast_or_null<CallInst>(
3022 PredBB->getTerminator()->getPrevNonDebugInstruction(true));
3023
3024 if (CI && CI->use_empty() &&
3025 isIntrinsicOrLFToBeTailCalled(TLInfo, CI) &&
3026 IncomingVal == CI->getArgOperand(0) &&
3027 TLI->mayBeEmittedAsTailCall(CI) &&
3028 attributesPermitTailCall(F, CI, RetI, *TLI)) {
3029 TailCallBBs.push_back(PredBB);
3030 CallInsts.push_back(CI);
3031 }
3032 }
3033 }
3034 } else {
3035 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock *, 4> VisitedBBs;
3036 for (BasicBlock *Pred : predecessors(BB)) {
3037 if (!VisitedBBs.insert(Pred).second)
3038 continue;
3039 if (Instruction *I = Pred->rbegin()->getPrevNonDebugInstruction(true)) {
3040 CallInst *CI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(I);
3041 if (CI && CI->use_empty() && TLI->mayBeEmittedAsTailCall(CI) &&
3042 attributesPermitTailCall(F, CI, RetI, *TLI)) {
3043 // Either we return void or the return value must be the first
3044 // argument of a known intrinsic or library function.
3045 if (!V || isa<UndefValue>(V) ||
3046 (isIntrinsicOrLFToBeTailCalled(TLInfo, CI) &&
3047 V == CI->getArgOperand(0))) {
3048 TailCallBBs.push_back(Pred);
3049 CallInsts.push_back(CI);
3050 }
3051 }
3052 }
3053 }
3054 }
3055
3056 bool Changed = false;
3057 for (auto const &TailCallBB : TailCallBBs) {
3058 // Make sure the call instruction is followed by an unconditional branch to
3059 // the return block.
3060 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TailCallBB->getTerminator());
3061 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional() || BI->getSuccessor(0) != BB)
3062 continue;
3063
3064 // Duplicate the return into TailCallBB.
3065 (void)FoldReturnIntoUncondBranch(RetI, BB, TailCallBB);
3066 assert(!VerifyBFIUpdates ||
3067 BFI->getBlockFreq(BB) >= BFI->getBlockFreq(TailCallBB));
3068 BFI->setBlockFreq(BB,
3069 (BFI->getBlockFreq(BB) - BFI->getBlockFreq(TailCallBB)));
3070 ModifiedDT = ModifyDT::ModifyBBDT;
3071 Changed = true;
3072 ++NumRetsDup;
3073 }
3074
3075 // If we eliminated all predecessors of the block, delete the block now.
3076 if (Changed && !BB->hasAddressTaken() && pred_empty(BB)) {
3077 // Copy the fake uses found in the original return block to all blocks
3078 // that contain tail calls.
3079 for (auto *CI : CallInsts) {
3080 for (auto const *FakeUse : FakeUses) {
3081 auto *ClonedInst = FakeUse->clone();
3082 ClonedInst->insertBefore(CI->getIterator());
3083 }
3084 }
3085 BB->eraseFromParent();
3086 }
3087
3088 return Changed;
3089 }
3090
3091 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3092 // Memory Optimization
3093 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3094
3095 namespace {
3096
3097 /// This is an extended version of TargetLowering::AddrMode
3098 /// which holds actual Value*'s for register values.
3099 struct ExtAddrMode : public TargetLowering::AddrMode {
3100 Value *BaseReg = nullptr;
3101 Value *ScaledReg = nullptr;
3102 Value *OriginalValue = nullptr;
3103 bool InBounds = true;
3104
3105 enum FieldName {
3106 NoField = 0x00,
3107 BaseRegField = 0x01,
3108 BaseGVField = 0x02,
3109 BaseOffsField = 0x04,
3110 ScaledRegField = 0x08,
3111 ScaleField = 0x10,
3112 MultipleFields = 0xff
3113 };
3114
3115 ExtAddrMode() = default;
3116
3117 void print(raw_ostream &OS) const;
3118 void dump() const;
3119
3120 // Replace From in ExtAddrMode with To.
3121 // E.g., SExt insts may be promoted and deleted. We should replace them with
3122 // the promoted values.
replaceWith__anon1d600f580c11::ExtAddrMode3123 void replaceWith(Value *From, Value *To) {
3124 if (ScaledReg == From)
3125 ScaledReg = To;
3126 }
3127
compare__anon1d600f580c11::ExtAddrMode3128 FieldName compare(const ExtAddrMode &other) {
3129 // First check that the types are the same on each field, as differing types
3130 // is something we can't cope with later on.
3131 if (BaseReg && other.BaseReg &&
3132 BaseReg->getType() != other.BaseReg->getType())
3133 return MultipleFields;
3134 if (BaseGV && other.BaseGV && BaseGV->getType() != other.BaseGV->getType())
3135 return MultipleFields;
3136 if (ScaledReg && other.ScaledReg &&
3137 ScaledReg->getType() != other.ScaledReg->getType())
3138 return MultipleFields;
3139
3140 // Conservatively reject 'inbounds' mismatches.
3141 if (InBounds != other.InBounds)
3142 return MultipleFields;
3143
3144 // Check each field to see if it differs.
3145 unsigned Result = NoField;
3146 if (BaseReg != other.BaseReg)
3147 Result |= BaseRegField;
3148 if (BaseGV != other.BaseGV)
3149 Result |= BaseGVField;
3150 if (BaseOffs != other.BaseOffs)
3151 Result |= BaseOffsField;
3152 if (ScaledReg != other.ScaledReg)
3153 Result |= ScaledRegField;
3154 // Don't count 0 as being a different scale, because that actually means
3155 // unscaled (which will already be counted by having no ScaledReg).
3156 if (Scale && other.Scale && Scale != other.Scale)
3157 Result |= ScaleField;
3158
3159 if (llvm::popcount(Result) > 1)
3160 return MultipleFields;
3161 else
3162 return static_cast<FieldName>(Result);
3163 }
3164
3165 // An AddrMode is trivial if it involves no calculation i.e. it is just a base
3166 // with no offset.
isTrivial__anon1d600f580c11::ExtAddrMode3167 bool isTrivial() {
3168 // An AddrMode is (BaseGV + BaseReg + BaseOffs + ScaleReg * Scale) so it is
3169 // trivial if at most one of these terms is nonzero, except that BaseGV and
3170 // BaseReg both being zero actually means a null pointer value, which we
3171 // consider to be 'non-zero' here.
3172 return !BaseOffs && !Scale && !(BaseGV && BaseReg);
3173 }
3174
GetFieldAsValue__anon1d600f580c11::ExtAddrMode3175 Value *GetFieldAsValue(FieldName Field, Type *IntPtrTy) {
3176 switch (Field) {
3177 default:
3178 return nullptr;
3179 case BaseRegField:
3180 return BaseReg;
3181 case BaseGVField:
3182 return BaseGV;
3183 case ScaledRegField:
3184 return ScaledReg;
3185 case BaseOffsField:
3186 return ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, BaseOffs);
3187 }
3188 }
3189
SetCombinedField__anon1d600f580c11::ExtAddrMode3190 void SetCombinedField(FieldName Field, Value *V,
3191 const SmallVectorImpl<ExtAddrMode> &AddrModes) {
3192 switch (Field) {
3193 default:
3194 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled fields are expected to be rejected earlier");
3195 break;
3196 case ExtAddrMode::BaseRegField:
3197 BaseReg = V;
3198 break;
3199 case ExtAddrMode::BaseGVField:
3200 // A combined BaseGV is an Instruction, not a GlobalValue, so it goes
3201 // in the BaseReg field.
3202 assert(BaseReg == nullptr);
3203 BaseReg = V;
3204 BaseGV = nullptr;
3205 break;
3206 case ExtAddrMode::ScaledRegField:
3207 ScaledReg = V;
3208 // If we have a mix of scaled and unscaled addrmodes then we want scale
3209 // to be the scale and not zero.
3210 if (!Scale)
3211 for (const ExtAddrMode &AM : AddrModes)
3212 if (AM.Scale) {
3213 Scale = AM.Scale;
3214 break;
3215 }
3216 break;
3217 case ExtAddrMode::BaseOffsField:
3218 // The offset is no longer a constant, so it goes in ScaledReg with a
3219 // scale of 1.
3220 assert(ScaledReg == nullptr);
3221 ScaledReg = V;
3222 Scale = 1;
3223 BaseOffs = 0;
3224 break;
3225 }
3226 }
3227 };
3228
3229 #ifndef NDEBUG
operator <<(raw_ostream & OS,const ExtAddrMode & AM)3230 static inline raw_ostream &operator<<(raw_ostream &OS, const ExtAddrMode &AM) {
3231 AM.print(OS);
3232 return OS;
3233 }
3234 #endif
3235
3236 #if !defined(NDEBUG) || defined(LLVM_ENABLE_DUMP)
print(raw_ostream & OS) const3237 void ExtAddrMode::print(raw_ostream &OS) const {
3238 bool NeedPlus = false;
3239 OS << "[";
3240 if (InBounds)
3241 OS << "inbounds ";
3242 if (BaseGV) {
3243 OS << "GV:";
3244 BaseGV->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false);
3245 NeedPlus = true;
3246 }
3247
3248 if (BaseOffs) {
3249 OS << (NeedPlus ? " + " : "") << BaseOffs;
3250 NeedPlus = true;
3251 }
3252
3253 if (BaseReg) {
3254 OS << (NeedPlus ? " + " : "") << "Base:";
3255 BaseReg->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false);
3256 NeedPlus = true;
3257 }
3258 if (Scale) {
3259 OS << (NeedPlus ? " + " : "") << Scale << "*";
3260 ScaledReg->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false);
3261 }
3262
3263 OS << ']';
3264 }
3265
dump() const3266 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void ExtAddrMode::dump() const {
3267 print(dbgs());
3268 dbgs() << '\n';
3269 }
3270 #endif
3271
3272 } // end anonymous namespace
3273
3274 namespace {
3275
3276 /// This class provides transaction based operation on the IR.
3277 /// Every change made through this class is recorded in the internal state and
3278 /// can be undone (rollback) until commit is called.
3279 /// CGP does not check if instructions could be speculatively executed when
3280 /// moved. Preserving the original location would pessimize the debugging
3281 /// experience, as well as negatively impact the quality of sample PGO.
3282 class TypePromotionTransaction {
3283 /// This represents the common interface of the individual transaction.
3284 /// Each class implements the logic for doing one specific modification on
3285 /// the IR via the TypePromotionTransaction.
3286 class TypePromotionAction {
3287 protected:
3288 /// The Instruction modified.
3289 Instruction *Inst;
3290
3291 public:
3292 /// Constructor of the action.
3293 /// The constructor performs the related action on the IR.
TypePromotionAction(Instruction * Inst)3294 TypePromotionAction(Instruction *Inst) : Inst(Inst) {}
3295
3296 virtual ~TypePromotionAction() = default;
3297
3298 /// Undo the modification done by this action.
3299 /// When this method is called, the IR must be in the same state as it was
3300 /// before this action was applied.
3301 /// \pre Undoing the action works if and only if the IR is in the exact same
3302 /// state as it was directly after this action was applied.
3303 virtual void undo() = 0;
3304
3305 /// Advocate every change made by this action.
3306 /// When the results on the IR of the action are to be kept, it is important
3307 /// to call this function, otherwise hidden information may be kept forever.
commit()3308 virtual void commit() {
3309 // Nothing to be done, this action is not doing anything.
3310 }
3311 };
3312
3313 /// Utility to remember the position of an instruction.
3314 class InsertionHandler {
3315 /// Position of an instruction.
3316 /// Either an instruction:
3317 /// - Is the first in a basic block: BB is used.
3318 /// - Has a previous instruction: PrevInst is used.
3319 struct {
3320 BasicBlock::iterator PrevInst;
3321 BasicBlock *BB;
3322 } Point;
3323 std::optional<DbgRecord::self_iterator> BeforeDbgRecord = std::nullopt;
3324
3325 /// Remember whether or not the instruction had a previous instruction.
3326 bool HasPrevInstruction;
3327
3328 public:
3329 /// Record the position of \p Inst.
InsertionHandler(Instruction * Inst)3330 InsertionHandler(Instruction *Inst) {
3331 HasPrevInstruction = (Inst != &*(Inst->getParent()->begin()));
3332 BasicBlock *BB = Inst->getParent();
3333
3334 // Record where we would have to re-insert the instruction in the sequence
3335 // of DbgRecords, if we ended up reinserting.
3336 BeforeDbgRecord = Inst->getDbgReinsertionPosition();
3337
3338 if (HasPrevInstruction) {
3339 Point.PrevInst = std::prev(Inst->getIterator());
3340 } else {
3341 Point.BB = BB;
3342 }
3343 }
3344
3345 /// Insert \p Inst at the recorded position.
insert(Instruction * Inst)3346 void insert(Instruction *Inst) {
3347 if (HasPrevInstruction) {
3348 if (Inst->getParent())
3349 Inst->removeFromParent();
3350 Inst->insertAfter(Point.PrevInst);
3351 } else {
3352 BasicBlock::iterator Position = Point.BB->getFirstInsertionPt();
3353 if (Inst->getParent())
3354 Inst->moveBefore(*Point.BB, Position);
3355 else
3356 Inst->insertBefore(*Point.BB, Position);
3357 }
3358
3359 Inst->getParent()->reinsertInstInDbgRecords(Inst, BeforeDbgRecord);
3360 }
3361 };
3362
3363 /// Move an instruction before another.
3364 class InstructionMoveBefore : public TypePromotionAction {
3365 /// Original position of the instruction.
3366 InsertionHandler Position;
3367
3368 public:
3369 /// Move \p Inst before \p Before.
InstructionMoveBefore(Instruction * Inst,BasicBlock::iterator Before)3370 InstructionMoveBefore(Instruction *Inst, BasicBlock::iterator Before)
3371 : TypePromotionAction(Inst), Position(Inst) {
3372 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: move: " << *Inst << "\nbefore: " << *Before
3373 << "\n");
3374 Inst->moveBefore(Before);
3375 }
3376
3377 /// Move the instruction back to its original position.
undo()3378 void undo() override {
3379 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: moveBefore: " << *Inst << "\n");
3380 Position.insert(Inst);
3381 }
3382 };
3383
3384 /// Set the operand of an instruction with a new value.
3385 class OperandSetter : public TypePromotionAction {
3386 /// Original operand of the instruction.
3387 Value *Origin;
3388
3389 /// Index of the modified instruction.
3390 unsigned Idx;
3391
3392 public:
3393 /// Set \p Idx operand of \p Inst with \p NewVal.
OperandSetter(Instruction * Inst,unsigned Idx,Value * NewVal)3394 OperandSetter(Instruction *Inst, unsigned Idx, Value *NewVal)
3395 : TypePromotionAction(Inst), Idx(Idx) {
3396 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: setOperand: " << Idx << "\n"
3397 << "for:" << *Inst << "\n"
3398 << "with:" << *NewVal << "\n");
3399 Origin = Inst->getOperand(Idx);
3400 Inst->setOperand(Idx, NewVal);
3401 }
3402
3403 /// Restore the original value of the instruction.
undo()3404 void undo() override {
3405 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: setOperand:" << Idx << "\n"
3406 << "for: " << *Inst << "\n"
3407 << "with: " << *Origin << "\n");
3408 Inst->setOperand(Idx, Origin);
3409 }
3410 };
3411
3412 /// Hide the operands of an instruction.
3413 /// Do as if this instruction was not using any of its operands.
3414 class OperandsHider : public TypePromotionAction {
3415 /// The list of original operands.
3416 SmallVector<Value *, 4> OriginalValues;
3417
3418 public:
3419 /// Remove \p Inst from the uses of the operands of \p Inst.
OperandsHider(Instruction * Inst)3420 OperandsHider(Instruction *Inst) : TypePromotionAction(Inst) {
3421 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: OperandsHider: " << *Inst << "\n");
3422 unsigned NumOpnds = Inst->getNumOperands();
3423 OriginalValues.reserve(NumOpnds);
3424 for (unsigned It = 0; It < NumOpnds; ++It) {
3425 // Save the current operand.
3426 Value *Val = Inst->getOperand(It);
3427 OriginalValues.push_back(Val);
3428 // Set a dummy one.
3429 // We could use OperandSetter here, but that would imply an overhead
3430 // that we are not willing to pay.
3431 Inst->setOperand(It, PoisonValue::get(Val->getType()));
3432 }
3433 }
3434
3435 /// Restore the original list of uses.
undo()3436 void undo() override {
3437 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: OperandsHider: " << *Inst << "\n");
3438 for (unsigned It = 0, EndIt = OriginalValues.size(); It != EndIt; ++It)
3439 Inst->setOperand(It, OriginalValues[It]);
3440 }
3441 };
3442
3443 /// Build a truncate instruction.
3444 class TruncBuilder : public TypePromotionAction {
3445 Value *Val;
3446
3447 public:
3448 /// Build a truncate instruction of \p Opnd producing a \p Ty
3449 /// result.
3450 /// trunc Opnd to Ty.
TruncBuilder(Instruction * Opnd,Type * Ty)3451 TruncBuilder(Instruction *Opnd, Type *Ty) : TypePromotionAction(Opnd) {
3452 IRBuilder<> Builder(Opnd);
3453 Builder.SetCurrentDebugLocation(DebugLoc());
3454 Val = Builder.CreateTrunc(Opnd, Ty, "promoted");
3455 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: TruncBuilder: " << *Val << "\n");
3456 }
3457
3458 /// Get the built value.
getBuiltValue()3459 Value *getBuiltValue() { return Val; }
3460
3461 /// Remove the built instruction.
undo()3462 void undo() override {
3463 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: TruncBuilder: " << *Val << "\n");
3464 if (Instruction *IVal = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
3465 IVal->eraseFromParent();
3466 }
3467 };
3468
3469 /// Build a sign extension instruction.
3470 class SExtBuilder : public TypePromotionAction {
3471 Value *Val;
3472
3473 public:
3474 /// Build a sign extension instruction of \p Opnd producing a \p Ty
3475 /// result.
3476 /// sext Opnd to Ty.
SExtBuilder(Instruction * InsertPt,Value * Opnd,Type * Ty)3477 SExtBuilder(Instruction *InsertPt, Value *Opnd, Type *Ty)
3478 : TypePromotionAction(InsertPt) {
3479 IRBuilder<> Builder(InsertPt);
3480 Val = Builder.CreateSExt(Opnd, Ty, "promoted");
3481 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: SExtBuilder: " << *Val << "\n");
3482 }
3483
3484 /// Get the built value.
getBuiltValue()3485 Value *getBuiltValue() { return Val; }
3486
3487 /// Remove the built instruction.
undo()3488 void undo() override {
3489 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: SExtBuilder: " << *Val << "\n");
3490 if (Instruction *IVal = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
3491 IVal->eraseFromParent();
3492 }
3493 };
3494
3495 /// Build a zero extension instruction.
3496 class ZExtBuilder : public TypePromotionAction {
3497 Value *Val;
3498
3499 public:
3500 /// Build a zero extension instruction of \p Opnd producing a \p Ty
3501 /// result.
3502 /// zext Opnd to Ty.
ZExtBuilder(Instruction * InsertPt,Value * Opnd,Type * Ty)3503 ZExtBuilder(Instruction *InsertPt, Value *Opnd, Type *Ty)
3504 : TypePromotionAction(InsertPt) {
3505 IRBuilder<> Builder(InsertPt);
3506 Builder.SetCurrentDebugLocation(DebugLoc());
3507 Val = Builder.CreateZExt(Opnd, Ty, "promoted");
3508 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: ZExtBuilder: " << *Val << "\n");
3509 }
3510
3511 /// Get the built value.
getBuiltValue()3512 Value *getBuiltValue() { return Val; }
3513
3514 /// Remove the built instruction.
undo()3515 void undo() override {
3516 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: ZExtBuilder: " << *Val << "\n");
3517 if (Instruction *IVal = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
3518 IVal->eraseFromParent();
3519 }
3520 };
3521
3522 /// Mutate an instruction to another type.
3523 class TypeMutator : public TypePromotionAction {
3524 /// Record the original type.
3525 Type *OrigTy;
3526
3527 public:
3528 /// Mutate the type of \p Inst into \p NewTy.
TypeMutator(Instruction * Inst,Type * NewTy)3529 TypeMutator(Instruction *Inst, Type *NewTy)
3530 : TypePromotionAction(Inst), OrigTy(Inst->getType()) {
3531 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: MutateType: " << *Inst << " with " << *NewTy
3532 << "\n");
3533 Inst->mutateType(NewTy);
3534 }
3535
3536 /// Mutate the instruction back to its original type.
undo()3537 void undo() override {
3538 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: MutateType: " << *Inst << " with " << *OrigTy
3539 << "\n");
3540 Inst->mutateType(OrigTy);
3541 }
3542 };
3543
3544 /// Replace the uses of an instruction by another instruction.
3545 class UsesReplacer : public TypePromotionAction {
3546 /// Helper structure to keep track of the replaced uses.
3547 struct InstructionAndIdx {
3548 /// The instruction using the instruction.
3549 Instruction *Inst;
3550
3551 /// The index where this instruction is used for Inst.
3552 unsigned Idx;
3553
InstructionAndIdx__anon1d600f580d11::TypePromotionTransaction::UsesReplacer::InstructionAndIdx3554 InstructionAndIdx(Instruction *Inst, unsigned Idx)
3555 : Inst(Inst), Idx(Idx) {}
3556 };
3557
3558 /// Keep track of the original uses (pair Instruction, Index).
3559 SmallVector<InstructionAndIdx, 4> OriginalUses;
3560 /// Keep track of the debug users.
3561 SmallVector<DbgValueInst *, 1> DbgValues;
3562 /// And non-instruction debug-users too.
3563 SmallVector<DbgVariableRecord *, 1> DbgVariableRecords;
3564
3565 /// Keep track of the new value so that we can undo it by replacing
3566 /// instances of the new value with the original value.
3567 Value *New;
3568
3569 using use_iterator = SmallVectorImpl<InstructionAndIdx>::iterator;
3570
3571 public:
3572 /// Replace all the use of \p Inst by \p New.
UsesReplacer(Instruction * Inst,Value * New)3573 UsesReplacer(Instruction *Inst, Value *New)
3574 : TypePromotionAction(Inst), New(New) {
3575 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: UsersReplacer: " << *Inst << " with " << *New
3576 << "\n");
3577 // Record the original uses.
3578 for (Use &U : Inst->uses()) {
3579 Instruction *UserI = cast<Instruction>(U.getUser());
3580 OriginalUses.push_back(InstructionAndIdx(UserI, U.getOperandNo()));
3581 }
3582 // Record the debug uses separately. They are not in the instruction's
3583 // use list, but they are replaced by RAUW.
3584 findDbgValues(DbgValues, Inst, &DbgVariableRecords);
3585
3586 // Now, we can replace the uses.
3587 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
3588 }
3589
3590 /// Reassign the original uses of Inst to Inst.
undo()3591 void undo() override {
3592 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: UsersReplacer: " << *Inst << "\n");
3593 for (InstructionAndIdx &Use : OriginalUses)
3594 Use.Inst->setOperand(Use.Idx, Inst);
3595 // RAUW has replaced all original uses with references to the new value,
3596 // including the debug uses. Since we are undoing the replacements,
3597 // the original debug uses must also be reinstated to maintain the
3598 // correctness and utility of debug value instructions.
3599 for (auto *DVI : DbgValues)
3600 DVI->replaceVariableLocationOp(New, Inst);
3601 // Similar story with DbgVariableRecords, the non-instruction
3602 // representation of dbg.values.
3603 for (DbgVariableRecord *DVR : DbgVariableRecords)
3604 DVR->replaceVariableLocationOp(New, Inst);
3605 }
3606 };
3607
3608 /// Remove an instruction from the IR.
3609 class InstructionRemover : public TypePromotionAction {
3610 /// Original position of the instruction.
3611 InsertionHandler Inserter;
3612
3613 /// Helper structure to hide all the link to the instruction. In other
3614 /// words, this helps to do as if the instruction was removed.
3615 OperandsHider Hider;
3616
3617 /// Keep track of the uses replaced, if any.
3618 UsesReplacer *Replacer = nullptr;
3619
3620 /// Keep track of instructions removed.
3621 SetOfInstrs &RemovedInsts;
3622
3623 public:
3624 /// Remove all reference of \p Inst and optionally replace all its
3625 /// uses with New.
3626 /// \p RemovedInsts Keep track of the instructions removed by this Action.
3627 /// \pre If !Inst->use_empty(), then New != nullptr
InstructionRemover(Instruction * Inst,SetOfInstrs & RemovedInsts,Value * New=nullptr)3628 InstructionRemover(Instruction *Inst, SetOfInstrs &RemovedInsts,
3629 Value *New = nullptr)
3630 : TypePromotionAction(Inst), Inserter(Inst), Hider(Inst),
3631 RemovedInsts(RemovedInsts) {
3632 if (New)
3633 Replacer = new UsesReplacer(Inst, New);
3634 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: InstructionRemover: " << *Inst << "\n");
3635 RemovedInsts.insert(Inst);
3636 /// The instructions removed here will be freed after completing
3637 /// optimizeBlock() for all blocks as we need to keep track of the
3638 /// removed instructions during promotion.
3639 Inst->removeFromParent();
3640 }
3641
~InstructionRemover()3642 ~InstructionRemover() override { delete Replacer; }
3643
3644 InstructionRemover &operator=(const InstructionRemover &other) = delete;
3645 InstructionRemover(const InstructionRemover &other) = delete;
3646
3647 /// Resurrect the instruction and reassign it to the proper uses if
3648 /// new value was provided when build this action.
undo()3649 void undo() override {
3650 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: InstructionRemover: " << *Inst << "\n");
3651 Inserter.insert(Inst);
3652 if (Replacer)
3653 Replacer->undo();
3654 Hider.undo();
3655 RemovedInsts.erase(Inst);
3656 }
3657 };
3658
3659 public:
3660 /// Restoration point.
3661 /// The restoration point is a pointer to an action instead of an iterator
3662 /// because the iterator may be invalidated but not the pointer.
3663 using ConstRestorationPt = const TypePromotionAction *;
3664
TypePromotionTransaction(SetOfInstrs & RemovedInsts)3665 TypePromotionTransaction(SetOfInstrs &RemovedInsts)
3666 : RemovedInsts(RemovedInsts) {}
3667
3668 /// Advocate every changes made in that transaction. Return true if any change
3669 /// happen.
3670 bool commit();
3671
3672 /// Undo all the changes made after the given point.
3673 void rollback(ConstRestorationPt Point);
3674
3675 /// Get the current restoration point.
3676 ConstRestorationPt getRestorationPoint() const;
3677
3678 /// \name API for IR modification with state keeping to support rollback.
3679 /// @{
3680 /// Same as Instruction::setOperand.
3681 void setOperand(Instruction *Inst, unsigned Idx, Value *NewVal);
3682
3683 /// Same as Instruction::eraseFromParent.
3684 void eraseInstruction(Instruction *Inst, Value *NewVal = nullptr);
3685
3686 /// Same as Value::replaceAllUsesWith.
3687 void replaceAllUsesWith(Instruction *Inst, Value *New);
3688
3689 /// Same as Value::mutateType.
3690 void mutateType(Instruction *Inst, Type *NewTy);
3691
3692 /// Same as IRBuilder::createTrunc.
3693 Value *createTrunc(Instruction *Opnd, Type *Ty);
3694
3695 /// Same as IRBuilder::createSExt.
3696 Value *createSExt(Instruction *Inst, Value *Opnd, Type *Ty);
3697
3698 /// Same as IRBuilder::createZExt.
3699 Value *createZExt(Instruction *Inst, Value *Opnd, Type *Ty);
3700
3701 private:
3702 /// The ordered list of actions made so far.
3703 SmallVector<std::unique_ptr<TypePromotionAction>, 16> Actions;
3704
3705 using CommitPt =
3706 SmallVectorImpl<std::unique_ptr<TypePromotionAction>>::iterator;
3707
3708 SetOfInstrs &RemovedInsts;
3709 };
3710
3711 } // end anonymous namespace
3712
setOperand(Instruction * Inst,unsigned Idx,Value * NewVal)3713 void TypePromotionTransaction::setOperand(Instruction *Inst, unsigned Idx,
3714 Value *NewVal) {
3715 Actions.push_back(std::make_unique<TypePromotionTransaction::OperandSetter>(
3716 Inst, Idx, NewVal));
3717 }
3718
eraseInstruction(Instruction * Inst,Value * NewVal)3719 void TypePromotionTransaction::eraseInstruction(Instruction *Inst,
3720 Value *NewVal) {
3721 Actions.push_back(
3722 std::make_unique<TypePromotionTransaction::InstructionRemover>(
3723 Inst, RemovedInsts, NewVal));
3724 }
3725
replaceAllUsesWith(Instruction * Inst,Value * New)3726 void TypePromotionTransaction::replaceAllUsesWith(Instruction *Inst,
3727 Value *New) {
3728 Actions.push_back(
3729 std::make_unique<TypePromotionTransaction::UsesReplacer>(Inst, New));
3730 }
3731
mutateType(Instruction * Inst,Type * NewTy)3732 void TypePromotionTransaction::mutateType(Instruction *Inst, Type *NewTy) {
3733 Actions.push_back(
3734 std::make_unique<TypePromotionTransaction::TypeMutator>(Inst, NewTy));
3735 }
3736
createTrunc(Instruction * Opnd,Type * Ty)3737 Value *TypePromotionTransaction::createTrunc(Instruction *Opnd, Type *Ty) {
3738 std::unique_ptr<TruncBuilder> Ptr(new TruncBuilder(Opnd, Ty));
3739 Value *Val = Ptr->getBuiltValue();
3740 Actions.push_back(std::move(Ptr));
3741 return Val;
3742 }
3743
createSExt(Instruction * Inst,Value * Opnd,Type * Ty)3744 Value *TypePromotionTransaction::createSExt(Instruction *Inst, Value *Opnd,
3745 Type *Ty) {
3746 std::unique_ptr<SExtBuilder> Ptr(new SExtBuilder(Inst, Opnd, Ty));
3747 Value *Val = Ptr->getBuiltValue();
3748 Actions.push_back(std::move(Ptr));
3749 return Val;
3750 }
3751
createZExt(Instruction * Inst,Value * Opnd,Type * Ty)3752 Value *TypePromotionTransaction::createZExt(Instruction *Inst, Value *Opnd,
3753 Type *Ty) {
3754 std::unique_ptr<ZExtBuilder> Ptr(new ZExtBuilder(Inst, Opnd, Ty));
3755 Value *Val = Ptr->getBuiltValue();
3756 Actions.push_back(std::move(Ptr));
3757 return Val;
3758 }
3759
3760 TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt
getRestorationPoint() const3761 TypePromotionTransaction::getRestorationPoint() const {
3762 return !Actions.empty() ? Actions.back().get() : nullptr;
3763 }
3764
commit()3765 bool TypePromotionTransaction::commit() {
3766 for (std::unique_ptr<TypePromotionAction> &Action : Actions)
3767 Action->commit();
3768 bool Modified = !Actions.empty();
3769 Actions.clear();
3770 return Modified;
3771 }
3772
rollback(TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt Point)3773 void TypePromotionTransaction::rollback(
3774 TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt Point) {
3775 while (!Actions.empty() && Point != Actions.back().get()) {
3776 std::unique_ptr<TypePromotionAction> Curr = Actions.pop_back_val();
3777 Curr->undo();
3778 }
3779 }
3780
3781 namespace {
3782
3783 /// A helper class for matching addressing modes.
3784 ///
3785 /// This encapsulates the logic for matching the target-legal addressing modes.
3786 class AddressingModeMatcher {
3787 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &AddrModeInsts;
3788 const TargetLowering &TLI;
3789 const TargetRegisterInfo &TRI;
3790 const DataLayout &DL;
3791 const LoopInfo &LI;
3792 const std::function<const DominatorTree &()> getDTFn;
3793
3794 /// AccessTy/MemoryInst - This is the type for the access (e.g. double) and
3795 /// the memory instruction that we're computing this address for.
3796 Type *AccessTy;
3797 unsigned AddrSpace;
3798 Instruction *MemoryInst;
3799
3800 /// This is the addressing mode that we're building up. This is
3801 /// part of the return value of this addressing mode matching stuff.
3802 ExtAddrMode &AddrMode;
3803
3804 /// The instructions inserted by other CodeGenPrepare optimizations.
3805 const SetOfInstrs &InsertedInsts;
3806
3807 /// A map from the instructions to their type before promotion.
3808 InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts;
3809
3810 /// The ongoing transaction where every action should be registered.
3811 TypePromotionTransaction &TPT;
3812
3813 // A GEP which has too large offset to be folded into the addressing mode.
3814 std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t> &LargeOffsetGEP;
3815
3816 /// This is set to true when we should not do profitability checks.
3817 /// When true, IsProfitableToFoldIntoAddressingMode always returns true.
3818 bool IgnoreProfitability;
3819
3820 /// True if we are optimizing for size.
3821 bool OptSize = false;
3822
3823 ProfileSummaryInfo *PSI;
3824 BlockFrequencyInfo *BFI;
3825
AddressingModeMatcher(SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > & AMI,const TargetLowering & TLI,const TargetRegisterInfo & TRI,const LoopInfo & LI,const std::function<const DominatorTree & ()> getDTFn,Type * AT,unsigned AS,Instruction * MI,ExtAddrMode & AM,const SetOfInstrs & InsertedInsts,InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts,TypePromotionTransaction & TPT,std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>,int64_t> & LargeOffsetGEP,bool OptSize,ProfileSummaryInfo * PSI,BlockFrequencyInfo * BFI)3826 AddressingModeMatcher(
3827 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &AMI, const TargetLowering &TLI,
3828 const TargetRegisterInfo &TRI, const LoopInfo &LI,
3829 const std::function<const DominatorTree &()> getDTFn, Type *AT,
3830 unsigned AS, Instruction *MI, ExtAddrMode &AM,
3831 const SetOfInstrs &InsertedInsts, InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts,
3832 TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
3833 std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t> &LargeOffsetGEP,
3834 bool OptSize, ProfileSummaryInfo *PSI, BlockFrequencyInfo *BFI)
3835 : AddrModeInsts(AMI), TLI(TLI), TRI(TRI),
3836 DL(MI->getDataLayout()), LI(LI), getDTFn(getDTFn),
3837 AccessTy(AT), AddrSpace(AS), MemoryInst(MI), AddrMode(AM),
3838 InsertedInsts(InsertedInsts), PromotedInsts(PromotedInsts), TPT(TPT),
3839 LargeOffsetGEP(LargeOffsetGEP), OptSize(OptSize), PSI(PSI), BFI(BFI) {
3840 IgnoreProfitability = false;
3841 }
3842
3843 public:
3844 /// Find the maximal addressing mode that a load/store of V can fold,
3845 /// give an access type of AccessTy. This returns a list of involved
3846 /// instructions in AddrModeInsts.
3847 /// \p InsertedInsts The instructions inserted by other CodeGenPrepare
3848 /// optimizations.
3849 /// \p PromotedInsts maps the instructions to their type before promotion.
3850 /// \p The ongoing transaction where every action should be registered.
3851 static ExtAddrMode
Match(Value * V,Type * AccessTy,unsigned AS,Instruction * MemoryInst,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > & AddrModeInsts,const TargetLowering & TLI,const LoopInfo & LI,const std::function<const DominatorTree & ()> getDTFn,const TargetRegisterInfo & TRI,const SetOfInstrs & InsertedInsts,InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts,TypePromotionTransaction & TPT,std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>,int64_t> & LargeOffsetGEP,bool OptSize,ProfileSummaryInfo * PSI,BlockFrequencyInfo * BFI)3852 Match(Value *V, Type *AccessTy, unsigned AS, Instruction *MemoryInst,
3853 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &AddrModeInsts,
3854 const TargetLowering &TLI, const LoopInfo &LI,
3855 const std::function<const DominatorTree &()> getDTFn,
3856 const TargetRegisterInfo &TRI, const SetOfInstrs &InsertedInsts,
3857 InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
3858 std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t> &LargeOffsetGEP,
3859 bool OptSize, ProfileSummaryInfo *PSI, BlockFrequencyInfo *BFI) {
3860 ExtAddrMode Result;
3861
3862 bool Success = AddressingModeMatcher(AddrModeInsts, TLI, TRI, LI, getDTFn,
3863 AccessTy, AS, MemoryInst, Result,
3864 InsertedInsts, PromotedInsts, TPT,
3865 LargeOffsetGEP, OptSize, PSI, BFI)
3866 .matchAddr(V, 0);
3867 (void)Success;
3868 assert(Success && "Couldn't select *anything*?");
3869 return Result;
3870 }
3871
3872 private:
3873 bool matchScaledValue(Value *ScaleReg, int64_t Scale, unsigned Depth);
3874 bool matchAddr(Value *Addr, unsigned Depth);
3875 bool matchOperationAddr(User *AddrInst, unsigned Opcode, unsigned Depth,
3876 bool *MovedAway = nullptr);
3877 bool isProfitableToFoldIntoAddressingMode(Instruction *I,
3878 ExtAddrMode &AMBefore,
3879 ExtAddrMode &AMAfter);
3880 bool valueAlreadyLiveAtInst(Value *Val, Value *KnownLive1, Value *KnownLive2);
3881 bool isPromotionProfitable(unsigned NewCost, unsigned OldCost,
3882 Value *PromotedOperand) const;
3883 };
3884
3885 class PhiNodeSet;
3886
3887 /// An iterator for PhiNodeSet.
3888 class PhiNodeSetIterator {
3889 PhiNodeSet *const Set;
3890 size_t CurrentIndex = 0;
3891
3892 public:
3893 /// The constructor. Start should point to either a valid element, or be equal
3894 /// to the size of the underlying SmallVector of the PhiNodeSet.
3895 PhiNodeSetIterator(PhiNodeSet *const Set, size_t Start);
3896 PHINode *operator*() const;
3897 PhiNodeSetIterator &operator++();
3898 bool operator==(const PhiNodeSetIterator &RHS) const;
3899 bool operator!=(const PhiNodeSetIterator &RHS) const;
3900 };
3901
3902 /// Keeps a set of PHINodes.
3903 ///
3904 /// This is a minimal set implementation for a specific use case:
3905 /// It is very fast when there are very few elements, but also provides good
3906 /// performance when there are many. It is similar to SmallPtrSet, but also
3907 /// provides iteration by insertion order, which is deterministic and stable
3908 /// across runs. It is also similar to SmallSetVector, but provides removing
3909 /// elements in O(1) time. This is achieved by not actually removing the element
3910 /// from the underlying vector, so comes at the cost of using more memory, but
3911 /// that is fine, since PhiNodeSets are used as short lived objects.
3912 class PhiNodeSet {
3913 friend class PhiNodeSetIterator;
3914
3915 using MapType = SmallDenseMap<PHINode *, size_t, 32>;
3916 using iterator = PhiNodeSetIterator;
3917
3918 /// Keeps the elements in the order of their insertion in the underlying
3919 /// vector. To achieve constant time removal, it never deletes any element.
3920 SmallVector<PHINode *, 32> NodeList;
3921
3922 /// Keeps the elements in the underlying set implementation. This (and not the
3923 /// NodeList defined above) is the source of truth on whether an element
3924 /// is actually in the collection.
3925 MapType NodeMap;
3926
3927 /// Points to the first valid (not deleted) element when the set is not empty
3928 /// and the value is not zero. Equals to the size of the underlying vector
3929 /// when the set is empty. When the value is 0, as in the beginning, the
3930 /// first element may or may not be valid.
3931 size_t FirstValidElement = 0;
3932
3933 public:
3934 /// Inserts a new element to the collection.
3935 /// \returns true if the element is actually added, i.e. was not in the
3936 /// collection before the operation.
insert(PHINode * Ptr)3937 bool insert(PHINode *Ptr) {
3938 if (NodeMap.insert(std::make_pair(Ptr, NodeList.size())).second) {
3939 NodeList.push_back(Ptr);
3940 return true;
3941 }
3942 return false;
3943 }
3944
3945 /// Removes the element from the collection.
3946 /// \returns whether the element is actually removed, i.e. was in the
3947 /// collection before the operation.
erase(PHINode * Ptr)3948 bool erase(PHINode *Ptr) {
3949 if (NodeMap.erase(Ptr)) {
3950 SkipRemovedElements(FirstValidElement);
3951 return true;
3952 }
3953 return false;
3954 }
3955
3956 /// Removes all elements and clears the collection.
clear()3957 void clear() {
3958 NodeMap.clear();
3959 NodeList.clear();
3960 FirstValidElement = 0;
3961 }
3962
3963 /// \returns an iterator that will iterate the elements in the order of
3964 /// insertion.
begin()3965 iterator begin() {
3966 if (FirstValidElement == 0)
3967 SkipRemovedElements(FirstValidElement);
3968 return PhiNodeSetIterator(this, FirstValidElement);
3969 }
3970
3971 /// \returns an iterator that points to the end of the collection.
end()3972 iterator end() { return PhiNodeSetIterator(this, NodeList.size()); }
3973
3974 /// Returns the number of elements in the collection.
size() const3975 size_t size() const { return NodeMap.size(); }
3976
3977 /// \returns 1 if the given element is in the collection, and 0 if otherwise.
count(PHINode * Ptr) const3978 size_t count(PHINode *Ptr) const { return NodeMap.count(Ptr); }
3979
3980 private:
3981 /// Updates the CurrentIndex so that it will point to a valid element.
3982 ///
3983 /// If the element of NodeList at CurrentIndex is valid, it does not
3984 /// change it. If there are no more valid elements, it updates CurrentIndex
3985 /// to point to the end of the NodeList.
SkipRemovedElements(size_t & CurrentIndex)3986 void SkipRemovedElements(size_t &CurrentIndex) {
3987 while (CurrentIndex < NodeList.size()) {
3988 auto it = NodeMap.find(NodeList[CurrentIndex]);
3989 // If the element has been deleted and added again later, NodeMap will
3990 // point to a different index, so CurrentIndex will still be invalid.
3991 if (it != NodeMap.end() && it->second == CurrentIndex)
3992 break;
3993 ++CurrentIndex;
3994 }
3995 }
3996 };
3997
PhiNodeSetIterator(PhiNodeSet * const Set,size_t Start)3998 PhiNodeSetIterator::PhiNodeSetIterator(PhiNodeSet *const Set, size_t Start)
3999 : Set(Set), CurrentIndex(Start) {}
4000
operator *() const4001 PHINode *PhiNodeSetIterator::operator*() const {
4002 assert(CurrentIndex < Set->NodeList.size() &&
4003 "PhiNodeSet access out of range");
4004 return Set->NodeList[CurrentIndex];
4005 }
4006
operator ++()4007 PhiNodeSetIterator &PhiNodeSetIterator::operator++() {
4008 assert(CurrentIndex < Set->NodeList.size() &&
4009 "PhiNodeSet access out of range");
4010 ++CurrentIndex;
4011 Set->SkipRemovedElements(CurrentIndex);
4012 return *this;
4013 }
4014
operator ==(const PhiNodeSetIterator & RHS) const4015 bool PhiNodeSetIterator::operator==(const PhiNodeSetIterator &RHS) const {
4016 return CurrentIndex == RHS.CurrentIndex;
4017 }
4018
operator !=(const PhiNodeSetIterator & RHS) const4019 bool PhiNodeSetIterator::operator!=(const PhiNodeSetIterator &RHS) const {
4020 return !((*this) == RHS);
4021 }
4022
4023 /// Keep track of simplification of Phi nodes.
4024 /// Accept the set of all phi nodes and erase phi node from this set
4025 /// if it is simplified.
4026 class SimplificationTracker {
4027 DenseMap<Value *, Value *> Storage;
4028 const SimplifyQuery &SQ;
4029 // Tracks newly created Phi nodes. The elements are iterated by insertion
4030 // order.
4031 PhiNodeSet AllPhiNodes;
4032 // Tracks newly created Select nodes.
4033 SmallPtrSet<SelectInst *, 32> AllSelectNodes;
4034
4035 public:
SimplificationTracker(const SimplifyQuery & sq)4036 SimplificationTracker(const SimplifyQuery &sq) : SQ(sq) {}
4037
Get(Value * V)4038 Value *Get(Value *V) {
4039 do {
4040 auto SV = Storage.find(V);
4041 if (SV == Storage.end())
4042 return V;
4043 V = SV->second;
4044 } while (true);
4045 }
4046
Simplify(Value * Val)4047 Value *Simplify(Value *Val) {
4048 SmallVector<Value *, 32> WorkList;
4049 SmallPtrSet<Value *, 32> Visited;
4050 WorkList.push_back(Val);
4051 while (!WorkList.empty()) {
4052 auto *P = WorkList.pop_back_val();
4053 if (!Visited.insert(P).second)
4054 continue;
4055 if (auto *PI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(P))
4056 if (Value *V = simplifyInstruction(cast<Instruction>(PI), SQ)) {
4057 for (auto *U : PI->users())
4058 WorkList.push_back(cast<Value>(U));
4059 Put(PI, V);
4060 PI->replaceAllUsesWith(V);
4061 if (auto *PHI = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PI))
4062 AllPhiNodes.erase(PHI);
4063 if (auto *Select = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(PI))
4064 AllSelectNodes.erase(Select);
4065 PI->eraseFromParent();
4066 }
4067 }
4068 return Get(Val);
4069 }
4070
Put(Value * From,Value * To)4071 void Put(Value *From, Value *To) { Storage.insert({From, To}); }
4072
ReplacePhi(PHINode * From,PHINode * To)4073 void ReplacePhi(PHINode *From, PHINode *To) {
4074 Value *OldReplacement = Get(From);
4075 while (OldReplacement != From) {
4076 From = To;
4077 To = dyn_cast<PHINode>(OldReplacement);
4078 OldReplacement = Get(From);
4079 }
4080 assert(To && Get(To) == To && "Replacement PHI node is already replaced.");
4081 Put(From, To);
4082 From->replaceAllUsesWith(To);
4083 AllPhiNodes.erase(From);
4084 From->eraseFromParent();
4085 }
4086
newPhiNodes()4087 PhiNodeSet &newPhiNodes() { return AllPhiNodes; }
4088
insertNewPhi(PHINode * PN)4089 void insertNewPhi(PHINode *PN) { AllPhiNodes.insert(PN); }
4090
insertNewSelect(SelectInst * SI)4091 void insertNewSelect(SelectInst *SI) { AllSelectNodes.insert(SI); }
4092
countNewPhiNodes() const4093 unsigned countNewPhiNodes() const { return AllPhiNodes.size(); }
4094
countNewSelectNodes() const4095 unsigned countNewSelectNodes() const { return AllSelectNodes.size(); }
4096
destroyNewNodes(Type * CommonType)4097 void destroyNewNodes(Type *CommonType) {
4098 // For safe erasing, replace the uses with dummy value first.
4099 auto *Dummy = PoisonValue::get(CommonType);
4100 for (auto *I : AllPhiNodes) {
4101 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Dummy);
4102 I->eraseFromParent();
4103 }
4104 AllPhiNodes.clear();
4105 for (auto *I : AllSelectNodes) {
4106 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Dummy);
4107 I->eraseFromParent();
4108 }
4109 AllSelectNodes.clear();
4110 }
4111 };
4112
4113 /// A helper class for combining addressing modes.
4114 class AddressingModeCombiner {
4115 typedef DenseMap<Value *, Value *> FoldAddrToValueMapping;
4116 typedef std::pair<PHINode *, PHINode *> PHIPair;
4117
4118 private:
4119 /// The addressing modes we've collected.
4120 SmallVector<ExtAddrMode, 16> AddrModes;
4121
4122 /// The field in which the AddrModes differ, when we have more than one.
4123 ExtAddrMode::FieldName DifferentField = ExtAddrMode::NoField;
4124
4125 /// Are the AddrModes that we have all just equal to their original values?
4126 bool AllAddrModesTrivial = true;
4127
4128 /// Common Type for all different fields in addressing modes.
4129 Type *CommonType = nullptr;
4130
4131 /// SimplifyQuery for simplifyInstruction utility.
4132 const SimplifyQuery &SQ;
4133
4134 /// Original Address.
4135 Value *Original;
4136
4137 /// Common value among addresses
4138 Value *CommonValue = nullptr;
4139
4140 public:
AddressingModeCombiner(const SimplifyQuery & _SQ,Value * OriginalValue)4141 AddressingModeCombiner(const SimplifyQuery &_SQ, Value *OriginalValue)
4142 : SQ(_SQ), Original(OriginalValue) {}
4143
~AddressingModeCombiner()4144 ~AddressingModeCombiner() { eraseCommonValueIfDead(); }
4145
4146 /// Get the combined AddrMode
getAddrMode() const4147 const ExtAddrMode &getAddrMode() const { return AddrModes[0]; }
4148
4149 /// Add a new AddrMode if it's compatible with the AddrModes we already
4150 /// have.
4151 /// \return True iff we succeeded in doing so.
addNewAddrMode(ExtAddrMode & NewAddrMode)4152 bool addNewAddrMode(ExtAddrMode &NewAddrMode) {
4153 // Take note of if we have any non-trivial AddrModes, as we need to detect
4154 // when all AddrModes are trivial as then we would introduce a phi or select
4155 // which just duplicates what's already there.
4156 AllAddrModesTrivial = AllAddrModesTrivial && NewAddrMode.isTrivial();
4157
4158 // If this is the first addrmode then everything is fine.
4159 if (AddrModes.empty()) {
4160 AddrModes.emplace_back(NewAddrMode);
4161 return true;
4162 }
4163
4164 // Figure out how different this is from the other address modes, which we
4165 // can do just by comparing against the first one given that we only care
4166 // about the cumulative difference.
4167 ExtAddrMode::FieldName ThisDifferentField =
4168 AddrModes[0].compare(NewAddrMode);
4169 if (DifferentField == ExtAddrMode::NoField)
4170 DifferentField = ThisDifferentField;
4171 else if (DifferentField != ThisDifferentField)
4172 DifferentField = ExtAddrMode::MultipleFields;
4173
4174 // If NewAddrMode differs in more than one dimension we cannot handle it.
4175 bool CanHandle = DifferentField != ExtAddrMode::MultipleFields;
4176
4177 // If Scale Field is different then we reject.
4178 CanHandle = CanHandle && DifferentField != ExtAddrMode::ScaleField;
4179
4180 // We also must reject the case when base offset is different and
4181 // scale reg is not null, we cannot handle this case due to merge of
4182 // different offsets will be used as ScaleReg.
4183 CanHandle = CanHandle && (DifferentField != ExtAddrMode::BaseOffsField ||
4184 !NewAddrMode.ScaledReg);
4185
4186 // We also must reject the case when GV is different and BaseReg installed
4187 // due to we want to use base reg as a merge of GV values.
4188 CanHandle = CanHandle && (DifferentField != ExtAddrMode::BaseGVField ||
4189 !NewAddrMode.HasBaseReg);
4190
4191 // Even if NewAddMode is the same we still need to collect it due to
4192 // original value is different. And later we will need all original values
4193 // as anchors during finding the common Phi node.
4194 if (CanHandle)
4195 AddrModes.emplace_back(NewAddrMode);
4196 else
4197 AddrModes.clear();
4198
4199 return CanHandle;
4200 }
4201
4202 /// Combine the addressing modes we've collected into a single
4203 /// addressing mode.
4204 /// \return True iff we successfully combined them or we only had one so
4205 /// didn't need to combine them anyway.
combineAddrModes()4206 bool combineAddrModes() {
4207 // If we have no AddrModes then they can't be combined.
4208 if (AddrModes.size() == 0)
4209 return false;
4210
4211 // A single AddrMode can trivially be combined.
4212 if (AddrModes.size() == 1 || DifferentField == ExtAddrMode::NoField)
4213 return true;
4214
4215 // If the AddrModes we collected are all just equal to the value they are
4216 // derived from then combining them wouldn't do anything useful.
4217 if (AllAddrModesTrivial)
4218 return false;
4219
4220 if (!addrModeCombiningAllowed())
4221 return false;
4222
4223 // Build a map between <original value, basic block where we saw it> to
4224 // value of base register.
4225 // Bail out if there is no common type.
4226 FoldAddrToValueMapping Map;
4227 if (!initializeMap(Map))
4228 return false;
4229
4230 CommonValue = findCommon(Map);
4231 if (CommonValue)
4232 AddrModes[0].SetCombinedField(DifferentField, CommonValue, AddrModes);
4233 return CommonValue != nullptr;
4234 }
4235
4236 private:
4237 /// `CommonValue` may be a placeholder inserted by us.
4238 /// If the placeholder is not used, we should remove this dead instruction.
eraseCommonValueIfDead()4239 void eraseCommonValueIfDead() {
4240 if (CommonValue && CommonValue->use_empty())
4241 if (Instruction *CommonInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CommonValue))
4242 CommonInst->eraseFromParent();
4243 }
4244
4245 /// Initialize Map with anchor values. For address seen
4246 /// we set the value of different field saw in this address.
4247 /// At the same time we find a common type for different field we will
4248 /// use to create new Phi/Select nodes. Keep it in CommonType field.
4249 /// Return false if there is no common type found.
initializeMap(FoldAddrToValueMapping & Map)4250 bool initializeMap(FoldAddrToValueMapping &Map) {
4251 // Keep track of keys where the value is null. We will need to replace it
4252 // with constant null when we know the common type.
4253 SmallVector<Value *, 2> NullValue;
4254 Type *IntPtrTy = SQ.DL.getIntPtrType(AddrModes[0].OriginalValue->getType());
4255 for (auto &AM : AddrModes) {
4256 Value *DV = AM.GetFieldAsValue(DifferentField, IntPtrTy);
4257 if (DV) {
4258 auto *Type = DV->getType();
4259 if (CommonType && CommonType != Type)
4260 return false;
4261 CommonType = Type;
4262 Map[AM.OriginalValue] = DV;
4263 } else {
4264 NullValue.push_back(AM.OriginalValue);
4265 }
4266 }
4267 assert(CommonType && "At least one non-null value must be!");
4268 for (auto *V : NullValue)
4269 Map[V] = Constant::getNullValue(CommonType);
4270 return true;
4271 }
4272
4273 /// We have mapping between value A and other value B where B was a field in
4274 /// addressing mode represented by A. Also we have an original value C
4275 /// representing an address we start with. Traversing from C through phi and
4276 /// selects we ended up with A's in a map. This utility function tries to find
4277 /// a value V which is a field in addressing mode C and traversing through phi
4278 /// nodes and selects we will end up in corresponded values B in a map.
4279 /// The utility will create a new Phi/Selects if needed.
4280 // The simple example looks as follows:
4281 // BB1:
4282 // p1 = b1 + 40
4283 // br cond BB2, BB3
4284 // BB2:
4285 // p2 = b2 + 40
4286 // br BB3
4287 // BB3:
4288 // p = phi [p1, BB1], [p2, BB2]
4289 // v = load p
4290 // Map is
4291 // p1 -> b1
4292 // p2 -> b2
4293 // Request is
4294 // p -> ?
4295 // The function tries to find or build phi [b1, BB1], [b2, BB2] in BB3.
findCommon(FoldAddrToValueMapping & Map)4296 Value *findCommon(FoldAddrToValueMapping &Map) {
4297 // Tracks the simplification of newly created phi nodes. The reason we use
4298 // this mapping is because we will add new created Phi nodes in AddrToBase.
4299 // Simplification of Phi nodes is recursive, so some Phi node may
4300 // be simplified after we added it to AddrToBase. In reality this
4301 // simplification is possible only if original phi/selects were not
4302 // simplified yet.
4303 // Using this mapping we can find the current value in AddrToBase.
4304 SimplificationTracker ST(SQ);
4305
4306 // First step, DFS to create PHI nodes for all intermediate blocks.
4307 // Also fill traverse order for the second step.
4308 SmallVector<Value *, 32> TraverseOrder;
4309 InsertPlaceholders(Map, TraverseOrder, ST);
4310
4311 // Second Step, fill new nodes by merged values and simplify if possible.
4312 FillPlaceholders(Map, TraverseOrder, ST);
4313
4314 if (!AddrSinkNewSelects && ST.countNewSelectNodes() > 0) {
4315 ST.destroyNewNodes(CommonType);
4316 return nullptr;
4317 }
4318
4319 // Now we'd like to match New Phi nodes to existed ones.
4320 unsigned PhiNotMatchedCount = 0;
4321 if (!MatchPhiSet(ST, AddrSinkNewPhis, PhiNotMatchedCount)) {
4322 ST.destroyNewNodes(CommonType);
4323 return nullptr;
4324 }
4325
4326 auto *Result = ST.Get(Map.find(Original)->second);
4327 if (Result) {
4328 NumMemoryInstsPhiCreated += ST.countNewPhiNodes() + PhiNotMatchedCount;
4329 NumMemoryInstsSelectCreated += ST.countNewSelectNodes();
4330 }
4331 return Result;
4332 }
4333
4334 /// Try to match PHI node to Candidate.
4335 /// Matcher tracks the matched Phi nodes.
MatchPhiNode(PHINode * PHI,PHINode * Candidate,SmallSetVector<PHIPair,8> & Matcher,PhiNodeSet & PhiNodesToMatch)4336 bool MatchPhiNode(PHINode *PHI, PHINode *Candidate,
4337 SmallSetVector<PHIPair, 8> &Matcher,
4338 PhiNodeSet &PhiNodesToMatch) {
4339 SmallVector<PHIPair, 8> WorkList;
4340 Matcher.insert({PHI, Candidate});
4341 SmallSet<PHINode *, 8> MatchedPHIs;
4342 MatchedPHIs.insert(PHI);
4343 WorkList.push_back({PHI, Candidate});
4344 SmallSet<PHIPair, 8> Visited;
4345 while (!WorkList.empty()) {
4346 auto Item = WorkList.pop_back_val();
4347 if (!Visited.insert(Item).second)
4348 continue;
4349 // We iterate over all incoming values to Phi to compare them.
4350 // If values are different and both of them Phi and the first one is a
4351 // Phi we added (subject to match) and both of them is in the same basic
4352 // block then we can match our pair if values match. So we state that
4353 // these values match and add it to work list to verify that.
4354 for (auto *B : Item.first->blocks()) {
4355 Value *FirstValue = Item.first->getIncomingValueForBlock(B);
4356 Value *SecondValue = Item.second->getIncomingValueForBlock(B);
4357 if (FirstValue == SecondValue)
4358 continue;
4359
4360 PHINode *FirstPhi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(FirstValue);
4361 PHINode *SecondPhi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(SecondValue);
4362
4363 // One of them is not Phi or
4364 // The first one is not Phi node from the set we'd like to match or
4365 // Phi nodes from different basic blocks then
4366 // we will not be able to match.
4367 if (!FirstPhi || !SecondPhi || !PhiNodesToMatch.count(FirstPhi) ||
4368 FirstPhi->getParent() != SecondPhi->getParent())
4369 return false;
4370
4371 // If we already matched them then continue.
4372 if (Matcher.count({FirstPhi, SecondPhi}))
4373 continue;
4374 // So the values are different and does not match. So we need them to
4375 // match. (But we register no more than one match per PHI node, so that
4376 // we won't later try to replace them twice.)
4377 if (MatchedPHIs.insert(FirstPhi).second)
4378 Matcher.insert({FirstPhi, SecondPhi});
4379 // But me must check it.
4380 WorkList.push_back({FirstPhi, SecondPhi});
4381 }
4382 }
4383 return true;
4384 }
4385
4386 /// For the given set of PHI nodes (in the SimplificationTracker) try
4387 /// to find their equivalents.
4388 /// Returns false if this matching fails and creation of new Phi is disabled.
MatchPhiSet(SimplificationTracker & ST,bool AllowNewPhiNodes,unsigned & PhiNotMatchedCount)4389 bool MatchPhiSet(SimplificationTracker &ST, bool AllowNewPhiNodes,
4390 unsigned &PhiNotMatchedCount) {
4391 // Matched and PhiNodesToMatch iterate their elements in a deterministic
4392 // order, so the replacements (ReplacePhi) are also done in a deterministic
4393 // order.
4394 SmallSetVector<PHIPair, 8> Matched;
4395 SmallPtrSet<PHINode *, 8> WillNotMatch;
4396 PhiNodeSet &PhiNodesToMatch = ST.newPhiNodes();
4397 while (PhiNodesToMatch.size()) {
4398 PHINode *PHI = *PhiNodesToMatch.begin();
4399
4400 // Add us, if no Phi nodes in the basic block we do not match.
4401 WillNotMatch.clear();
4402 WillNotMatch.insert(PHI);
4403
4404 // Traverse all Phis until we found equivalent or fail to do that.
4405 bool IsMatched = false;
4406 for (auto &P : PHI->getParent()->phis()) {
4407 // Skip new Phi nodes.
4408 if (PhiNodesToMatch.count(&P))
4409 continue;
4410 if ((IsMatched = MatchPhiNode(PHI, &P, Matched, PhiNodesToMatch)))
4411 break;
4412 // If it does not match, collect all Phi nodes from matcher.
4413 // if we end up with no match, them all these Phi nodes will not match
4414 // later.
4415 WillNotMatch.insert_range(llvm::make_first_range(Matched));
4416 Matched.clear();
4417 }
4418 if (IsMatched) {
4419 // Replace all matched values and erase them.
4420 for (auto MV : Matched)
4421 ST.ReplacePhi(MV.first, MV.second);
4422 Matched.clear();
4423 continue;
4424 }
4425 // If we are not allowed to create new nodes then bail out.
4426 if (!AllowNewPhiNodes)
4427 return false;
4428 // Just remove all seen values in matcher. They will not match anything.
4429 PhiNotMatchedCount += WillNotMatch.size();
4430 for (auto *P : WillNotMatch)
4431 PhiNodesToMatch.erase(P);
4432 }
4433 return true;
4434 }
4435 /// Fill the placeholders with values from predecessors and simplify them.
FillPlaceholders(FoldAddrToValueMapping & Map,SmallVectorImpl<Value * > & TraverseOrder,SimplificationTracker & ST)4436 void FillPlaceholders(FoldAddrToValueMapping &Map,
4437 SmallVectorImpl<Value *> &TraverseOrder,
4438 SimplificationTracker &ST) {
4439 while (!TraverseOrder.empty()) {
4440 Value *Current = TraverseOrder.pop_back_val();
4441 assert(Map.contains(Current) && "No node to fill!!!");
4442 Value *V = Map[Current];
4443
4444 if (SelectInst *Select = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(V)) {
4445 // CurrentValue also must be Select.
4446 auto *CurrentSelect = cast<SelectInst>(Current);
4447 auto *TrueValue = CurrentSelect->getTrueValue();
4448 assert(Map.contains(TrueValue) && "No True Value!");
4449 Select->setTrueValue(ST.Get(Map[TrueValue]));
4450 auto *FalseValue = CurrentSelect->getFalseValue();
4451 assert(Map.contains(FalseValue) && "No False Value!");
4452 Select->setFalseValue(ST.Get(Map[FalseValue]));
4453 } else {
4454 // Must be a Phi node then.
4455 auto *PHI = cast<PHINode>(V);
4456 // Fill the Phi node with values from predecessors.
4457 for (auto *B : predecessors(PHI->getParent())) {
4458 Value *PV = cast<PHINode>(Current)->getIncomingValueForBlock(B);
4459 assert(Map.contains(PV) && "No predecessor Value!");
4460 PHI->addIncoming(ST.Get(Map[PV]), B);
4461 }
4462 }
4463 Map[Current] = ST.Simplify(V);
4464 }
4465 }
4466
4467 /// Starting from original value recursively iterates over def-use chain up to
4468 /// known ending values represented in a map. For each traversed phi/select
4469 /// inserts a placeholder Phi or Select.
4470 /// Reports all new created Phi/Select nodes by adding them to set.
4471 /// Also reports and order in what values have been traversed.
InsertPlaceholders(FoldAddrToValueMapping & Map,SmallVectorImpl<Value * > & TraverseOrder,SimplificationTracker & ST)4472 void InsertPlaceholders(FoldAddrToValueMapping &Map,
4473 SmallVectorImpl<Value *> &TraverseOrder,
4474 SimplificationTracker &ST) {
4475 SmallVector<Value *, 32> Worklist;
4476 assert((isa<PHINode>(Original) || isa<SelectInst>(Original)) &&
4477 "Address must be a Phi or Select node");
4478 auto *Dummy = PoisonValue::get(CommonType);
4479 Worklist.push_back(Original);
4480 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
4481 Value *Current = Worklist.pop_back_val();
4482 // if it is already visited or it is an ending value then skip it.
4483 if (Map.contains(Current))
4484 continue;
4485 TraverseOrder.push_back(Current);
4486
4487 // CurrentValue must be a Phi node or select. All others must be covered
4488 // by anchors.
4489 if (SelectInst *CurrentSelect = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Current)) {
4490 // Is it OK to get metadata from OrigSelect?!
4491 // Create a Select placeholder with dummy value.
4492 SelectInst *Select =
4493 SelectInst::Create(CurrentSelect->getCondition(), Dummy, Dummy,
4494 CurrentSelect->getName(),
4495 CurrentSelect->getIterator(), CurrentSelect);
4496 Map[Current] = Select;
4497 ST.insertNewSelect(Select);
4498 // We are interested in True and False values.
4499 Worklist.push_back(CurrentSelect->getTrueValue());
4500 Worklist.push_back(CurrentSelect->getFalseValue());
4501 } else {
4502 // It must be a Phi node then.
4503 PHINode *CurrentPhi = cast<PHINode>(Current);
4504 unsigned PredCount = CurrentPhi->getNumIncomingValues();
4505 PHINode *PHI =
4506 PHINode::Create(CommonType, PredCount, "sunk_phi", CurrentPhi->getIterator());
4507 Map[Current] = PHI;
4508 ST.insertNewPhi(PHI);
4509 append_range(Worklist, CurrentPhi->incoming_values());
4510 }
4511 }
4512 }
4513
addrModeCombiningAllowed()4514 bool addrModeCombiningAllowed() {
4515 if (DisableComplexAddrModes)
4516 return false;
4517 switch (DifferentField) {
4518 default:
4519 return false;
4520 case ExtAddrMode::BaseRegField:
4521 return AddrSinkCombineBaseReg;
4522 case ExtAddrMode::BaseGVField:
4523 return AddrSinkCombineBaseGV;
4524 case ExtAddrMode::BaseOffsField:
4525 return AddrSinkCombineBaseOffs;
4526 case ExtAddrMode::ScaledRegField:
4527 return AddrSinkCombineScaledReg;
4528 }
4529 }
4530 };
4531 } // end anonymous namespace
4532
4533 /// Try adding ScaleReg*Scale to the current addressing mode.
4534 /// Return true and update AddrMode if this addr mode is legal for the target,
4535 /// false if not.
matchScaledValue(Value * ScaleReg,int64_t Scale,unsigned Depth)4536 bool AddressingModeMatcher::matchScaledValue(Value *ScaleReg, int64_t Scale,
4537 unsigned Depth) {
4538 // If Scale is 1, then this is the same as adding ScaleReg to the addressing
4539 // mode. Just process that directly.
4540 if (Scale == 1)
4541 return matchAddr(ScaleReg, Depth);
4542
4543 // If the scale is 0, it takes nothing to add this.
4544 if (Scale == 0)
4545 return true;
4546
4547 // If we already have a scale of this value, we can add to it, otherwise, we
4548 // need an available scale field.
4549 if (AddrMode.Scale != 0 && AddrMode.ScaledReg != ScaleReg)
4550 return false;
4551
4552 ExtAddrMode TestAddrMode = AddrMode;
4553
4554 // Add scale to turn X*4+X*3 -> X*7. This could also do things like
4555 // [A+B + A*7] -> [B+A*8].
4556 TestAddrMode.Scale += Scale;
4557 TestAddrMode.ScaledReg = ScaleReg;
4558
4559 // If the new address isn't legal, bail out.
4560 if (!TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, TestAddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace))
4561 return false;
4562
4563 // It was legal, so commit it.
4564 AddrMode = TestAddrMode;
4565
4566 // Okay, we decided that we can add ScaleReg+Scale to AddrMode. Check now
4567 // to see if ScaleReg is actually X+C. If so, we can turn this into adding
4568 // X*Scale + C*Scale to addr mode. If we found available IV increment, do not
4569 // go any further: we can reuse it and cannot eliminate it.
4570 ConstantInt *CI = nullptr;
4571 Value *AddLHS = nullptr;
4572 if (isa<Instruction>(ScaleReg) && // not a constant expr.
4573 match(ScaleReg, m_Add(m_Value(AddLHS), m_ConstantInt(CI))) &&
4574 !isIVIncrement(ScaleReg, &LI) && CI->getValue().isSignedIntN(64)) {
4575 TestAddrMode.InBounds = false;
4576 TestAddrMode.ScaledReg = AddLHS;
4577 TestAddrMode.BaseOffs += CI->getSExtValue() * TestAddrMode.Scale;
4578
4579 // If this addressing mode is legal, commit it and remember that we folded
4580 // this instruction.
4581 if (TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, TestAddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace)) {
4582 AddrModeInsts.push_back(cast<Instruction>(ScaleReg));
4583 AddrMode = TestAddrMode;
4584 return true;
4585 }
4586 // Restore status quo.
4587 TestAddrMode = AddrMode;
4588 }
4589
4590 // If this is an add recurrence with a constant step, return the increment
4591 // instruction and the canonicalized step.
4592 auto GetConstantStep =
4593 [this](const Value *V) -> std::optional<std::pair<Instruction *, APInt>> {
4594 auto *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V);
4595 if (!PN)
4596 return std::nullopt;
4597 auto IVInc = getIVIncrement(PN, &LI);
4598 if (!IVInc)
4599 return std::nullopt;
4600 // TODO: The result of the intrinsics above is two-complement. However when
4601 // IV inc is expressed as add or sub, iv.next is potentially a poison value.
4602 // If it has nuw or nsw flags, we need to make sure that these flags are
4603 // inferrable at the point of memory instruction. Otherwise we are replacing
4604 // well-defined two-complement computation with poison. Currently, to avoid
4605 // potentially complex analysis needed to prove this, we reject such cases.
4606 if (auto *OIVInc = dyn_cast<OverflowingBinaryOperator>(IVInc->first))
4607 if (OIVInc->hasNoSignedWrap() || OIVInc->hasNoUnsignedWrap())
4608 return std::nullopt;
4609 if (auto *ConstantStep = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IVInc->second))
4610 return std::make_pair(IVInc->first, ConstantStep->getValue());
4611 return std::nullopt;
4612 };
4613
4614 // Try to account for the following special case:
4615 // 1. ScaleReg is an inductive variable;
4616 // 2. We use it with non-zero offset;
4617 // 3. IV's increment is available at the point of memory instruction.
4618 //
4619 // In this case, we may reuse the IV increment instead of the IV Phi to
4620 // achieve the following advantages:
4621 // 1. If IV step matches the offset, we will have no need in the offset;
4622 // 2. Even if they don't match, we will reduce the overlap of living IV
4623 // and IV increment, that will potentially lead to better register
4624 // assignment.
4625 if (AddrMode.BaseOffs) {
4626 if (auto IVStep = GetConstantStep(ScaleReg)) {
4627 Instruction *IVInc = IVStep->first;
4628 // The following assert is important to ensure a lack of infinite loops.
4629 // This transforms is (intentionally) the inverse of the one just above.
4630 // If they don't agree on the definition of an increment, we'd alternate
4631 // back and forth indefinitely.
4632 assert(isIVIncrement(IVInc, &LI) && "implied by GetConstantStep");
4633 APInt Step = IVStep->second;
4634 APInt Offset = Step * AddrMode.Scale;
4635 if (Offset.isSignedIntN(64)) {
4636 TestAddrMode.InBounds = false;
4637 TestAddrMode.ScaledReg = IVInc;
4638 TestAddrMode.BaseOffs -= Offset.getLimitedValue();
4639 // If this addressing mode is legal, commit it..
4640 // (Note that we defer the (expensive) domtree base legality check
4641 // to the very last possible point.)
4642 if (TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, TestAddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace) &&
4643 getDTFn().dominates(IVInc, MemoryInst)) {
4644 AddrModeInsts.push_back(cast<Instruction>(IVInc));
4645 AddrMode = TestAddrMode;
4646 return true;
4647 }
4648 // Restore status quo.
4649 TestAddrMode = AddrMode;
4650 }
4651 }
4652 }
4653
4654 // Otherwise, just return what we have.
4655 return true;
4656 }
4657
4658 /// This is a little filter, which returns true if an addressing computation
4659 /// involving I might be folded into a load/store accessing it.
4660 /// This doesn't need to be perfect, but needs to accept at least
4661 /// the set of instructions that MatchOperationAddr can.
MightBeFoldableInst(Instruction * I)4662 static bool MightBeFoldableInst(Instruction *I) {
4663 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
4664 case Instruction::BitCast:
4665 case Instruction::AddrSpaceCast:
4666 // Don't touch identity bitcasts.
4667 if (I->getType() == I->getOperand(0)->getType())
4668 return false;
4669 return I->getType()->isIntOrPtrTy();
4670 case Instruction::PtrToInt:
4671 // PtrToInt is always a noop, as we know that the int type is pointer sized.
4672 return true;
4673 case Instruction::IntToPtr:
4674 // We know the input is intptr_t, so this is foldable.
4675 return true;
4676 case Instruction::Add:
4677 return true;
4678 case Instruction::Mul:
4679 case Instruction::Shl:
4680 // Can only handle X*C and X << C.
4681 return isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1));
4682 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
4683 return true;
4684 default:
4685 return false;
4686 }
4687 }
4688
4689 /// Check whether or not \p Val is a legal instruction for \p TLI.
4690 /// \note \p Val is assumed to be the product of some type promotion.
4691 /// Therefore if \p Val has an undefined state in \p TLI, this is assumed
4692 /// to be legal, as the non-promoted value would have had the same state.
isPromotedInstructionLegal(const TargetLowering & TLI,const DataLayout & DL,Value * Val)4693 static bool isPromotedInstructionLegal(const TargetLowering &TLI,
4694 const DataLayout &DL, Value *Val) {
4695 Instruction *PromotedInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val);
4696 if (!PromotedInst)
4697 return false;
4698 int ISDOpcode = TLI.InstructionOpcodeToISD(PromotedInst->getOpcode());
4699 // If the ISDOpcode is undefined, it was undefined before the promotion.
4700 if (!ISDOpcode)
4701 return true;
4702 // Otherwise, check if the promoted instruction is legal or not.
4703 return TLI.isOperationLegalOrCustom(
4704 ISDOpcode, TLI.getValueType(DL, PromotedInst->getType()));
4705 }
4706
4707 namespace {
4708
4709 /// Hepler class to perform type promotion.
4710 class TypePromotionHelper {
4711 /// Utility function to add a promoted instruction \p ExtOpnd to
4712 /// \p PromotedInsts and record the type of extension we have seen.
addPromotedInst(InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts,Instruction * ExtOpnd,bool IsSExt)4713 static void addPromotedInst(InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts,
4714 Instruction *ExtOpnd, bool IsSExt) {
4715 ExtType ExtTy = IsSExt ? SignExtension : ZeroExtension;
4716 auto [It, Inserted] = PromotedInsts.try_emplace(ExtOpnd);
4717 if (!Inserted) {
4718 // If the new extension is same as original, the information in
4719 // PromotedInsts[ExtOpnd] is still correct.
4720 if (It->second.getInt() == ExtTy)
4721 return;
4722
4723 // Now the new extension is different from old extension, we make
4724 // the type information invalid by setting extension type to
4725 // BothExtension.
4726 ExtTy = BothExtension;
4727 }
4728 It->second = TypeIsSExt(ExtOpnd->getType(), ExtTy);
4729 }
4730
4731 /// Utility function to query the original type of instruction \p Opnd
4732 /// with a matched extension type. If the extension doesn't match, we
4733 /// cannot use the information we had on the original type.
4734 /// BothExtension doesn't match any extension type.
getOrigType(const InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts,Instruction * Opnd,bool IsSExt)4735 static const Type *getOrigType(const InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts,
4736 Instruction *Opnd, bool IsSExt) {
4737 ExtType ExtTy = IsSExt ? SignExtension : ZeroExtension;
4738 InstrToOrigTy::const_iterator It = PromotedInsts.find(Opnd);
4739 if (It != PromotedInsts.end() && It->second.getInt() == ExtTy)
4740 return It->second.getPointer();
4741 return nullptr;
4742 }
4743
4744 /// Utility function to check whether or not a sign or zero extension
4745 /// of \p Inst with \p ConsideredExtType can be moved through \p Inst by
4746 /// either using the operands of \p Inst or promoting \p Inst.
4747 /// The type of the extension is defined by \p IsSExt.
4748 /// In other words, check if:
4749 /// ext (Ty Inst opnd1 opnd2 ... opndN) to ConsideredExtType.
4750 /// #1 Promotion applies:
4751 /// ConsideredExtType Inst (ext opnd1 to ConsideredExtType, ...).
4752 /// #2 Operand reuses:
4753 /// ext opnd1 to ConsideredExtType.
4754 /// \p PromotedInsts maps the instructions to their type before promotion.
4755 static bool canGetThrough(const Instruction *Inst, Type *ConsideredExtType,
4756 const InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, bool IsSExt);
4757
4758 /// Utility function to determine if \p OpIdx should be promoted when
4759 /// promoting \p Inst.
shouldExtOperand(const Instruction * Inst,int OpIdx)4760 static bool shouldExtOperand(const Instruction *Inst, int OpIdx) {
4761 return !(isa<SelectInst>(Inst) && OpIdx == 0);
4762 }
4763
4764 /// Utility function to promote the operand of \p Ext when this
4765 /// operand is a promotable trunc or sext or zext.
4766 /// \p PromotedInsts maps the instructions to their type before promotion.
4767 /// \p CreatedInstsCost[out] contains the cost of all instructions
4768 /// created to promote the operand of Ext.
4769 /// Newly added extensions are inserted in \p Exts.
4770 /// Newly added truncates are inserted in \p Truncs.
4771 /// Should never be called directly.
4772 /// \return The promoted value which is used instead of Ext.
4773 static Value *promoteOperandForTruncAndAnyExt(
4774 Instruction *Ext, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
4775 InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
4776 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
4777 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs, const TargetLowering &TLI);
4778
4779 /// Utility function to promote the operand of \p Ext when this
4780 /// operand is promotable and is not a supported trunc or sext.
4781 /// \p PromotedInsts maps the instructions to their type before promotion.
4782 /// \p CreatedInstsCost[out] contains the cost of all the instructions
4783 /// created to promote the operand of Ext.
4784 /// Newly added extensions are inserted in \p Exts.
4785 /// Newly added truncates are inserted in \p Truncs.
4786 /// Should never be called directly.
4787 /// \return The promoted value which is used instead of Ext.
4788 static Value *promoteOperandForOther(Instruction *Ext,
4789 TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
4790 InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts,
4791 unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
4792 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
4793 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs,
4794 const TargetLowering &TLI, bool IsSExt);
4795
4796 /// \see promoteOperandForOther.
signExtendOperandForOther(Instruction * Ext,TypePromotionTransaction & TPT,InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts,unsigned & CreatedInstsCost,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > * Exts,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > * Truncs,const TargetLowering & TLI)4797 static Value *signExtendOperandForOther(
4798 Instruction *Ext, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
4799 InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
4800 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
4801 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs, const TargetLowering &TLI) {
4802 return promoteOperandForOther(Ext, TPT, PromotedInsts, CreatedInstsCost,
4803 Exts, Truncs, TLI, true);
4804 }
4805
4806 /// \see promoteOperandForOther.
zeroExtendOperandForOther(Instruction * Ext,TypePromotionTransaction & TPT,InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts,unsigned & CreatedInstsCost,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > * Exts,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > * Truncs,const TargetLowering & TLI)4807 static Value *zeroExtendOperandForOther(
4808 Instruction *Ext, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
4809 InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
4810 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
4811 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs, const TargetLowering &TLI) {
4812 return promoteOperandForOther(Ext, TPT, PromotedInsts, CreatedInstsCost,
4813 Exts, Truncs, TLI, false);
4814 }
4815
4816 public:
4817 /// Type for the utility function that promotes the operand of Ext.
4818 using Action = Value *(*)(Instruction *Ext, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
4819 InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts,
4820 unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
4821 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
4822 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs,
4823 const TargetLowering &TLI);
4824
4825 /// Given a sign/zero extend instruction \p Ext, return the appropriate
4826 /// action to promote the operand of \p Ext instead of using Ext.
4827 /// \return NULL if no promotable action is possible with the current
4828 /// sign extension.
4829 /// \p InsertedInsts keeps track of all the instructions inserted by the
4830 /// other CodeGenPrepare optimizations. This information is important
4831 /// because we do not want to promote these instructions as CodeGenPrepare
4832 /// will reinsert them later. Thus creating an infinite loop: create/remove.
4833 /// \p PromotedInsts maps the instructions to their type before promotion.
4834 static Action getAction(Instruction *Ext, const SetOfInstrs &InsertedInsts,
4835 const TargetLowering &TLI,
4836 const InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts);
4837 };
4838
4839 } // end anonymous namespace
4840
canGetThrough(const Instruction * Inst,Type * ConsideredExtType,const InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts,bool IsSExt)4841 bool TypePromotionHelper::canGetThrough(const Instruction *Inst,
4842 Type *ConsideredExtType,
4843 const InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts,
4844 bool IsSExt) {
4845 // The promotion helper does not know how to deal with vector types yet.
4846 // To be able to fix that, we would need to fix the places where we
4847 // statically extend, e.g., constants and such.
4848 if (Inst->getType()->isVectorTy())
4849 return false;
4850
4851 // We can always get through zext.
4852 if (isa<ZExtInst>(Inst))
4853 return true;
4854
4855 // sext(sext) is ok too.
4856 if (IsSExt && isa<SExtInst>(Inst))
4857 return true;
4858
4859 // We can get through binary operator, if it is legal. In other words, the
4860 // binary operator must have a nuw or nsw flag.
4861 if (const auto *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Inst))
4862 if (isa<OverflowingBinaryOperator>(BinOp) &&
4863 ((!IsSExt && BinOp->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) ||
4864 (IsSExt && BinOp->hasNoSignedWrap())))
4865 return true;
4866
4867 // ext(and(opnd, cst)) --> and(ext(opnd), ext(cst))
4868 if ((Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4869 Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or))
4870 return true;
4871
4872 // ext(xor(opnd, cst)) --> xor(ext(opnd), ext(cst))
4873 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor) {
4874 // Make sure it is not a NOT.
4875 if (const auto *Cst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1)))
4876 if (!Cst->getValue().isAllOnes())
4877 return true;
4878 }
4879
4880 // zext(shrl(opnd, cst)) --> shrl(zext(opnd), zext(cst))
4881 // It may change a poisoned value into a regular value, like
4882 // zext i32 (shrl i8 %val, 12) --> shrl i32 (zext i8 %val), 12
4883 // poisoned value regular value
4884 // It should be OK since undef covers valid value.
4885 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && !IsSExt)
4886 return true;
4887
4888 // and(ext(shl(opnd, cst)), cst) --> and(shl(ext(opnd), ext(cst)), cst)
4889 // It may change a poisoned value into a regular value, like
4890 // zext i32 (shl i8 %val, 12) --> shl i32 (zext i8 %val), 12
4891 // poisoned value regular value
4892 // It should be OK since undef covers valid value.
4893 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl && Inst->hasOneUse()) {
4894 const auto *ExtInst = cast<const Instruction>(*Inst->user_begin());
4895 if (ExtInst->hasOneUse()) {
4896 const auto *AndInst = dyn_cast<const Instruction>(*ExtInst->user_begin());
4897 if (AndInst && AndInst->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
4898 const auto *Cst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AndInst->getOperand(1));
4899 if (Cst &&
4900 Cst->getValue().isIntN(Inst->getType()->getIntegerBitWidth()))
4901 return true;
4902 }
4903 }
4904 }
4905
4906 // Check if we can do the following simplification.
4907 // ext(trunc(opnd)) --> ext(opnd)
4908 if (!isa<TruncInst>(Inst))
4909 return false;
4910
4911 Value *OpndVal = Inst->getOperand(0);
4912 // Check if we can use this operand in the extension.
4913 // If the type is larger than the result type of the extension, we cannot.
4914 if (!OpndVal->getType()->isIntegerTy() ||
4915 OpndVal->getType()->getIntegerBitWidth() >
4916 ConsideredExtType->getIntegerBitWidth())
4917 return false;
4918
4919 // If the operand of the truncate is not an instruction, we will not have
4920 // any information on the dropped bits.
4921 // (Actually we could for constant but it is not worth the extra logic).
4922 Instruction *Opnd = dyn_cast<Instruction>(OpndVal);
4923 if (!Opnd)
4924 return false;
4925
4926 // Check if the source of the type is narrow enough.
4927 // I.e., check that trunc just drops extended bits of the same kind of
4928 // the extension.
4929 // #1 get the type of the operand and check the kind of the extended bits.
4930 const Type *OpndType = getOrigType(PromotedInsts, Opnd, IsSExt);
4931 if (OpndType)
4932 ;
4933 else if ((IsSExt && isa<SExtInst>(Opnd)) || (!IsSExt && isa<ZExtInst>(Opnd)))
4934 OpndType = Opnd->getOperand(0)->getType();
4935 else
4936 return false;
4937
4938 // #2 check that the truncate just drops extended bits.
4939 return Inst->getType()->getIntegerBitWidth() >=
4940 OpndType->getIntegerBitWidth();
4941 }
4942
getAction(Instruction * Ext,const SetOfInstrs & InsertedInsts,const TargetLowering & TLI,const InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts)4943 TypePromotionHelper::Action TypePromotionHelper::getAction(
4944 Instruction *Ext, const SetOfInstrs &InsertedInsts,
4945 const TargetLowering &TLI, const InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts) {
4946 assert((isa<SExtInst>(Ext) || isa<ZExtInst>(Ext)) &&
4947 "Unexpected instruction type");
4948 Instruction *ExtOpnd = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Ext->getOperand(0));
4949 Type *ExtTy = Ext->getType();
4950 bool IsSExt = isa<SExtInst>(Ext);
4951 // If the operand of the extension is not an instruction, we cannot
4952 // get through.
4953 // If it, check we can get through.
4954 if (!ExtOpnd || !canGetThrough(ExtOpnd, ExtTy, PromotedInsts, IsSExt))
4955 return nullptr;
4956
4957 // Do not promote if the operand has been added by codegenprepare.
4958 // Otherwise, it means we are undoing an optimization that is likely to be
4959 // redone, thus causing potential infinite loop.
4960 if (isa<TruncInst>(ExtOpnd) && InsertedInsts.count(ExtOpnd))
4961 return nullptr;
4962
4963 // SExt or Trunc instructions.
4964 // Return the related handler.
4965 if (isa<SExtInst>(ExtOpnd) || isa<TruncInst>(ExtOpnd) ||
4966 isa<ZExtInst>(ExtOpnd))
4967 return promoteOperandForTruncAndAnyExt;
4968
4969 // Regular instruction.
4970 // Abort early if we will have to insert non-free instructions.
4971 if (!ExtOpnd->hasOneUse() && !TLI.isTruncateFree(ExtTy, ExtOpnd->getType()))
4972 return nullptr;
4973 return IsSExt ? signExtendOperandForOther : zeroExtendOperandForOther;
4974 }
4975
promoteOperandForTruncAndAnyExt(Instruction * SExt,TypePromotionTransaction & TPT,InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts,unsigned & CreatedInstsCost,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > * Exts,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > * Truncs,const TargetLowering & TLI)4976 Value *TypePromotionHelper::promoteOperandForTruncAndAnyExt(
4977 Instruction *SExt, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
4978 InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
4979 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
4980 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs, const TargetLowering &TLI) {
4981 // By construction, the operand of SExt is an instruction. Otherwise we cannot
4982 // get through it and this method should not be called.
4983 Instruction *SExtOpnd = cast<Instruction>(SExt->getOperand(0));
4984 Value *ExtVal = SExt;
4985 bool HasMergedNonFreeExt = false;
4986 if (isa<ZExtInst>(SExtOpnd)) {
4987 // Replace s|zext(zext(opnd))
4988 // => zext(opnd).
4989 HasMergedNonFreeExt = !TLI.isExtFree(SExtOpnd);
4990 Value *ZExt =
4991 TPT.createZExt(SExt, SExtOpnd->getOperand(0), SExt->getType());
4992 TPT.replaceAllUsesWith(SExt, ZExt);
4993 TPT.eraseInstruction(SExt);
4994 ExtVal = ZExt;
4995 } else {
4996 // Replace z|sext(trunc(opnd)) or sext(sext(opnd))
4997 // => z|sext(opnd).
4998 TPT.setOperand(SExt, 0, SExtOpnd->getOperand(0));
4999 }
5000 CreatedInstsCost = 0;
5001
5002 // Remove dead code.
5003 if (SExtOpnd->use_empty())
5004 TPT.eraseInstruction(SExtOpnd);
5005
5006 // Check if the extension is still needed.
5007 Instruction *ExtInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(ExtVal);
5008 if (!ExtInst || ExtInst->getType() != ExtInst->getOperand(0)->getType()) {
5009 if (ExtInst) {
5010 if (Exts)
5011 Exts->push_back(ExtInst);
5012 CreatedInstsCost = !TLI.isExtFree(ExtInst) && !HasMergedNonFreeExt;
5013 }
5014 return ExtVal;
5015 }
5016
5017 // At this point we have: ext ty opnd to ty.
5018 // Reassign the uses of ExtInst to the opnd and remove ExtInst.
5019 Value *NextVal = ExtInst->getOperand(0);
5020 TPT.eraseInstruction(ExtInst, NextVal);
5021 return NextVal;
5022 }
5023
promoteOperandForOther(Instruction * Ext,TypePromotionTransaction & TPT,InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts,unsigned & CreatedInstsCost,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > * Exts,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > * Truncs,const TargetLowering & TLI,bool IsSExt)5024 Value *TypePromotionHelper::promoteOperandForOther(
5025 Instruction *Ext, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
5026 InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
5027 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
5028 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs, const TargetLowering &TLI,
5029 bool IsSExt) {
5030 // By construction, the operand of Ext is an instruction. Otherwise we cannot
5031 // get through it and this method should not be called.
5032 Instruction *ExtOpnd = cast<Instruction>(Ext->getOperand(0));
5033 CreatedInstsCost = 0;
5034 if (!ExtOpnd->hasOneUse()) {
5035 // ExtOpnd will be promoted.
5036 // All its uses, but Ext, will need to use a truncated value of the
5037 // promoted version.
5038 // Create the truncate now.
5039 Value *Trunc = TPT.createTrunc(Ext, ExtOpnd->getType());
5040 if (Instruction *ITrunc = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Trunc)) {
5041 // Insert it just after the definition.
5042 ITrunc->moveAfter(ExtOpnd);
5043 if (Truncs)
5044 Truncs->push_back(ITrunc);
5045 }
5046
5047 TPT.replaceAllUsesWith(ExtOpnd, Trunc);
5048 // Restore the operand of Ext (which has been replaced by the previous call
5049 // to replaceAllUsesWith) to avoid creating a cycle trunc <-> sext.
5050 TPT.setOperand(Ext, 0, ExtOpnd);
5051 }
5052
5053 // Get through the Instruction:
5054 // 1. Update its type.
5055 // 2. Replace the uses of Ext by Inst.
5056 // 3. Extend each operand that needs to be extended.
5057
5058 // Remember the original type of the instruction before promotion.
5059 // This is useful to know that the high bits are sign extended bits.
5060 addPromotedInst(PromotedInsts, ExtOpnd, IsSExt);
5061 // Step #1.
5062 TPT.mutateType(ExtOpnd, Ext->getType());
5063 // Step #2.
5064 TPT.replaceAllUsesWith(Ext, ExtOpnd);
5065 // Step #3.
5066 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Propagate Ext to operands\n");
5067 for (int OpIdx = 0, EndOpIdx = ExtOpnd->getNumOperands(); OpIdx != EndOpIdx;
5068 ++OpIdx) {
5069 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Operand:\n" << *(ExtOpnd->getOperand(OpIdx)) << '\n');
5070 if (ExtOpnd->getOperand(OpIdx)->getType() == Ext->getType() ||
5071 !shouldExtOperand(ExtOpnd, OpIdx)) {
5072 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "No need to propagate\n");
5073 continue;
5074 }
5075 // Check if we can statically extend the operand.
5076 Value *Opnd = ExtOpnd->getOperand(OpIdx);
5077 if (const ConstantInt *Cst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Opnd)) {
5078 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Statically extend\n");
5079 unsigned BitWidth = Ext->getType()->getIntegerBitWidth();
5080 APInt CstVal = IsSExt ? Cst->getValue().sext(BitWidth)
5081 : Cst->getValue().zext(BitWidth);
5082 TPT.setOperand(ExtOpnd, OpIdx, ConstantInt::get(Ext->getType(), CstVal));
5083 continue;
5084 }
5085 // UndefValue are typed, so we have to statically sign extend them.
5086 if (isa<UndefValue>(Opnd)) {
5087 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Statically extend\n");
5088 TPT.setOperand(ExtOpnd, OpIdx, UndefValue::get(Ext->getType()));
5089 continue;
5090 }
5091
5092 // Otherwise we have to explicitly sign extend the operand.
5093 Value *ValForExtOpnd = IsSExt
5094 ? TPT.createSExt(ExtOpnd, Opnd, Ext->getType())
5095 : TPT.createZExt(ExtOpnd, Opnd, Ext->getType());
5096 TPT.setOperand(ExtOpnd, OpIdx, ValForExtOpnd);
5097 Instruction *InstForExtOpnd = dyn_cast<Instruction>(ValForExtOpnd);
5098 if (!InstForExtOpnd)
5099 continue;
5100
5101 if (Exts)
5102 Exts->push_back(InstForExtOpnd);
5103
5104 CreatedInstsCost += !TLI.isExtFree(InstForExtOpnd);
5105 }
5106 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Extension is useless now\n");
5107 TPT.eraseInstruction(Ext);
5108 return ExtOpnd;
5109 }
5110
5111 /// Check whether or not promoting an instruction to a wider type is profitable.
5112 /// \p NewCost gives the cost of extension instructions created by the
5113 /// promotion.
5114 /// \p OldCost gives the cost of extension instructions before the promotion
5115 /// plus the number of instructions that have been
5116 /// matched in the addressing mode the promotion.
5117 /// \p PromotedOperand is the value that has been promoted.
5118 /// \return True if the promotion is profitable, false otherwise.
isPromotionProfitable(unsigned NewCost,unsigned OldCost,Value * PromotedOperand) const5119 bool AddressingModeMatcher::isPromotionProfitable(
5120 unsigned NewCost, unsigned OldCost, Value *PromotedOperand) const {
5121 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "OldCost: " << OldCost << "\tNewCost: " << NewCost
5122 << '\n');
5123 // The cost of the new extensions is greater than the cost of the
5124 // old extension plus what we folded.
5125 // This is not profitable.
5126 if (NewCost > OldCost)
5127 return false;
5128 if (NewCost < OldCost)
5129 return true;
5130 // The promotion is neutral but it may help folding the sign extension in
5131 // loads for instance.
5132 // Check that we did not create an illegal instruction.
5133 return isPromotedInstructionLegal(TLI, DL, PromotedOperand);
5134 }
5135
5136 /// Given an instruction or constant expr, see if we can fold the operation
5137 /// into the addressing mode. If so, update the addressing mode and return
5138 /// true, otherwise return false without modifying AddrMode.
5139 /// If \p MovedAway is not NULL, it contains the information of whether or
5140 /// not AddrInst has to be folded into the addressing mode on success.
5141 /// If \p MovedAway == true, \p AddrInst will not be part of the addressing
5142 /// because it has been moved away.
5143 /// Thus AddrInst must not be added in the matched instructions.
5144 /// This state can happen when AddrInst is a sext, since it may be moved away.
5145 /// Therefore, AddrInst may not be valid when MovedAway is true and it must
5146 /// not be referenced anymore.
matchOperationAddr(User * AddrInst,unsigned Opcode,unsigned Depth,bool * MovedAway)5147 bool AddressingModeMatcher::matchOperationAddr(User *AddrInst, unsigned Opcode,
5148 unsigned Depth,
5149 bool *MovedAway) {
5150 // Avoid exponential behavior on extremely deep expression trees.
5151 if (Depth >= 5)
5152 return false;
5153
5154 // By default, all matched instructions stay in place.
5155 if (MovedAway)
5156 *MovedAway = false;
5157
5158 switch (Opcode) {
5159 case Instruction::PtrToInt:
5160 // PtrToInt is always a noop, as we know that the int type is pointer sized.
5161 return matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth);
5162 case Instruction::IntToPtr: {
5163 auto AS = AddrInst->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace();
5164 auto PtrTy = MVT::getIntegerVT(DL.getPointerSizeInBits(AS));
5165 // This inttoptr is a no-op if the integer type is pointer sized.
5166 if (TLI.getValueType(DL, AddrInst->getOperand(0)->getType()) == PtrTy)
5167 return matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth);
5168 return false;
5169 }
5170 case Instruction::BitCast:
5171 // BitCast is always a noop, and we can handle it as long as it is
5172 // int->int or pointer->pointer (we don't want int<->fp or something).
5173 if (AddrInst->getOperand(0)->getType()->isIntOrPtrTy() &&
5174 // Don't touch identity bitcasts. These were probably put here by LSR,
5175 // and we don't want to mess around with them. Assume it knows what it
5176 // is doing.
5177 AddrInst->getOperand(0)->getType() != AddrInst->getType())
5178 return matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth);
5179 return false;
5180 case Instruction::AddrSpaceCast: {
5181 unsigned SrcAS =
5182 AddrInst->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace();
5183 unsigned DestAS = AddrInst->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace();
5184 if (TLI.getTargetMachine().isNoopAddrSpaceCast(SrcAS, DestAS))
5185 return matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth);
5186 return false;
5187 }
5188 case Instruction::Add: {
5189 // Check to see if we can merge in one operand, then the other. If so, we
5190 // win.
5191 ExtAddrMode BackupAddrMode = AddrMode;
5192 unsigned OldSize = AddrModeInsts.size();
5193 // Start a transaction at this point.
5194 // The LHS may match but not the RHS.
5195 // Therefore, we need a higher level restoration point to undo partially
5196 // matched operation.
5197 TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
5198 TPT.getRestorationPoint();
5199
5200 // Try to match an integer constant second to increase its chance of ending
5201 // up in `BaseOffs`, resp. decrease its chance of ending up in `BaseReg`.
5202 int First = 0, Second = 1;
5203 if (isa<ConstantInt>(AddrInst->getOperand(First))
5204 && !isa<ConstantInt>(AddrInst->getOperand(Second)))
5205 std::swap(First, Second);
5206 AddrMode.InBounds = false;
5207 if (matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(First), Depth + 1) &&
5208 matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(Second), Depth + 1))
5209 return true;
5210
5211 // Restore the old addr mode info.
5212 AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
5213 AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
5214 TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
5215
5216 // Otherwise this was over-aggressive. Try merging operands in the opposite
5217 // order.
5218 if (matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(Second), Depth + 1) &&
5219 matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(First), Depth + 1))
5220 return true;
5221
5222 // Otherwise we definitely can't merge the ADD in.
5223 AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
5224 AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
5225 TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
5226 break;
5227 }
5228 // case Instruction::Or:
5229 // TODO: We can handle "Or Val, Imm" iff this OR is equivalent to an ADD.
5230 // break;
5231 case Instruction::Mul:
5232 case Instruction::Shl: {
5233 // Can only handle X*C and X << C.
5234 AddrMode.InBounds = false;
5235 ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AddrInst->getOperand(1));
5236 if (!RHS || RHS->getBitWidth() > 64)
5237 return false;
5238 int64_t Scale = Opcode == Instruction::Shl
5239 ? 1LL << RHS->getLimitedValue(RHS->getBitWidth() - 1)
5240 : RHS->getSExtValue();
5241
5242 return matchScaledValue(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Scale, Depth);
5243 }
5244 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
5245 // Scan the GEP. We check it if it contains constant offsets and at most
5246 // one variable offset.
5247 int VariableOperand = -1;
5248 unsigned VariableScale = 0;
5249
5250 int64_t ConstantOffset = 0;
5251 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(AddrInst);
5252 for (unsigned i = 1, e = AddrInst->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5253 if (StructType *STy = GTI.getStructTypeOrNull()) {
5254 const StructLayout *SL = DL.getStructLayout(STy);
5255 unsigned Idx =
5256 cast<ConstantInt>(AddrInst->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
5257 ConstantOffset += SL->getElementOffset(Idx);
5258 } else {
5259 TypeSize TS = GTI.getSequentialElementStride(DL);
5260 if (TS.isNonZero()) {
5261 // The optimisations below currently only work for fixed offsets.
5262 if (TS.isScalable())
5263 return false;
5264 int64_t TypeSize = TS.getFixedValue();
5265 if (ConstantInt *CI =
5266 dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AddrInst->getOperand(i))) {
5267 const APInt &CVal = CI->getValue();
5268 if (CVal.getSignificantBits() <= 64) {
5269 ConstantOffset += CVal.getSExtValue() * TypeSize;
5270 continue;
5271 }
5272 }
5273 // We only allow one variable index at the moment.
5274 if (VariableOperand != -1)
5275 return false;
5276
5277 // Remember the variable index.
5278 VariableOperand = i;
5279 VariableScale = TypeSize;
5280 }
5281 }
5282 }
5283
5284 // A common case is for the GEP to only do a constant offset. In this case,
5285 // just add it to the disp field and check validity.
5286 if (VariableOperand == -1) {
5287 AddrMode.BaseOffs += ConstantOffset;
5288 if (matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth + 1)) {
5289 if (!cast<GEPOperator>(AddrInst)->isInBounds())
5290 AddrMode.InBounds = false;
5291 return true;
5292 }
5293 AddrMode.BaseOffs -= ConstantOffset;
5294
5295 if (EnableGEPOffsetSplit && isa<GetElementPtrInst>(AddrInst) &&
5296 TLI.shouldConsiderGEPOffsetSplit() && Depth == 0 &&
5297 ConstantOffset > 0) {
5298 // Record GEPs with non-zero offsets as candidates for splitting in
5299 // the event that the offset cannot fit into the r+i addressing mode.
5300 // Simple and common case that only one GEP is used in calculating the
5301 // address for the memory access.
5302 Value *Base = AddrInst->getOperand(0);
5303 auto *BaseI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Base);
5304 auto *GEP = cast<GetElementPtrInst>(AddrInst);
5305 if (isa<Argument>(Base) || isa<GlobalValue>(Base) ||
5306 (BaseI && !isa<CastInst>(BaseI) &&
5307 !isa<GetElementPtrInst>(BaseI))) {
5308 // Make sure the parent block allows inserting non-PHI instructions
5309 // before the terminator.
5310 BasicBlock *Parent = BaseI ? BaseI->getParent()
5311 : &GEP->getFunction()->getEntryBlock();
5312 if (!Parent->getTerminator()->isEHPad())
5313 LargeOffsetGEP = std::make_pair(GEP, ConstantOffset);
5314 }
5315 }
5316
5317 return false;
5318 }
5319
5320 // Save the valid addressing mode in case we can't match.
5321 ExtAddrMode BackupAddrMode = AddrMode;
5322 unsigned OldSize = AddrModeInsts.size();
5323
5324 // See if the scale and offset amount is valid for this target.
5325 AddrMode.BaseOffs += ConstantOffset;
5326 if (!cast<GEPOperator>(AddrInst)->isInBounds())
5327 AddrMode.InBounds = false;
5328
5329 // Match the base operand of the GEP.
5330 if (!matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth + 1)) {
5331 // If it couldn't be matched, just stuff the value in a register.
5332 if (AddrMode.HasBaseReg) {
5333 AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
5334 AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
5335 return false;
5336 }
5337 AddrMode.HasBaseReg = true;
5338 AddrMode.BaseReg = AddrInst->getOperand(0);
5339 }
5340
5341 // Match the remaining variable portion of the GEP.
5342 if (!matchScaledValue(AddrInst->getOperand(VariableOperand), VariableScale,
5343 Depth)) {
5344 // If it couldn't be matched, try stuffing the base into a register
5345 // instead of matching it, and retrying the match of the scale.
5346 AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
5347 AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
5348 if (AddrMode.HasBaseReg)
5349 return false;
5350 AddrMode.HasBaseReg = true;
5351 AddrMode.BaseReg = AddrInst->getOperand(0);
5352 AddrMode.BaseOffs += ConstantOffset;
5353 if (!matchScaledValue(AddrInst->getOperand(VariableOperand),
5354 VariableScale, Depth)) {
5355 // If even that didn't work, bail.
5356 AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
5357 AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
5358 return false;
5359 }
5360 }
5361
5362 return true;
5363 }
5364 case Instruction::SExt:
5365 case Instruction::ZExt: {
5366 Instruction *Ext = dyn_cast<Instruction>(AddrInst);
5367 if (!Ext)
5368 return false;
5369
5370 // Try to move this ext out of the way of the addressing mode.
5371 // Ask for a method for doing so.
5372 TypePromotionHelper::Action TPH =
5373 TypePromotionHelper::getAction(Ext, InsertedInsts, TLI, PromotedInsts);
5374 if (!TPH)
5375 return false;
5376
5377 TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
5378 TPT.getRestorationPoint();
5379 unsigned CreatedInstsCost = 0;
5380 unsigned ExtCost = !TLI.isExtFree(Ext);
5381 Value *PromotedOperand =
5382 TPH(Ext, TPT, PromotedInsts, CreatedInstsCost, nullptr, nullptr, TLI);
5383 // SExt has been moved away.
5384 // Thus either it will be rematched later in the recursive calls or it is
5385 // gone. Anyway, we must not fold it into the addressing mode at this point.
5386 // E.g.,
5387 // op = add opnd, 1
5388 // idx = ext op
5389 // addr = gep base, idx
5390 // is now:
5391 // promotedOpnd = ext opnd <- no match here
5392 // op = promoted_add promotedOpnd, 1 <- match (later in recursive calls)
5393 // addr = gep base, op <- match
5394 if (MovedAway)
5395 *MovedAway = true;
5396
5397 assert(PromotedOperand &&
5398 "TypePromotionHelper should have filtered out those cases");
5399
5400 ExtAddrMode BackupAddrMode = AddrMode;
5401 unsigned OldSize = AddrModeInsts.size();
5402
5403 if (!matchAddr(PromotedOperand, Depth) ||
5404 // The total of the new cost is equal to the cost of the created
5405 // instructions.
5406 // The total of the old cost is equal to the cost of the extension plus
5407 // what we have saved in the addressing mode.
5408 !isPromotionProfitable(CreatedInstsCost,
5409 ExtCost + (AddrModeInsts.size() - OldSize),
5410 PromotedOperand)) {
5411 AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
5412 AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
5413 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Sign extension does not pay off: rollback\n");
5414 TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
5415 return false;
5416 }
5417
5418 // SExt has been deleted. Make sure it is not referenced by the AddrMode.
5419 AddrMode.replaceWith(Ext, PromotedOperand);
5420 return true;
5421 }
5422 case Instruction::Call:
5423 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(AddrInst)) {
5424 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::threadlocal_address) {
5425 GlobalValue &GV = cast<GlobalValue>(*II->getArgOperand(0));
5426 if (TLI.addressingModeSupportsTLS(GV))
5427 return matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth);
5428 }
5429 }
5430 break;
5431 }
5432 return false;
5433 }
5434
5435 /// If we can, try to add the value of 'Addr' into the current addressing mode.
5436 /// If Addr can't be added to AddrMode this returns false and leaves AddrMode
5437 /// unmodified. This assumes that Addr is either a pointer type or intptr_t
5438 /// for the target.
5439 ///
matchAddr(Value * Addr,unsigned Depth)5440 bool AddressingModeMatcher::matchAddr(Value *Addr, unsigned Depth) {
5441 // Start a transaction at this point that we will rollback if the matching
5442 // fails.
5443 TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
5444 TPT.getRestorationPoint();
5445 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Addr)) {
5446 if (CI->getValue().isSignedIntN(64)) {
5447 // Check if the addition would result in a signed overflow.
5448 int64_t Result;
5449 bool Overflow =
5450 AddOverflow(AddrMode.BaseOffs, CI->getSExtValue(), Result);
5451 if (!Overflow) {
5452 // Fold in immediates if legal for the target.
5453 AddrMode.BaseOffs = Result;
5454 if (TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, AddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace))
5455 return true;
5456 AddrMode.BaseOffs -= CI->getSExtValue();
5457 }
5458 }
5459 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(Addr)) {
5460 // If this is a global variable, try to fold it into the addressing mode.
5461 if (!AddrMode.BaseGV) {
5462 AddrMode.BaseGV = GV;
5463 if (TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, AddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace))
5464 return true;
5465 AddrMode.BaseGV = nullptr;
5466 }
5467 } else if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Addr)) {
5468 ExtAddrMode BackupAddrMode = AddrMode;
5469 unsigned OldSize = AddrModeInsts.size();
5470
5471 // Check to see if it is possible to fold this operation.
5472 bool MovedAway = false;
5473 if (matchOperationAddr(I, I->getOpcode(), Depth, &MovedAway)) {
5474 // This instruction may have been moved away. If so, there is nothing
5475 // to check here.
5476 if (MovedAway)
5477 return true;
5478 // Okay, it's possible to fold this. Check to see if it is actually
5479 // *profitable* to do so. We use a simple cost model to avoid increasing
5480 // register pressure too much.
5481 if (I->hasOneUse() ||
5482 isProfitableToFoldIntoAddressingMode(I, BackupAddrMode, AddrMode)) {
5483 AddrModeInsts.push_back(I);
5484 return true;
5485 }
5486
5487 // It isn't profitable to do this, roll back.
5488 AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
5489 AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
5490 TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
5491 }
5492 } else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Addr)) {
5493 if (matchOperationAddr(CE, CE->getOpcode(), Depth))
5494 return true;
5495 TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
5496 } else if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Addr)) {
5497 // Null pointer gets folded without affecting the addressing mode.
5498 return true;
5499 }
5500
5501 // Worse case, the target should support [reg] addressing modes. :)
5502 if (!AddrMode.HasBaseReg) {
5503 AddrMode.HasBaseReg = true;
5504 AddrMode.BaseReg = Addr;
5505 // Still check for legality in case the target supports [imm] but not [i+r].
5506 if (TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, AddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace))
5507 return true;
5508 AddrMode.HasBaseReg = false;
5509 AddrMode.BaseReg = nullptr;
5510 }
5511
5512 // If the base register is already taken, see if we can do [r+r].
5513 if (AddrMode.Scale == 0) {
5514 AddrMode.Scale = 1;
5515 AddrMode.ScaledReg = Addr;
5516 if (TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, AddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace))
5517 return true;
5518 AddrMode.Scale = 0;
5519 AddrMode.ScaledReg = nullptr;
5520 }
5521 // Couldn't match.
5522 TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
5523 return false;
5524 }
5525
5526 /// Check to see if all uses of OpVal by the specified inline asm call are due
5527 /// to memory operands. If so, return true, otherwise return false.
IsOperandAMemoryOperand(CallInst * CI,InlineAsm * IA,Value * OpVal,const TargetLowering & TLI,const TargetRegisterInfo & TRI)5528 static bool IsOperandAMemoryOperand(CallInst *CI, InlineAsm *IA, Value *OpVal,
5529 const TargetLowering &TLI,
5530 const TargetRegisterInfo &TRI) {
5531 const Function *F = CI->getFunction();
5532 TargetLowering::AsmOperandInfoVector TargetConstraints =
5533 TLI.ParseConstraints(F->getDataLayout(), &TRI, *CI);
5534
5535 for (TargetLowering::AsmOperandInfo &OpInfo : TargetConstraints) {
5536 // Compute the constraint code and ConstraintType to use.
5537 TLI.ComputeConstraintToUse(OpInfo, SDValue());
5538
5539 // If this asm operand is our Value*, and if it isn't an indirect memory
5540 // operand, we can't fold it! TODO: Also handle C_Address?
5541 if (OpInfo.CallOperandVal == OpVal &&
5542 (OpInfo.ConstraintType != TargetLowering::C_Memory ||
5543 !OpInfo.isIndirect))
5544 return false;
5545 }
5546
5547 return true;
5548 }
5549
5550 /// Recursively walk all the uses of I until we find a memory use.
5551 /// If we find an obviously non-foldable instruction, return true.
5552 /// Add accessed addresses and types to MemoryUses.
FindAllMemoryUses(Instruction * I,SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<Use *,Type * >> & MemoryUses,SmallPtrSetImpl<Instruction * > & ConsideredInsts,const TargetLowering & TLI,const TargetRegisterInfo & TRI,bool OptSize,ProfileSummaryInfo * PSI,BlockFrequencyInfo * BFI,unsigned & SeenInsts)5553 static bool FindAllMemoryUses(
5554 Instruction *I, SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<Use *, Type *>> &MemoryUses,
5555 SmallPtrSetImpl<Instruction *> &ConsideredInsts, const TargetLowering &TLI,
5556 const TargetRegisterInfo &TRI, bool OptSize, ProfileSummaryInfo *PSI,
5557 BlockFrequencyInfo *BFI, unsigned &SeenInsts) {
5558 // If we already considered this instruction, we're done.
5559 if (!ConsideredInsts.insert(I).second)
5560 return false;
5561
5562 // If this is an obviously unfoldable instruction, bail out.
5563 if (!MightBeFoldableInst(I))
5564 return true;
5565
5566 // Loop over all the uses, recursively processing them.
5567 for (Use &U : I->uses()) {
5568 // Conservatively return true if we're seeing a large number or a deep chain
5569 // of users. This avoids excessive compilation times in pathological cases.
5570 if (SeenInsts++ >= MaxAddressUsersToScan)
5571 return true;
5572
5573 Instruction *UserI = cast<Instruction>(U.getUser());
5574 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(UserI)) {
5575 MemoryUses.push_back({&U, LI->getType()});
5576 continue;
5577 }
5578
5579 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(UserI)) {
5580 if (U.getOperandNo() != StoreInst::getPointerOperandIndex())
5581 return true; // Storing addr, not into addr.
5582 MemoryUses.push_back({&U, SI->getValueOperand()->getType()});
5583 continue;
5584 }
5585
5586 if (AtomicRMWInst *RMW = dyn_cast<AtomicRMWInst>(UserI)) {
5587 if (U.getOperandNo() != AtomicRMWInst::getPointerOperandIndex())
5588 return true; // Storing addr, not into addr.
5589 MemoryUses.push_back({&U, RMW->getValOperand()->getType()});
5590 continue;
5591 }
5592
5593 if (AtomicCmpXchgInst *CmpX = dyn_cast<AtomicCmpXchgInst>(UserI)) {
5594 if (U.getOperandNo() != AtomicCmpXchgInst::getPointerOperandIndex())
5595 return true; // Storing addr, not into addr.
5596 MemoryUses.push_back({&U, CmpX->getCompareOperand()->getType()});
5597 continue;
5598 }
5599
5600 if (CallInst *CI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(UserI)) {
5601 if (CI->hasFnAttr(Attribute::Cold)) {
5602 // If this is a cold call, we can sink the addressing calculation into
5603 // the cold path. See optimizeCallInst
5604 if (!llvm::shouldOptimizeForSize(CI->getParent(), PSI, BFI))
5605 continue;
5606 }
5607
5608 InlineAsm *IA = dyn_cast<InlineAsm>(CI->getCalledOperand());
5609 if (!IA)
5610 return true;
5611
5612 // If this is a memory operand, we're cool, otherwise bail out.
5613 if (!IsOperandAMemoryOperand(CI, IA, I, TLI, TRI))
5614 return true;
5615 continue;
5616 }
5617
5618 if (FindAllMemoryUses(UserI, MemoryUses, ConsideredInsts, TLI, TRI, OptSize,
5619 PSI, BFI, SeenInsts))
5620 return true;
5621 }
5622
5623 return false;
5624 }
5625
FindAllMemoryUses(Instruction * I,SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<Use *,Type * >> & MemoryUses,const TargetLowering & TLI,const TargetRegisterInfo & TRI,bool OptSize,ProfileSummaryInfo * PSI,BlockFrequencyInfo * BFI)5626 static bool FindAllMemoryUses(
5627 Instruction *I, SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<Use *, Type *>> &MemoryUses,
5628 const TargetLowering &TLI, const TargetRegisterInfo &TRI, bool OptSize,
5629 ProfileSummaryInfo *PSI, BlockFrequencyInfo *BFI) {
5630 unsigned SeenInsts = 0;
5631 SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 16> ConsideredInsts;
5632 return FindAllMemoryUses(I, MemoryUses, ConsideredInsts, TLI, TRI, OptSize,
5633 PSI, BFI, SeenInsts);
5634 }
5635
5636
5637 /// Return true if Val is already known to be live at the use site that we're
5638 /// folding it into. If so, there is no cost to include it in the addressing
5639 /// mode. KnownLive1 and KnownLive2 are two values that we know are live at the
5640 /// instruction already.
valueAlreadyLiveAtInst(Value * Val,Value * KnownLive1,Value * KnownLive2)5641 bool AddressingModeMatcher::valueAlreadyLiveAtInst(Value *Val,
5642 Value *KnownLive1,
5643 Value *KnownLive2) {
5644 // If Val is either of the known-live values, we know it is live!
5645 if (Val == nullptr || Val == KnownLive1 || Val == KnownLive2)
5646 return true;
5647
5648 // All values other than instructions and arguments (e.g. constants) are live.
5649 if (!isa<Instruction>(Val) && !isa<Argument>(Val))
5650 return true;
5651
5652 // If Val is a constant sized alloca in the entry block, it is live, this is
5653 // true because it is just a reference to the stack/frame pointer, which is
5654 // live for the whole function.
5655 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(Val))
5656 if (AI->isStaticAlloca())
5657 return true;
5658
5659 // Check to see if this value is already used in the memory instruction's
5660 // block. If so, it's already live into the block at the very least, so we
5661 // can reasonably fold it.
5662 return Val->isUsedInBasicBlock(MemoryInst->getParent());
5663 }
5664
5665 /// It is possible for the addressing mode of the machine to fold the specified
5666 /// instruction into a load or store that ultimately uses it.
5667 /// However, the specified instruction has multiple uses.
5668 /// Given this, it may actually increase register pressure to fold it
5669 /// into the load. For example, consider this code:
5670 ///
5671 /// X = ...
5672 /// Y = X+1
5673 /// use(Y) -> nonload/store
5674 /// Z = Y+1
5675 /// load Z
5676 ///
5677 /// In this case, Y has multiple uses, and can be folded into the load of Z
5678 /// (yielding load [X+2]). However, doing this will cause both "X" and "X+1" to
5679 /// be live at the use(Y) line. If we don't fold Y into load Z, we use one
5680 /// fewer register. Since Y can't be folded into "use(Y)" we don't increase the
5681 /// number of computations either.
5682 ///
5683 /// Note that this (like most of CodeGenPrepare) is just a rough heuristic. If
5684 /// X was live across 'load Z' for other reasons, we actually *would* want to
5685 /// fold the addressing mode in the Z case. This would make Y die earlier.
isProfitableToFoldIntoAddressingMode(Instruction * I,ExtAddrMode & AMBefore,ExtAddrMode & AMAfter)5686 bool AddressingModeMatcher::isProfitableToFoldIntoAddressingMode(
5687 Instruction *I, ExtAddrMode &AMBefore, ExtAddrMode &AMAfter) {
5688 if (IgnoreProfitability)
5689 return true;
5690
5691 // AMBefore is the addressing mode before this instruction was folded into it,
5692 // and AMAfter is the addressing mode after the instruction was folded. Get
5693 // the set of registers referenced by AMAfter and subtract out those
5694 // referenced by AMBefore: this is the set of values which folding in this
5695 // address extends the lifetime of.
5696 //
5697 // Note that there are only two potential values being referenced here,
5698 // BaseReg and ScaleReg (global addresses are always available, as are any
5699 // folded immediates).
5700 Value *BaseReg = AMAfter.BaseReg, *ScaledReg = AMAfter.ScaledReg;
5701
5702 // If the BaseReg or ScaledReg was referenced by the previous addrmode, their
5703 // lifetime wasn't extended by adding this instruction.
5704 if (valueAlreadyLiveAtInst(BaseReg, AMBefore.BaseReg, AMBefore.ScaledReg))
5705 BaseReg = nullptr;
5706 if (valueAlreadyLiveAtInst(ScaledReg, AMBefore.BaseReg, AMBefore.ScaledReg))
5707 ScaledReg = nullptr;
5708
5709 // If folding this instruction (and it's subexprs) didn't extend any live
5710 // ranges, we're ok with it.
5711 if (!BaseReg && !ScaledReg)
5712 return true;
5713
5714 // If all uses of this instruction can have the address mode sunk into them,
5715 // we can remove the addressing mode and effectively trade one live register
5716 // for another (at worst.) In this context, folding an addressing mode into
5717 // the use is just a particularly nice way of sinking it.
5718 SmallVector<std::pair<Use *, Type *>, 16> MemoryUses;
5719 if (FindAllMemoryUses(I, MemoryUses, TLI, TRI, OptSize, PSI, BFI))
5720 return false; // Has a non-memory, non-foldable use!
5721
5722 // Now that we know that all uses of this instruction are part of a chain of
5723 // computation involving only operations that could theoretically be folded
5724 // into a memory use, loop over each of these memory operation uses and see
5725 // if they could *actually* fold the instruction. The assumption is that
5726 // addressing modes are cheap and that duplicating the computation involved
5727 // many times is worthwhile, even on a fastpath. For sinking candidates
5728 // (i.e. cold call sites), this serves as a way to prevent excessive code
5729 // growth since most architectures have some reasonable small and fast way to
5730 // compute an effective address. (i.e LEA on x86)
5731 SmallVector<Instruction *, 32> MatchedAddrModeInsts;
5732 for (const std::pair<Use *, Type *> &Pair : MemoryUses) {
5733 Value *Address = Pair.first->get();
5734 Instruction *UserI = cast<Instruction>(Pair.first->getUser());
5735 Type *AddressAccessTy = Pair.second;
5736 unsigned AS = Address->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace();
5737
5738 // Do a match against the root of this address, ignoring profitability. This
5739 // will tell us if the addressing mode for the memory operation will
5740 // *actually* cover the shared instruction.
5741 ExtAddrMode Result;
5742 std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t> LargeOffsetGEP(nullptr,
5743 0);
5744 TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
5745 TPT.getRestorationPoint();
5746 AddressingModeMatcher Matcher(MatchedAddrModeInsts, TLI, TRI, LI, getDTFn,
5747 AddressAccessTy, AS, UserI, Result,
5748 InsertedInsts, PromotedInsts, TPT,
5749 LargeOffsetGEP, OptSize, PSI, BFI);
5750 Matcher.IgnoreProfitability = true;
5751 bool Success = Matcher.matchAddr(Address, 0);
5752 (void)Success;
5753 assert(Success && "Couldn't select *anything*?");
5754
5755 // The match was to check the profitability, the changes made are not
5756 // part of the original matcher. Therefore, they should be dropped
5757 // otherwise the original matcher will not present the right state.
5758 TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
5759
5760 // If the match didn't cover I, then it won't be shared by it.
5761 if (!is_contained(MatchedAddrModeInsts, I))
5762 return false;
5763
5764 MatchedAddrModeInsts.clear();
5765 }
5766
5767 return true;
5768 }
5769
5770 /// Return true if the specified values are defined in a
5771 /// different basic block than BB.
IsNonLocalValue(Value * V,BasicBlock * BB)5772 static bool IsNonLocalValue(Value *V, BasicBlock *BB) {
5773 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
5774 return I->getParent() != BB;
5775 return false;
5776 }
5777
5778 // Find an insert position of Addr for MemoryInst. We can't guarantee MemoryInst
5779 // is the first instruction that will use Addr. So we need to find the first
5780 // user of Addr in current BB.
findInsertPos(Value * Addr,Instruction * MemoryInst,Value * SunkAddr)5781 static BasicBlock::iterator findInsertPos(Value *Addr, Instruction *MemoryInst,
5782 Value *SunkAddr) {
5783 if (Addr->hasOneUse())
5784 return MemoryInst->getIterator();
5785
5786 // We already have a SunkAddr in current BB, but we may need to insert cast
5787 // instruction after it.
5788 if (SunkAddr) {
5789 if (Instruction *AddrInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SunkAddr))
5790 return std::next(AddrInst->getIterator());
5791 }
5792
5793 // Find the first user of Addr in current BB.
5794 Instruction *Earliest = MemoryInst;
5795 for (User *U : Addr->users()) {
5796 Instruction *UserInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(U);
5797 if (UserInst && UserInst->getParent() == MemoryInst->getParent()) {
5798 if (isa<PHINode>(UserInst) || UserInst->isDebugOrPseudoInst())
5799 continue;
5800 if (UserInst->comesBefore(Earliest))
5801 Earliest = UserInst;
5802 }
5803 }
5804 return Earliest->getIterator();
5805 }
5806
5807 /// Sink addressing mode computation immediate before MemoryInst if doing so
5808 /// can be done without increasing register pressure. The need for the
5809 /// register pressure constraint means this can end up being an all or nothing
5810 /// decision for all uses of the same addressing computation.
5811 ///
5812 /// Load and Store Instructions often have addressing modes that can do
5813 /// significant amounts of computation. As such, instruction selection will try
5814 /// to get the load or store to do as much computation as possible for the
5815 /// program. The problem is that isel can only see within a single block. As
5816 /// such, we sink as much legal addressing mode work into the block as possible.
5817 ///
5818 /// This method is used to optimize both load/store and inline asms with memory
5819 /// operands. It's also used to sink addressing computations feeding into cold
5820 /// call sites into their (cold) basic block.
5821 ///
5822 /// The motivation for handling sinking into cold blocks is that doing so can
5823 /// both enable other address mode sinking (by satisfying the register pressure
5824 /// constraint above), and reduce register pressure globally (by removing the
5825 /// addressing mode computation from the fast path entirely.).
optimizeMemoryInst(Instruction * MemoryInst,Value * Addr,Type * AccessTy,unsigned AddrSpace)5826 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeMemoryInst(Instruction *MemoryInst, Value *Addr,
5827 Type *AccessTy, unsigned AddrSpace) {
5828 Value *Repl = Addr;
5829
5830 // Try to collapse single-value PHI nodes. This is necessary to undo
5831 // unprofitable PRE transformations.
5832 SmallVector<Value *, 8> worklist;
5833 SmallPtrSet<Value *, 16> Visited;
5834 worklist.push_back(Addr);
5835
5836 // Use a worklist to iteratively look through PHI and select nodes, and
5837 // ensure that the addressing mode obtained from the non-PHI/select roots of
5838 // the graph are compatible.
5839 bool PhiOrSelectSeen = false;
5840 SmallVector<Instruction *, 16> AddrModeInsts;
5841 const SimplifyQuery SQ(*DL, TLInfo);
5842 AddressingModeCombiner AddrModes(SQ, Addr);
5843 TypePromotionTransaction TPT(RemovedInsts);
5844 TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
5845 TPT.getRestorationPoint();
5846 while (!worklist.empty()) {
5847 Value *V = worklist.pop_back_val();
5848
5849 // We allow traversing cyclic Phi nodes.
5850 // In case of success after this loop we ensure that traversing through
5851 // Phi nodes ends up with all cases to compute address of the form
5852 // BaseGV + Base + Scale * Index + Offset
5853 // where Scale and Offset are constans and BaseGV, Base and Index
5854 // are exactly the same Values in all cases.
5855 // It means that BaseGV, Scale and Offset dominate our memory instruction
5856 // and have the same value as they had in address computation represented
5857 // as Phi. So we can safely sink address computation to memory instruction.
5858 if (!Visited.insert(V).second)
5859 continue;
5860
5861 // For a PHI node, push all of its incoming values.
5862 if (PHINode *P = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V)) {
5863 append_range(worklist, P->incoming_values());
5864 PhiOrSelectSeen = true;
5865 continue;
5866 }
5867 // Similar for select.
5868 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(V)) {
5869 worklist.push_back(SI->getFalseValue());
5870 worklist.push_back(SI->getTrueValue());
5871 PhiOrSelectSeen = true;
5872 continue;
5873 }
5874
5875 // For non-PHIs, determine the addressing mode being computed. Note that
5876 // the result may differ depending on what other uses our candidate
5877 // addressing instructions might have.
5878 AddrModeInsts.clear();
5879 std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t> LargeOffsetGEP(nullptr,
5880 0);
5881 // Defer the query (and possible computation of) the dom tree to point of
5882 // actual use. It's expected that most address matches don't actually need
5883 // the domtree.
5884 auto getDTFn = [MemoryInst, this]() -> const DominatorTree & {
5885 Function *F = MemoryInst->getParent()->getParent();
5886 return this->getDT(*F);
5887 };
5888 ExtAddrMode NewAddrMode = AddressingModeMatcher::Match(
5889 V, AccessTy, AddrSpace, MemoryInst, AddrModeInsts, *TLI, *LI, getDTFn,
5890 *TRI, InsertedInsts, PromotedInsts, TPT, LargeOffsetGEP, OptSize, PSI,
5891 BFI.get());
5892
5893 GetElementPtrInst *GEP = LargeOffsetGEP.first;
5894 if (GEP && !NewGEPBases.count(GEP)) {
5895 // If splitting the underlying data structure can reduce the offset of a
5896 // GEP, collect the GEP. Skip the GEPs that are the new bases of
5897 // previously split data structures.
5898 LargeOffsetGEPMap[GEP->getPointerOperand()].push_back(LargeOffsetGEP);
5899 LargeOffsetGEPID.insert(std::make_pair(GEP, LargeOffsetGEPID.size()));
5900 }
5901
5902 NewAddrMode.OriginalValue = V;
5903 if (!AddrModes.addNewAddrMode(NewAddrMode))
5904 break;
5905 }
5906
5907 // Try to combine the AddrModes we've collected. If we couldn't collect any,
5908 // or we have multiple but either couldn't combine them or combining them
5909 // wouldn't do anything useful, bail out now.
5910 if (!AddrModes.combineAddrModes()) {
5911 TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
5912 return false;
5913 }
5914 bool Modified = TPT.commit();
5915
5916 // Get the combined AddrMode (or the only AddrMode, if we only had one).
5917 ExtAddrMode AddrMode = AddrModes.getAddrMode();
5918
5919 // If all the instructions matched are already in this BB, don't do anything.
5920 // If we saw a Phi node then it is not local definitely, and if we saw a
5921 // select then we want to push the address calculation past it even if it's
5922 // already in this BB.
5923 if (!PhiOrSelectSeen && none_of(AddrModeInsts, [&](Value *V) {
5924 return IsNonLocalValue(V, MemoryInst->getParent());
5925 })) {
5926 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "CGP: Found local addrmode: " << AddrMode
5927 << "\n");
5928 return Modified;
5929 }
5930
5931 // Now that we determined the addressing expression we want to use and know
5932 // that we have to sink it into this block. Check to see if we have already
5933 // done this for some other load/store instr in this block. If so, reuse
5934 // the computation. Before attempting reuse, check if the address is valid
5935 // as it may have been erased.
5936
5937 WeakTrackingVH SunkAddrVH = SunkAddrs[Addr];
5938
5939 Value *SunkAddr = SunkAddrVH.pointsToAliveValue() ? SunkAddrVH : nullptr;
5940 Type *IntPtrTy = DL->getIntPtrType(Addr->getType());
5941
5942 // The current BB may be optimized multiple times, we can't guarantee the
5943 // reuse of Addr happens later, call findInsertPos to find an appropriate
5944 // insert position.
5945 auto InsertPos = findInsertPos(Addr, MemoryInst, SunkAddr);
5946
5947 // TODO: Adjust insert point considering (Base|Scaled)Reg if possible.
5948 if (!SunkAddr) {
5949 auto &DT = getDT(*MemoryInst->getFunction());
5950 if ((AddrMode.BaseReg && !DT.dominates(AddrMode.BaseReg, &*InsertPos)) ||
5951 (AddrMode.ScaledReg && !DT.dominates(AddrMode.ScaledReg, &*InsertPos)))
5952 return Modified;
5953 }
5954
5955 IRBuilder<> Builder(MemoryInst->getParent(), InsertPos);
5956
5957 if (SunkAddr) {
5958 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "CGP: Reusing nonlocal addrmode: " << AddrMode
5959 << " for " << *MemoryInst << "\n");
5960 if (SunkAddr->getType() != Addr->getType()) {
5961 if (SunkAddr->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace() !=
5962 Addr->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace() &&
5963 !DL->isNonIntegralPointerType(Addr->getType())) {
5964 // There are two reasons the address spaces might not match: a no-op
5965 // addrspacecast, or a ptrtoint/inttoptr pair. Either way, we emit a
5966 // ptrtoint/inttoptr pair to ensure we match the original semantics.
5967 // TODO: allow bitcast between different address space pointers with the
5968 // same size.
5969 SunkAddr = Builder.CreatePtrToInt(SunkAddr, IntPtrTy, "sunkaddr");
5970 SunkAddr =
5971 Builder.CreateIntToPtr(SunkAddr, Addr->getType(), "sunkaddr");
5972 } else
5973 SunkAddr = Builder.CreatePointerCast(SunkAddr, Addr->getType());
5974 }
5975 } else if (AddrSinkUsingGEPs || (!AddrSinkUsingGEPs.getNumOccurrences() &&
5976 SubtargetInfo->addrSinkUsingGEPs())) {
5977 // By default, we use the GEP-based method when AA is used later. This
5978 // prevents new inttoptr/ptrtoint pairs from degrading AA capabilities.
5979 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "CGP: SINKING nonlocal addrmode: " << AddrMode
5980 << " for " << *MemoryInst << "\n");
5981 Value *ResultPtr = nullptr, *ResultIndex = nullptr;
5982
5983 // First, find the pointer.
5984 if (AddrMode.BaseReg && AddrMode.BaseReg->getType()->isPointerTy()) {
5985 ResultPtr = AddrMode.BaseReg;
5986 AddrMode.BaseReg = nullptr;
5987 }
5988
5989 if (AddrMode.Scale && AddrMode.ScaledReg->getType()->isPointerTy()) {
5990 // We can't add more than one pointer together, nor can we scale a
5991 // pointer (both of which seem meaningless).
5992 if (ResultPtr || AddrMode.Scale != 1)
5993 return Modified;
5994
5995 ResultPtr = AddrMode.ScaledReg;
5996 AddrMode.Scale = 0;
5997 }
5998
5999 // It is only safe to sign extend the BaseReg if we know that the math
6000 // required to create it did not overflow before we extend it. Since
6001 // the original IR value was tossed in favor of a constant back when
6002 // the AddrMode was created we need to bail out gracefully if widths
6003 // do not match instead of extending it.
6004 //
6005 // (See below for code to add the scale.)
6006 if (AddrMode.Scale) {
6007 Type *ScaledRegTy = AddrMode.ScaledReg->getType();
6008 if (cast<IntegerType>(IntPtrTy)->getBitWidth() >
6009 cast<IntegerType>(ScaledRegTy)->getBitWidth())
6010 return Modified;
6011 }
6012
6013 GlobalValue *BaseGV = AddrMode.BaseGV;
6014 if (BaseGV != nullptr) {
6015 if (ResultPtr)
6016 return Modified;
6017
6018 if (BaseGV->isThreadLocal()) {
6019 ResultPtr = Builder.CreateThreadLocalAddress(BaseGV);
6020 } else {
6021 ResultPtr = BaseGV;
6022 }
6023 }
6024
6025 // If the real base value actually came from an inttoptr, then the matcher
6026 // will look through it and provide only the integer value. In that case,
6027 // use it here.
6028 if (!DL->isNonIntegralPointerType(Addr->getType())) {
6029 if (!ResultPtr && AddrMode.BaseReg) {
6030 ResultPtr = Builder.CreateIntToPtr(AddrMode.BaseReg, Addr->getType(),
6031 "sunkaddr");
6032 AddrMode.BaseReg = nullptr;
6033 } else if (!ResultPtr && AddrMode.Scale == 1) {
6034 ResultPtr = Builder.CreateIntToPtr(AddrMode.ScaledReg, Addr->getType(),
6035 "sunkaddr");
6036 AddrMode.Scale = 0;
6037 }
6038 }
6039
6040 if (!ResultPtr && !AddrMode.BaseReg && !AddrMode.Scale &&
6041 !AddrMode.BaseOffs) {
6042 SunkAddr = Constant::getNullValue(Addr->getType());
6043 } else if (!ResultPtr) {
6044 return Modified;
6045 } else {
6046 Type *I8PtrTy =
6047 Builder.getPtrTy(Addr->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace());
6048
6049 // Start with the base register. Do this first so that subsequent address
6050 // matching finds it last, which will prevent it from trying to match it
6051 // as the scaled value in case it happens to be a mul. That would be
6052 // problematic if we've sunk a different mul for the scale, because then
6053 // we'd end up sinking both muls.
6054 if (AddrMode.BaseReg) {
6055 Value *V = AddrMode.BaseReg;
6056 if (V->getType() != IntPtrTy)
6057 V = Builder.CreateIntCast(V, IntPtrTy, /*isSigned=*/true, "sunkaddr");
6058
6059 ResultIndex = V;
6060 }
6061
6062 // Add the scale value.
6063 if (AddrMode.Scale) {
6064 Value *V = AddrMode.ScaledReg;
6065 if (V->getType() == IntPtrTy) {
6066 // done.
6067 } else {
6068 assert(cast<IntegerType>(IntPtrTy)->getBitWidth() <
6069 cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth() &&
6070 "We can't transform if ScaledReg is too narrow");
6071 V = Builder.CreateTrunc(V, IntPtrTy, "sunkaddr");
6072 }
6073
6074 if (AddrMode.Scale != 1)
6075 V = Builder.CreateMul(V, ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, AddrMode.Scale),
6076 "sunkaddr");
6077 if (ResultIndex)
6078 ResultIndex = Builder.CreateAdd(ResultIndex, V, "sunkaddr");
6079 else
6080 ResultIndex = V;
6081 }
6082
6083 // Add in the Base Offset if present.
6084 if (AddrMode.BaseOffs) {
6085 Value *V = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, AddrMode.BaseOffs);
6086 if (ResultIndex) {
6087 // We need to add this separately from the scale above to help with
6088 // SDAG consecutive load/store merging.
6089 if (ResultPtr->getType() != I8PtrTy)
6090 ResultPtr = Builder.CreatePointerCast(ResultPtr, I8PtrTy);
6091 ResultPtr = Builder.CreatePtrAdd(ResultPtr, ResultIndex, "sunkaddr",
6092 AddrMode.InBounds);
6093 }
6094
6095 ResultIndex = V;
6096 }
6097
6098 if (!ResultIndex) {
6099 auto PtrInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(ResultPtr);
6100 // We know that we have a pointer without any offsets. If this pointer
6101 // originates from a different basic block than the current one, we
6102 // must be able to recreate it in the current basic block.
6103 // We do not support the recreation of any instructions yet.
6104 if (PtrInst && PtrInst->getParent() != MemoryInst->getParent())
6105 return Modified;
6106 SunkAddr = ResultPtr;
6107 } else {
6108 if (ResultPtr->getType() != I8PtrTy)
6109 ResultPtr = Builder.CreatePointerCast(ResultPtr, I8PtrTy);
6110 SunkAddr = Builder.CreatePtrAdd(ResultPtr, ResultIndex, "sunkaddr",
6111 AddrMode.InBounds);
6112 }
6113
6114 if (SunkAddr->getType() != Addr->getType()) {
6115 if (SunkAddr->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace() !=
6116 Addr->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace() &&
6117 !DL->isNonIntegralPointerType(Addr->getType())) {
6118 // There are two reasons the address spaces might not match: a no-op
6119 // addrspacecast, or a ptrtoint/inttoptr pair. Either way, we emit a
6120 // ptrtoint/inttoptr pair to ensure we match the original semantics.
6121 // TODO: allow bitcast between different address space pointers with
6122 // the same size.
6123 SunkAddr = Builder.CreatePtrToInt(SunkAddr, IntPtrTy, "sunkaddr");
6124 SunkAddr =
6125 Builder.CreateIntToPtr(SunkAddr, Addr->getType(), "sunkaddr");
6126 } else
6127 SunkAddr = Builder.CreatePointerCast(SunkAddr, Addr->getType());
6128 }
6129 }
6130 } else {
6131 // We'd require a ptrtoint/inttoptr down the line, which we can't do for
6132 // non-integral pointers, so in that case bail out now.
6133 Type *BaseTy = AddrMode.BaseReg ? AddrMode.BaseReg->getType() : nullptr;
6134 Type *ScaleTy = AddrMode.Scale ? AddrMode.ScaledReg->getType() : nullptr;
6135 PointerType *BasePtrTy = dyn_cast_or_null<PointerType>(BaseTy);
6136 PointerType *ScalePtrTy = dyn_cast_or_null<PointerType>(ScaleTy);
6137 if (DL->isNonIntegralPointerType(Addr->getType()) ||
6138 (BasePtrTy && DL->isNonIntegralPointerType(BasePtrTy)) ||
6139 (ScalePtrTy && DL->isNonIntegralPointerType(ScalePtrTy)) ||
6140 (AddrMode.BaseGV &&
6141 DL->isNonIntegralPointerType(AddrMode.BaseGV->getType())))
6142 return Modified;
6143
6144 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "CGP: SINKING nonlocal addrmode: " << AddrMode
6145 << " for " << *MemoryInst << "\n");
6146 Type *IntPtrTy = DL->getIntPtrType(Addr->getType());
6147 Value *Result = nullptr;
6148
6149 // Start with the base register. Do this first so that subsequent address
6150 // matching finds it last, which will prevent it from trying to match it
6151 // as the scaled value in case it happens to be a mul. That would be
6152 // problematic if we've sunk a different mul for the scale, because then
6153 // we'd end up sinking both muls.
6154 if (AddrMode.BaseReg) {
6155 Value *V = AddrMode.BaseReg;
6156 if (V->getType()->isPointerTy())
6157 V = Builder.CreatePtrToInt(V, IntPtrTy, "sunkaddr");
6158 if (V->getType() != IntPtrTy)
6159 V = Builder.CreateIntCast(V, IntPtrTy, /*isSigned=*/true, "sunkaddr");
6160 Result = V;
6161 }
6162
6163 // Add the scale value.
6164 if (AddrMode.Scale) {
6165 Value *V = AddrMode.ScaledReg;
6166 if (V->getType() == IntPtrTy) {
6167 // done.
6168 } else if (V->getType()->isPointerTy()) {
6169 V = Builder.CreatePtrToInt(V, IntPtrTy, "sunkaddr");
6170 } else if (cast<IntegerType>(IntPtrTy)->getBitWidth() <
6171 cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth()) {
6172 V = Builder.CreateTrunc(V, IntPtrTy, "sunkaddr");
6173 } else {
6174 // It is only safe to sign extend the BaseReg if we know that the math
6175 // required to create it did not overflow before we extend it. Since
6176 // the original IR value was tossed in favor of a constant back when
6177 // the AddrMode was created we need to bail out gracefully if widths
6178 // do not match instead of extending it.
6179 Instruction *I = dyn_cast_or_null<Instruction>(Result);
6180 if (I && (Result != AddrMode.BaseReg))
6181 I->eraseFromParent();
6182 return Modified;
6183 }
6184 if (AddrMode.Scale != 1)
6185 V = Builder.CreateMul(V, ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, AddrMode.Scale),
6186 "sunkaddr");
6187 if (Result)
6188 Result = Builder.CreateAdd(Result, V, "sunkaddr");
6189 else
6190 Result = V;
6191 }
6192
6193 // Add in the BaseGV if present.
6194 GlobalValue *BaseGV = AddrMode.BaseGV;
6195 if (BaseGV != nullptr) {
6196 Value *BaseGVPtr;
6197 if (BaseGV->isThreadLocal()) {
6198 BaseGVPtr = Builder.CreateThreadLocalAddress(BaseGV);
6199 } else {
6200 BaseGVPtr = BaseGV;
6201 }
6202 Value *V = Builder.CreatePtrToInt(BaseGVPtr, IntPtrTy, "sunkaddr");
6203 if (Result)
6204 Result = Builder.CreateAdd(Result, V, "sunkaddr");
6205 else
6206 Result = V;
6207 }
6208
6209 // Add in the Base Offset if present.
6210 if (AddrMode.BaseOffs) {
6211 Value *V = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, AddrMode.BaseOffs);
6212 if (Result)
6213 Result = Builder.CreateAdd(Result, V, "sunkaddr");
6214 else
6215 Result = V;
6216 }
6217
6218 if (!Result)
6219 SunkAddr = Constant::getNullValue(Addr->getType());
6220 else
6221 SunkAddr = Builder.CreateIntToPtr(Result, Addr->getType(), "sunkaddr");
6222 }
6223
6224 MemoryInst->replaceUsesOfWith(Repl, SunkAddr);
6225 // Store the newly computed address into the cache. In the case we reused a
6226 // value, this should be idempotent.
6227 SunkAddrs[Addr] = WeakTrackingVH(SunkAddr);
6228
6229 // If we have no uses, recursively delete the value and all dead instructions
6230 // using it.
6231 if (Repl->use_empty()) {
6232 resetIteratorIfInvalidatedWhileCalling(CurInstIterator->getParent(), [&]() {
6233 RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(
6234 Repl, TLInfo, nullptr,
6235 [&](Value *V) { removeAllAssertingVHReferences(V); });
6236 });
6237 }
6238 ++NumMemoryInsts;
6239 return true;
6240 }
6241
6242 /// Rewrite GEP input to gather/scatter to enable SelectionDAGBuilder to find
6243 /// a uniform base to use for ISD::MGATHER/MSCATTER. SelectionDAGBuilder can
6244 /// only handle a 2 operand GEP in the same basic block or a splat constant
6245 /// vector. The 2 operands to the GEP must have a scalar pointer and a vector
6246 /// index.
6247 ///
6248 /// If the existing GEP has a vector base pointer that is splat, we can look
6249 /// through the splat to find the scalar pointer. If we can't find a scalar
6250 /// pointer there's nothing we can do.
6251 ///
6252 /// If we have a GEP with more than 2 indices where the middle indices are all
6253 /// zeroes, we can replace it with 2 GEPs where the second has 2 operands.
6254 ///
6255 /// If the final index isn't a vector or is a splat, we can emit a scalar GEP
6256 /// followed by a GEP with an all zeroes vector index. This will enable
6257 /// SelectionDAGBuilder to use the scalar GEP as the uniform base and have a
6258 /// zero index.
optimizeGatherScatterInst(Instruction * MemoryInst,Value * Ptr)6259 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeGatherScatterInst(Instruction *MemoryInst,
6260 Value *Ptr) {
6261 Value *NewAddr;
6262
6263 if (const auto *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr)) {
6264 // Don't optimize GEPs that don't have indices.
6265 if (!GEP->hasIndices())
6266 return false;
6267
6268 // If the GEP and the gather/scatter aren't in the same BB, don't optimize.
6269 // FIXME: We should support this by sinking the GEP.
6270 if (MemoryInst->getParent() != GEP->getParent())
6271 return false;
6272
6273 SmallVector<Value *, 2> Ops(GEP->operands());
6274
6275 bool RewriteGEP = false;
6276
6277 if (Ops[0]->getType()->isVectorTy()) {
6278 Ops[0] = getSplatValue(Ops[0]);
6279 if (!Ops[0])
6280 return false;
6281 RewriteGEP = true;
6282 }
6283
6284 unsigned FinalIndex = Ops.size() - 1;
6285
6286 // Ensure all but the last index is 0.
6287 // FIXME: This isn't strictly required. All that's required is that they are
6288 // all scalars or splats.
6289 for (unsigned i = 1; i < FinalIndex; ++i) {
6290 auto *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Ops[i]);
6291 if (!C)
6292 return false;
6293 if (isa<VectorType>(C->getType()))
6294 C = C->getSplatValue();
6295 auto *CI = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantInt>(C);
6296 if (!CI || !CI->isZero())
6297 return false;
6298 // Scalarize the index if needed.
6299 Ops[i] = CI;
6300 }
6301
6302 // Try to scalarize the final index.
6303 if (Ops[FinalIndex]->getType()->isVectorTy()) {
6304 if (Value *V = getSplatValue(Ops[FinalIndex])) {
6305 auto *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V);
6306 // Don't scalarize all zeros vector.
6307 if (!C || !C->isZero()) {
6308 Ops[FinalIndex] = V;
6309 RewriteGEP = true;
6310 }
6311 }
6312 }
6313
6314 // If we made any changes or the we have extra operands, we need to generate
6315 // new instructions.
6316 if (!RewriteGEP && Ops.size() == 2)
6317 return false;
6318
6319 auto NumElts = cast<VectorType>(Ptr->getType())->getElementCount();
6320
6321 IRBuilder<> Builder(MemoryInst);
6322
6323 Type *SourceTy = GEP->getSourceElementType();
6324 Type *ScalarIndexTy = DL->getIndexType(Ops[0]->getType()->getScalarType());
6325
6326 // If the final index isn't a vector, emit a scalar GEP containing all ops
6327 // and a vector GEP with all zeroes final index.
6328 if (!Ops[FinalIndex]->getType()->isVectorTy()) {
6329 NewAddr = Builder.CreateGEP(SourceTy, Ops[0], ArrayRef(Ops).drop_front());
6330 auto *IndexTy = VectorType::get(ScalarIndexTy, NumElts);
6331 auto *SecondTy = GetElementPtrInst::getIndexedType(
6332 SourceTy, ArrayRef(Ops).drop_front());
6333 NewAddr =
6334 Builder.CreateGEP(SecondTy, NewAddr, Constant::getNullValue(IndexTy));
6335 } else {
6336 Value *Base = Ops[0];
6337 Value *Index = Ops[FinalIndex];
6338
6339 // Create a scalar GEP if there are more than 2 operands.
6340 if (Ops.size() != 2) {
6341 // Replace the last index with 0.
6342 Ops[FinalIndex] =
6343 Constant::getNullValue(Ops[FinalIndex]->getType()->getScalarType());
6344 Base = Builder.CreateGEP(SourceTy, Base, ArrayRef(Ops).drop_front());
6345 SourceTy = GetElementPtrInst::getIndexedType(
6346 SourceTy, ArrayRef(Ops).drop_front());
6347 }
6348
6349 // Now create the GEP with scalar pointer and vector index.
6350 NewAddr = Builder.CreateGEP(SourceTy, Base, Index);
6351 }
6352 } else if (!isa<Constant>(Ptr)) {
6353 // Not a GEP, maybe its a splat and we can create a GEP to enable
6354 // SelectionDAGBuilder to use it as a uniform base.
6355 Value *V = getSplatValue(Ptr);
6356 if (!V)
6357 return false;
6358
6359 auto NumElts = cast<VectorType>(Ptr->getType())->getElementCount();
6360
6361 IRBuilder<> Builder(MemoryInst);
6362
6363 // Emit a vector GEP with a scalar pointer and all 0s vector index.
6364 Type *ScalarIndexTy = DL->getIndexType(V->getType()->getScalarType());
6365 auto *IndexTy = VectorType::get(ScalarIndexTy, NumElts);
6366 Type *ScalarTy;
6367 if (cast<IntrinsicInst>(MemoryInst)->getIntrinsicID() ==
6368 Intrinsic::masked_gather) {
6369 ScalarTy = MemoryInst->getType()->getScalarType();
6370 } else {
6371 assert(cast<IntrinsicInst>(MemoryInst)->getIntrinsicID() ==
6372 Intrinsic::masked_scatter);
6373 ScalarTy = MemoryInst->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarType();
6374 }
6375 NewAddr = Builder.CreateGEP(ScalarTy, V, Constant::getNullValue(IndexTy));
6376 } else {
6377 // Constant, SelectionDAGBuilder knows to check if its a splat.
6378 return false;
6379 }
6380
6381 MemoryInst->replaceUsesOfWith(Ptr, NewAddr);
6382
6383 // If we have no uses, recursively delete the value and all dead instructions
6384 // using it.
6385 if (Ptr->use_empty())
6386 RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(
6387 Ptr, TLInfo, nullptr,
6388 [&](Value *V) { removeAllAssertingVHReferences(V); });
6389
6390 return true;
6391 }
6392
6393 /// If there are any memory operands, use OptimizeMemoryInst to sink their
6394 /// address computing into the block when possible / profitable.
optimizeInlineAsmInst(CallInst * CS)6395 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeInlineAsmInst(CallInst *CS) {
6396 bool MadeChange = false;
6397
6398 const TargetRegisterInfo *TRI =
6399 TM->getSubtargetImpl(*CS->getFunction())->getRegisterInfo();
6400 TargetLowering::AsmOperandInfoVector TargetConstraints =
6401 TLI->ParseConstraints(*DL, TRI, *CS);
6402 unsigned ArgNo = 0;
6403 for (TargetLowering::AsmOperandInfo &OpInfo : TargetConstraints) {
6404 // Compute the constraint code and ConstraintType to use.
6405 TLI->ComputeConstraintToUse(OpInfo, SDValue());
6406
6407 // TODO: Also handle C_Address?
6408 if (OpInfo.ConstraintType == TargetLowering::C_Memory &&
6409 OpInfo.isIndirect) {
6410 Value *OpVal = CS->getArgOperand(ArgNo++);
6411 MadeChange |= optimizeMemoryInst(CS, OpVal, OpVal->getType(), ~0u);
6412 } else if (OpInfo.Type == InlineAsm::isInput)
6413 ArgNo++;
6414 }
6415
6416 return MadeChange;
6417 }
6418
6419 /// Check if all the uses of \p Val are equivalent (or free) zero or
6420 /// sign extensions.
hasSameExtUse(Value * Val,const TargetLowering & TLI)6421 static bool hasSameExtUse(Value *Val, const TargetLowering &TLI) {
6422 assert(!Val->use_empty() && "Input must have at least one use");
6423 const Instruction *FirstUser = cast<Instruction>(*Val->user_begin());
6424 bool IsSExt = isa<SExtInst>(FirstUser);
6425 Type *ExtTy = FirstUser->getType();
6426 for (const User *U : Val->users()) {
6427 const Instruction *UI = cast<Instruction>(U);
6428 if ((IsSExt && !isa<SExtInst>(UI)) || (!IsSExt && !isa<ZExtInst>(UI)))
6429 return false;
6430 Type *CurTy = UI->getType();
6431 // Same input and output types: Same instruction after CSE.
6432 if (CurTy == ExtTy)
6433 continue;
6434
6435 // If IsSExt is true, we are in this situation:
6436 // a = Val
6437 // b = sext ty1 a to ty2
6438 // c = sext ty1 a to ty3
6439 // Assuming ty2 is shorter than ty3, this could be turned into:
6440 // a = Val
6441 // b = sext ty1 a to ty2
6442 // c = sext ty2 b to ty3
6443 // However, the last sext is not free.
6444 if (IsSExt)
6445 return false;
6446
6447 // This is a ZExt, maybe this is free to extend from one type to another.
6448 // In that case, we would not account for a different use.
6449 Type *NarrowTy;
6450 Type *LargeTy;
6451 if (ExtTy->getScalarType()->getIntegerBitWidth() >
6452 CurTy->getScalarType()->getIntegerBitWidth()) {
6453 NarrowTy = CurTy;
6454 LargeTy = ExtTy;
6455 } else {
6456 NarrowTy = ExtTy;
6457 LargeTy = CurTy;
6458 }
6459
6460 if (!TLI.isZExtFree(NarrowTy, LargeTy))
6461 return false;
6462 }
6463 // All uses are the same or can be derived from one another for free.
6464 return true;
6465 }
6466
6467 /// Try to speculatively promote extensions in \p Exts and continue
6468 /// promoting through newly promoted operands recursively as far as doing so is
6469 /// profitable. Save extensions profitably moved up, in \p ProfitablyMovedExts.
6470 /// When some promotion happened, \p TPT contains the proper state to revert
6471 /// them.
6472 ///
6473 /// \return true if some promotion happened, false otherwise.
tryToPromoteExts(TypePromotionTransaction & TPT,const SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > & Exts,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > & ProfitablyMovedExts,unsigned CreatedInstsCost)6474 bool CodeGenPrepare::tryToPromoteExts(
6475 TypePromotionTransaction &TPT, const SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &Exts,
6476 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &ProfitablyMovedExts,
6477 unsigned CreatedInstsCost) {
6478 bool Promoted = false;
6479
6480 // Iterate over all the extensions to try to promote them.
6481 for (auto *I : Exts) {
6482 // Early check if we directly have ext(load).
6483 if (isa<LoadInst>(I->getOperand(0))) {
6484 ProfitablyMovedExts.push_back(I);
6485 continue;
6486 }
6487
6488 // Check whether or not we want to do any promotion. The reason we have
6489 // this check inside the for loop is to catch the case where an extension
6490 // is directly fed by a load because in such case the extension can be moved
6491 // up without any promotion on its operands.
6492 if (!TLI->enableExtLdPromotion() || DisableExtLdPromotion)
6493 return false;
6494
6495 // Get the action to perform the promotion.
6496 TypePromotionHelper::Action TPH =
6497 TypePromotionHelper::getAction(I, InsertedInsts, *TLI, PromotedInsts);
6498 // Check if we can promote.
6499 if (!TPH) {
6500 // Save the current extension as we cannot move up through its operand.
6501 ProfitablyMovedExts.push_back(I);
6502 continue;
6503 }
6504
6505 // Save the current state.
6506 TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
6507 TPT.getRestorationPoint();
6508 SmallVector<Instruction *, 4> NewExts;
6509 unsigned NewCreatedInstsCost = 0;
6510 unsigned ExtCost = !TLI->isExtFree(I);
6511 // Promote.
6512 Value *PromotedVal = TPH(I, TPT, PromotedInsts, NewCreatedInstsCost,
6513 &NewExts, nullptr, *TLI);
6514 assert(PromotedVal &&
6515 "TypePromotionHelper should have filtered out those cases");
6516
6517 // We would be able to merge only one extension in a load.
6518 // Therefore, if we have more than 1 new extension we heuristically
6519 // cut this search path, because it means we degrade the code quality.
6520 // With exactly 2, the transformation is neutral, because we will merge
6521 // one extension but leave one. However, we optimistically keep going,
6522 // because the new extension may be removed too. Also avoid replacing a
6523 // single free extension with multiple extensions, as this increases the
6524 // number of IR instructions while not providing any savings.
6525 long long TotalCreatedInstsCost = CreatedInstsCost + NewCreatedInstsCost;
6526 // FIXME: It would be possible to propagate a negative value instead of
6527 // conservatively ceiling it to 0.
6528 TotalCreatedInstsCost =
6529 std::max((long long)0, (TotalCreatedInstsCost - ExtCost));
6530 if (!StressExtLdPromotion &&
6531 (TotalCreatedInstsCost > 1 ||
6532 !isPromotedInstructionLegal(*TLI, *DL, PromotedVal) ||
6533 (ExtCost == 0 && NewExts.size() > 1))) {
6534 // This promotion is not profitable, rollback to the previous state, and
6535 // save the current extension in ProfitablyMovedExts as the latest
6536 // speculative promotion turned out to be unprofitable.
6537 TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
6538 ProfitablyMovedExts.push_back(I);
6539 continue;
6540 }
6541 // Continue promoting NewExts as far as doing so is profitable.
6542 SmallVector<Instruction *, 2> NewlyMovedExts;
6543 (void)tryToPromoteExts(TPT, NewExts, NewlyMovedExts, TotalCreatedInstsCost);
6544 bool NewPromoted = false;
6545 for (auto *ExtInst : NewlyMovedExts) {
6546 Instruction *MovedExt = cast<Instruction>(ExtInst);
6547 Value *ExtOperand = MovedExt->getOperand(0);
6548 // If we have reached to a load, we need this extra profitability check
6549 // as it could potentially be merged into an ext(load).
6550 if (isa<LoadInst>(ExtOperand) &&
6551 !(StressExtLdPromotion || NewCreatedInstsCost <= ExtCost ||
6552 (ExtOperand->hasOneUse() || hasSameExtUse(ExtOperand, *TLI))))
6553 continue;
6554
6555 ProfitablyMovedExts.push_back(MovedExt);
6556 NewPromoted = true;
6557 }
6558
6559 // If none of speculative promotions for NewExts is profitable, rollback
6560 // and save the current extension (I) as the last profitable extension.
6561 if (!NewPromoted) {
6562 TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
6563 ProfitablyMovedExts.push_back(I);
6564 continue;
6565 }
6566 // The promotion is profitable.
6567 Promoted = true;
6568 }
6569 return Promoted;
6570 }
6571
6572 /// Merging redundant sexts when one is dominating the other.
mergeSExts(Function & F)6573 bool CodeGenPrepare::mergeSExts(Function &F) {
6574 bool Changed = false;
6575 for (auto &Entry : ValToSExtendedUses) {
6576 SExts &Insts = Entry.second;
6577 SExts CurPts;
6578 for (Instruction *Inst : Insts) {
6579 if (RemovedInsts.count(Inst) || !isa<SExtInst>(Inst) ||
6580 Inst->getOperand(0) != Entry.first)
6581 continue;
6582 bool inserted = false;
6583 for (auto &Pt : CurPts) {
6584 if (getDT(F).dominates(Inst, Pt)) {
6585 replaceAllUsesWith(Pt, Inst, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
6586 RemovedInsts.insert(Pt);
6587 Pt->removeFromParent();
6588 Pt = Inst;
6589 inserted = true;
6590 Changed = true;
6591 break;
6592 }
6593 if (!getDT(F).dominates(Pt, Inst))
6594 // Give up if we need to merge in a common dominator as the
6595 // experiments show it is not profitable.
6596 continue;
6597 replaceAllUsesWith(Inst, Pt, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
6598 RemovedInsts.insert(Inst);
6599 Inst->removeFromParent();
6600 inserted = true;
6601 Changed = true;
6602 break;
6603 }
6604 if (!inserted)
6605 CurPts.push_back(Inst);
6606 }
6607 }
6608 return Changed;
6609 }
6610
6611 // Splitting large data structures so that the GEPs accessing them can have
6612 // smaller offsets so that they can be sunk to the same blocks as their users.
6613 // For example, a large struct starting from %base is split into two parts
6614 // where the second part starts from %new_base.
6615 //
6616 // Before:
6617 // BB0:
6618 // %base =
6619 //
6620 // BB1:
6621 // %gep0 = gep %base, off0
6622 // %gep1 = gep %base, off1
6623 // %gep2 = gep %base, off2
6624 //
6625 // BB2:
6626 // %load1 = load %gep0
6627 // %load2 = load %gep1
6628 // %load3 = load %gep2
6629 //
6630 // After:
6631 // BB0:
6632 // %base =
6633 // %new_base = gep %base, off0
6634 //
6635 // BB1:
6636 // %new_gep0 = %new_base
6637 // %new_gep1 = gep %new_base, off1 - off0
6638 // %new_gep2 = gep %new_base, off2 - off0
6639 //
6640 // BB2:
6641 // %load1 = load i32, i32* %new_gep0
6642 // %load2 = load i32, i32* %new_gep1
6643 // %load3 = load i32, i32* %new_gep2
6644 //
6645 // %new_gep1 and %new_gep2 can be sunk to BB2 now after the splitting because
6646 // their offsets are smaller enough to fit into the addressing mode.
splitLargeGEPOffsets()6647 bool CodeGenPrepare::splitLargeGEPOffsets() {
6648 bool Changed = false;
6649 for (auto &Entry : LargeOffsetGEPMap) {
6650 Value *OldBase = Entry.first;
6651 SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t>>
6652 &LargeOffsetGEPs = Entry.second;
6653 auto compareGEPOffset =
6654 [&](const std::pair<GetElementPtrInst *, int64_t> &LHS,
6655 const std::pair<GetElementPtrInst *, int64_t> &RHS) {
6656 if (LHS.first == RHS.first)
6657 return false;
6658 if (LHS.second != RHS.second)
6659 return LHS.second < RHS.second;
6660 return LargeOffsetGEPID[LHS.first] < LargeOffsetGEPID[RHS.first];
6661 };
6662 // Sorting all the GEPs of the same data structures based on the offsets.
6663 llvm::sort(LargeOffsetGEPs, compareGEPOffset);
6664 LargeOffsetGEPs.erase(llvm::unique(LargeOffsetGEPs), LargeOffsetGEPs.end());
6665 // Skip if all the GEPs have the same offsets.
6666 if (LargeOffsetGEPs.front().second == LargeOffsetGEPs.back().second)
6667 continue;
6668 GetElementPtrInst *BaseGEP = LargeOffsetGEPs.begin()->first;
6669 int64_t BaseOffset = LargeOffsetGEPs.begin()->second;
6670 Value *NewBaseGEP = nullptr;
6671
6672 auto createNewBase = [&](int64_t BaseOffset, Value *OldBase,
6673 GetElementPtrInst *GEP) {
6674 LLVMContext &Ctx = GEP->getContext();
6675 Type *PtrIdxTy = DL->getIndexType(GEP->getType());
6676 Type *I8PtrTy =
6677 PointerType::get(Ctx, GEP->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace());
6678
6679 BasicBlock::iterator NewBaseInsertPt;
6680 BasicBlock *NewBaseInsertBB;
6681 if (auto *BaseI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(OldBase)) {
6682 // If the base of the struct is an instruction, the new base will be
6683 // inserted close to it.
6684 NewBaseInsertBB = BaseI->getParent();
6685 if (isa<PHINode>(BaseI))
6686 NewBaseInsertPt = NewBaseInsertBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
6687 else if (InvokeInst *Invoke = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(BaseI)) {
6688 NewBaseInsertBB =
6689 SplitEdge(NewBaseInsertBB, Invoke->getNormalDest(), DT.get(), LI);
6690 NewBaseInsertPt = NewBaseInsertBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
6691 } else
6692 NewBaseInsertPt = std::next(BaseI->getIterator());
6693 } else {
6694 // If the current base is an argument or global value, the new base
6695 // will be inserted to the entry block.
6696 NewBaseInsertBB = &BaseGEP->getFunction()->getEntryBlock();
6697 NewBaseInsertPt = NewBaseInsertBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
6698 }
6699 IRBuilder<> NewBaseBuilder(NewBaseInsertBB, NewBaseInsertPt);
6700 // Create a new base.
6701 Value *BaseIndex = ConstantInt::get(PtrIdxTy, BaseOffset);
6702 NewBaseGEP = OldBase;
6703 if (NewBaseGEP->getType() != I8PtrTy)
6704 NewBaseGEP = NewBaseBuilder.CreatePointerCast(NewBaseGEP, I8PtrTy);
6705 NewBaseGEP =
6706 NewBaseBuilder.CreatePtrAdd(NewBaseGEP, BaseIndex, "splitgep");
6707 NewGEPBases.insert(NewBaseGEP);
6708 return;
6709 };
6710
6711 // Check whether all the offsets can be encoded with prefered common base.
6712 if (int64_t PreferBase = TLI->getPreferredLargeGEPBaseOffset(
6713 LargeOffsetGEPs.front().second, LargeOffsetGEPs.back().second)) {
6714 BaseOffset = PreferBase;
6715 // Create a new base if the offset of the BaseGEP can be decoded with one
6716 // instruction.
6717 createNewBase(BaseOffset, OldBase, BaseGEP);
6718 }
6719
6720 auto *LargeOffsetGEP = LargeOffsetGEPs.begin();
6721 while (LargeOffsetGEP != LargeOffsetGEPs.end()) {
6722 GetElementPtrInst *GEP = LargeOffsetGEP->first;
6723 int64_t Offset = LargeOffsetGEP->second;
6724 if (Offset != BaseOffset) {
6725 TargetLowering::AddrMode AddrMode;
6726 AddrMode.HasBaseReg = true;
6727 AddrMode.BaseOffs = Offset - BaseOffset;
6728 // The result type of the GEP might not be the type of the memory
6729 // access.
6730 if (!TLI->isLegalAddressingMode(*DL, AddrMode,
6731 GEP->getResultElementType(),
6732 GEP->getAddressSpace())) {
6733 // We need to create a new base if the offset to the current base is
6734 // too large to fit into the addressing mode. So, a very large struct
6735 // may be split into several parts.
6736 BaseGEP = GEP;
6737 BaseOffset = Offset;
6738 NewBaseGEP = nullptr;
6739 }
6740 }
6741
6742 // Generate a new GEP to replace the current one.
6743 Type *PtrIdxTy = DL->getIndexType(GEP->getType());
6744
6745 if (!NewBaseGEP) {
6746 // Create a new base if we don't have one yet. Find the insertion
6747 // pointer for the new base first.
6748 createNewBase(BaseOffset, OldBase, GEP);
6749 }
6750
6751 IRBuilder<> Builder(GEP);
6752 Value *NewGEP = NewBaseGEP;
6753 if (Offset != BaseOffset) {
6754 // Calculate the new offset for the new GEP.
6755 Value *Index = ConstantInt::get(PtrIdxTy, Offset - BaseOffset);
6756 NewGEP = Builder.CreatePtrAdd(NewBaseGEP, Index);
6757 }
6758 replaceAllUsesWith(GEP, NewGEP, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
6759 LargeOffsetGEPID.erase(GEP);
6760 LargeOffsetGEP = LargeOffsetGEPs.erase(LargeOffsetGEP);
6761 GEP->eraseFromParent();
6762 Changed = true;
6763 }
6764 }
6765 return Changed;
6766 }
6767
optimizePhiType(PHINode * I,SmallPtrSetImpl<PHINode * > & Visited,SmallPtrSetImpl<Instruction * > & DeletedInstrs)6768 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizePhiType(
6769 PHINode *I, SmallPtrSetImpl<PHINode *> &Visited,
6770 SmallPtrSetImpl<Instruction *> &DeletedInstrs) {
6771 // We are looking for a collection on interconnected phi nodes that together
6772 // only use loads/bitcasts and are used by stores/bitcasts, and the bitcasts
6773 // are of the same type. Convert the whole set of nodes to the type of the
6774 // bitcast.
6775 Type *PhiTy = I->getType();
6776 Type *ConvertTy = nullptr;
6777 if (Visited.count(I) ||
6778 (!I->getType()->isIntegerTy() && !I->getType()->isFloatingPointTy()))
6779 return false;
6780
6781 SmallVector<Instruction *, 4> Worklist;
6782 Worklist.push_back(cast<Instruction>(I));
6783 SmallPtrSet<PHINode *, 4> PhiNodes;
6784 SmallPtrSet<ConstantData *, 4> Constants;
6785 PhiNodes.insert(I);
6786 Visited.insert(I);
6787 SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 4> Defs;
6788 SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 4> Uses;
6789 // This works by adding extra bitcasts between load/stores and removing
6790 // existing bicasts. If we have a phi(bitcast(load)) or a store(bitcast(phi))
6791 // we can get in the situation where we remove a bitcast in one iteration
6792 // just to add it again in the next. We need to ensure that at least one
6793 // bitcast we remove are anchored to something that will not change back.
6794 bool AnyAnchored = false;
6795
6796 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
6797 Instruction *II = Worklist.pop_back_val();
6798
6799 if (auto *Phi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(II)) {
6800 // Handle Defs, which might also be PHI's
6801 for (Value *V : Phi->incoming_values()) {
6802 if (auto *OpPhi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V)) {
6803 if (!PhiNodes.count(OpPhi)) {
6804 if (!Visited.insert(OpPhi).second)
6805 return false;
6806 PhiNodes.insert(OpPhi);
6807 Worklist.push_back(OpPhi);
6808 }
6809 } else if (auto *OpLoad = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(V)) {
6810 if (!OpLoad->isSimple())
6811 return false;
6812 if (Defs.insert(OpLoad).second)
6813 Worklist.push_back(OpLoad);
6814 } else if (auto *OpEx = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(V)) {
6815 if (Defs.insert(OpEx).second)
6816 Worklist.push_back(OpEx);
6817 } else if (auto *OpBC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V)) {
6818 if (!ConvertTy)
6819 ConvertTy = OpBC->getOperand(0)->getType();
6820 if (OpBC->getOperand(0)->getType() != ConvertTy)
6821 return false;
6822 if (Defs.insert(OpBC).second) {
6823 Worklist.push_back(OpBC);
6824 AnyAnchored |= !isa<LoadInst>(OpBC->getOperand(0)) &&
6825 !isa<ExtractElementInst>(OpBC->getOperand(0));
6826 }
6827 } else if (auto *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantData>(V))
6828 Constants.insert(OpC);
6829 else
6830 return false;
6831 }
6832 }
6833
6834 // Handle uses which might also be phi's
6835 for (User *V : II->users()) {
6836 if (auto *OpPhi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V)) {
6837 if (!PhiNodes.count(OpPhi)) {
6838 if (Visited.count(OpPhi))
6839 return false;
6840 PhiNodes.insert(OpPhi);
6841 Visited.insert(OpPhi);
6842 Worklist.push_back(OpPhi);
6843 }
6844 } else if (auto *OpStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(V)) {
6845 if (!OpStore->isSimple() || OpStore->getOperand(0) != II)
6846 return false;
6847 Uses.insert(OpStore);
6848 } else if (auto *OpBC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V)) {
6849 if (!ConvertTy)
6850 ConvertTy = OpBC->getType();
6851 if (OpBC->getType() != ConvertTy)
6852 return false;
6853 Uses.insert(OpBC);
6854 AnyAnchored |=
6855 any_of(OpBC->users(), [](User *U) { return !isa<StoreInst>(U); });
6856 } else {
6857 return false;
6858 }
6859 }
6860 }
6861
6862 if (!ConvertTy || !AnyAnchored ||
6863 !TLI->shouldConvertPhiType(PhiTy, ConvertTy))
6864 return false;
6865
6866 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Converting " << *I << "\n and connected nodes to "
6867 << *ConvertTy << "\n");
6868
6869 // Create all the new phi nodes of the new type, and bitcast any loads to the
6870 // correct type.
6871 ValueToValueMap ValMap;
6872 for (ConstantData *C : Constants)
6873 ValMap[C] = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(C, ConvertTy);
6874 for (Instruction *D : Defs) {
6875 if (isa<BitCastInst>(D)) {
6876 ValMap[D] = D->getOperand(0);
6877 DeletedInstrs.insert(D);
6878 } else {
6879 BasicBlock::iterator insertPt = std::next(D->getIterator());
6880 ValMap[D] = new BitCastInst(D, ConvertTy, D->getName() + ".bc", insertPt);
6881 }
6882 }
6883 for (PHINode *Phi : PhiNodes)
6884 ValMap[Phi] = PHINode::Create(ConvertTy, Phi->getNumIncomingValues(),
6885 Phi->getName() + ".tc", Phi->getIterator());
6886 // Pipe together all the PhiNodes.
6887 for (PHINode *Phi : PhiNodes) {
6888 PHINode *NewPhi = cast<PHINode>(ValMap[Phi]);
6889 for (int i = 0, e = Phi->getNumIncomingValues(); i < e; i++)
6890 NewPhi->addIncoming(ValMap[Phi->getIncomingValue(i)],
6891 Phi->getIncomingBlock(i));
6892 Visited.insert(NewPhi);
6893 }
6894 // And finally pipe up the stores and bitcasts
6895 for (Instruction *U : Uses) {
6896 if (isa<BitCastInst>(U)) {
6897 DeletedInstrs.insert(U);
6898 replaceAllUsesWith(U, ValMap[U->getOperand(0)], FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
6899 } else {
6900 U->setOperand(0, new BitCastInst(ValMap[U->getOperand(0)], PhiTy, "bc",
6901 U->getIterator()));
6902 }
6903 }
6904
6905 // Save the removed phis to be deleted later.
6906 DeletedInstrs.insert_range(PhiNodes);
6907 return true;
6908 }
6909
optimizePhiTypes(Function & F)6910 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizePhiTypes(Function &F) {
6911 if (!OptimizePhiTypes)
6912 return false;
6913
6914 bool Changed = false;
6915 SmallPtrSet<PHINode *, 4> Visited;
6916 SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 4> DeletedInstrs;
6917
6918 // Attempt to optimize all the phis in the functions to the correct type.
6919 for (auto &BB : F)
6920 for (auto &Phi : BB.phis())
6921 Changed |= optimizePhiType(&Phi, Visited, DeletedInstrs);
6922
6923 // Remove any old phi's that have been converted.
6924 for (auto *I : DeletedInstrs) {
6925 replaceAllUsesWith(I, PoisonValue::get(I->getType()), FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
6926 I->eraseFromParent();
6927 }
6928
6929 return Changed;
6930 }
6931
6932 /// Return true, if an ext(load) can be formed from an extension in
6933 /// \p MovedExts.
canFormExtLd(const SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > & MovedExts,LoadInst * & LI,Instruction * & Inst,bool HasPromoted)6934 bool CodeGenPrepare::canFormExtLd(
6935 const SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &MovedExts, LoadInst *&LI,
6936 Instruction *&Inst, bool HasPromoted) {
6937 for (auto *MovedExtInst : MovedExts) {
6938 if (isa<LoadInst>(MovedExtInst->getOperand(0))) {
6939 LI = cast<LoadInst>(MovedExtInst->getOperand(0));
6940 Inst = MovedExtInst;
6941 break;
6942 }
6943 }
6944 if (!LI)
6945 return false;
6946
6947 // If they're already in the same block, there's nothing to do.
6948 // Make the cheap checks first if we did not promote.
6949 // If we promoted, we need to check if it is indeed profitable.
6950 if (!HasPromoted && LI->getParent() == Inst->getParent())
6951 return false;
6952
6953 return TLI->isExtLoad(LI, Inst, *DL);
6954 }
6955
6956 /// Move a zext or sext fed by a load into the same basic block as the load,
6957 /// unless conditions are unfavorable. This allows SelectionDAG to fold the
6958 /// extend into the load.
6959 ///
6960 /// E.g.,
6961 /// \code
6962 /// %ld = load i32* %addr
6963 /// %add = add nuw i32 %ld, 4
6964 /// %zext = zext i32 %add to i64
6965 // \endcode
6966 /// =>
6967 /// \code
6968 /// %ld = load i32* %addr
6969 /// %zext = zext i32 %ld to i64
6970 /// %add = add nuw i64 %zext, 4
6971 /// \encode
6972 /// Note that the promotion in %add to i64 is done in tryToPromoteExts(), which
6973 /// allow us to match zext(load i32*) to i64.
6974 ///
6975 /// Also, try to promote the computations used to obtain a sign extended
6976 /// value used into memory accesses.
6977 /// E.g.,
6978 /// \code
6979 /// a = add nsw i32 b, 3
6980 /// d = sext i32 a to i64
6981 /// e = getelementptr ..., i64 d
6982 /// \endcode
6983 /// =>
6984 /// \code
6985 /// f = sext i32 b to i64
6986 /// a = add nsw i64 f, 3
6987 /// e = getelementptr ..., i64 a
6988 /// \endcode
6989 ///
6990 /// \p Inst[in/out] the extension may be modified during the process if some
6991 /// promotions apply.
optimizeExt(Instruction * & Inst)6992 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeExt(Instruction *&Inst) {
6993 bool AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader = false;
6994 /// See if it is an interesting sext operations for the address type
6995 /// promotion before trying to promote it, e.g., the ones with the right
6996 /// type and used in memory accesses.
6997 bool ATPConsiderable = TTI->shouldConsiderAddressTypePromotion(
6998 *Inst, AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader);
6999 TypePromotionTransaction TPT(RemovedInsts);
7000 TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
7001 TPT.getRestorationPoint();
7002 SmallVector<Instruction *, 1> Exts;
7003 SmallVector<Instruction *, 2> SpeculativelyMovedExts;
7004 Exts.push_back(Inst);
7005
7006 bool HasPromoted = tryToPromoteExts(TPT, Exts, SpeculativelyMovedExts);
7007
7008 // Look for a load being extended.
7009 LoadInst *LI = nullptr;
7010 Instruction *ExtFedByLoad;
7011
7012 // Try to promote a chain of computation if it allows to form an extended
7013 // load.
7014 if (canFormExtLd(SpeculativelyMovedExts, LI, ExtFedByLoad, HasPromoted)) {
7015 assert(LI && ExtFedByLoad && "Expect a valid load and extension");
7016 TPT.commit();
7017 // Move the extend into the same block as the load.
7018 ExtFedByLoad->moveAfter(LI);
7019 ++NumExtsMoved;
7020 Inst = ExtFedByLoad;
7021 return true;
7022 }
7023
7024 // Continue promoting SExts if known as considerable depending on targets.
7025 if (ATPConsiderable &&
7026 performAddressTypePromotion(Inst, AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader,
7027 HasPromoted, TPT, SpeculativelyMovedExts))
7028 return true;
7029
7030 TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
7031 return false;
7032 }
7033
7034 // Perform address type promotion if doing so is profitable.
7035 // If AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader == false, we should find other sext
7036 // instructions that sign extended the same initial value. However, if
7037 // AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader == true, we expect promoting the
7038 // extension is just profitable.
performAddressTypePromotion(Instruction * & Inst,bool AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader,bool HasPromoted,TypePromotionTransaction & TPT,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > & SpeculativelyMovedExts)7039 bool CodeGenPrepare::performAddressTypePromotion(
7040 Instruction *&Inst, bool AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader,
7041 bool HasPromoted, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
7042 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &SpeculativelyMovedExts) {
7043 bool Promoted = false;
7044 SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 1> UnhandledExts;
7045 bool AllSeenFirst = true;
7046 for (auto *I : SpeculativelyMovedExts) {
7047 Value *HeadOfChain = I->getOperand(0);
7048 DenseMap<Value *, Instruction *>::iterator AlreadySeen =
7049 SeenChainsForSExt.find(HeadOfChain);
7050 // If there is an unhandled SExt which has the same header, try to promote
7051 // it as well.
7052 if (AlreadySeen != SeenChainsForSExt.end()) {
7053 if (AlreadySeen->second != nullptr)
7054 UnhandledExts.insert(AlreadySeen->second);
7055 AllSeenFirst = false;
7056 }
7057 }
7058
7059 if (!AllSeenFirst || (AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader &&
7060 SpeculativelyMovedExts.size() == 1)) {
7061 TPT.commit();
7062 if (HasPromoted)
7063 Promoted = true;
7064 for (auto *I : SpeculativelyMovedExts) {
7065 Value *HeadOfChain = I->getOperand(0);
7066 SeenChainsForSExt[HeadOfChain] = nullptr;
7067 ValToSExtendedUses[HeadOfChain].push_back(I);
7068 }
7069 // Update Inst as promotion happen.
7070 Inst = SpeculativelyMovedExts.pop_back_val();
7071 } else {
7072 // This is the first chain visited from the header, keep the current chain
7073 // as unhandled. Defer to promote this until we encounter another SExt
7074 // chain derived from the same header.
7075 for (auto *I : SpeculativelyMovedExts) {
7076 Value *HeadOfChain = I->getOperand(0);
7077 SeenChainsForSExt[HeadOfChain] = Inst;
7078 }
7079 return false;
7080 }
7081
7082 if (!AllSeenFirst && !UnhandledExts.empty())
7083 for (auto *VisitedSExt : UnhandledExts) {
7084 if (RemovedInsts.count(VisitedSExt))
7085 continue;
7086 TypePromotionTransaction TPT(RemovedInsts);
7087 SmallVector<Instruction *, 1> Exts;
7088 SmallVector<Instruction *, 2> Chains;
7089 Exts.push_back(VisitedSExt);
7090 bool HasPromoted = tryToPromoteExts(TPT, Exts, Chains);
7091 TPT.commit();
7092 if (HasPromoted)
7093 Promoted = true;
7094 for (auto *I : Chains) {
7095 Value *HeadOfChain = I->getOperand(0);
7096 // Mark this as handled.
7097 SeenChainsForSExt[HeadOfChain] = nullptr;
7098 ValToSExtendedUses[HeadOfChain].push_back(I);
7099 }
7100 }
7101 return Promoted;
7102 }
7103
optimizeExtUses(Instruction * I)7104 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeExtUses(Instruction *I) {
7105 BasicBlock *DefBB = I->getParent();
7106
7107 // If the result of a {s|z}ext and its source are both live out, rewrite all
7108 // other uses of the source with result of extension.
7109 Value *Src = I->getOperand(0);
7110 if (Src->hasOneUse())
7111 return false;
7112
7113 // Only do this xform if truncating is free.
7114 if (!TLI->isTruncateFree(I->getType(), Src->getType()))
7115 return false;
7116
7117 // Only safe to perform the optimization if the source is also defined in
7118 // this block.
7119 if (!isa<Instruction>(Src) || DefBB != cast<Instruction>(Src)->getParent())
7120 return false;
7121
7122 bool DefIsLiveOut = false;
7123 for (User *U : I->users()) {
7124 Instruction *UI = cast<Instruction>(U);
7125
7126 // Figure out which BB this ext is used in.
7127 BasicBlock *UserBB = UI->getParent();
7128 if (UserBB == DefBB)
7129 continue;
7130 DefIsLiveOut = true;
7131 break;
7132 }
7133 if (!DefIsLiveOut)
7134 return false;
7135
7136 // Make sure none of the uses are PHI nodes.
7137 for (User *U : Src->users()) {
7138 Instruction *UI = cast<Instruction>(U);
7139 BasicBlock *UserBB = UI->getParent();
7140 if (UserBB == DefBB)
7141 continue;
7142 // Be conservative. We don't want this xform to end up introducing
7143 // reloads just before load / store instructions.
7144 if (isa<PHINode>(UI) || isa<LoadInst>(UI) || isa<StoreInst>(UI))
7145 return false;
7146 }
7147
7148 // InsertedTruncs - Only insert one trunc in each block once.
7149 DenseMap<BasicBlock *, Instruction *> InsertedTruncs;
7150
7151 bool MadeChange = false;
7152 for (Use &U : Src->uses()) {
7153 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(U.getUser());
7154
7155 // Figure out which BB this ext is used in.
7156 BasicBlock *UserBB = User->getParent();
7157 if (UserBB == DefBB)
7158 continue;
7159
7160 // Both src and def are live in this block. Rewrite the use.
7161 Instruction *&InsertedTrunc = InsertedTruncs[UserBB];
7162
7163 if (!InsertedTrunc) {
7164 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPt = UserBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
7165 assert(InsertPt != UserBB->end());
7166 InsertedTrunc = new TruncInst(I, Src->getType(), "");
7167 InsertedTrunc->insertBefore(*UserBB, InsertPt);
7168 InsertedInsts.insert(InsertedTrunc);
7169 }
7170
7171 // Replace a use of the {s|z}ext source with a use of the result.
7172 U = InsertedTrunc;
7173 ++NumExtUses;
7174 MadeChange = true;
7175 }
7176
7177 return MadeChange;
7178 }
7179
7180 // Find loads whose uses only use some of the loaded value's bits. Add an "and"
7181 // just after the load if the target can fold this into one extload instruction,
7182 // with the hope of eliminating some of the other later "and" instructions using
7183 // the loaded value. "and"s that are made trivially redundant by the insertion
7184 // of the new "and" are removed by this function, while others (e.g. those whose
7185 // path from the load goes through a phi) are left for isel to potentially
7186 // remove.
7187 //
7188 // For example:
7189 //
7190 // b0:
7191 // x = load i32
7192 // ...
7193 // b1:
7194 // y = and x, 0xff
7195 // z = use y
7196 //
7197 // becomes:
7198 //
7199 // b0:
7200 // x = load i32
7201 // x' = and x, 0xff
7202 // ...
7203 // b1:
7204 // z = use x'
7205 //
7206 // whereas:
7207 //
7208 // b0:
7209 // x1 = load i32
7210 // ...
7211 // b1:
7212 // x2 = load i32
7213 // ...
7214 // b2:
7215 // x = phi x1, x2
7216 // y = and x, 0xff
7217 //
7218 // becomes (after a call to optimizeLoadExt for each load):
7219 //
7220 // b0:
7221 // x1 = load i32
7222 // x1' = and x1, 0xff
7223 // ...
7224 // b1:
7225 // x2 = load i32
7226 // x2' = and x2, 0xff
7227 // ...
7228 // b2:
7229 // x = phi x1', x2'
7230 // y = and x, 0xff
optimizeLoadExt(LoadInst * Load)7231 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeLoadExt(LoadInst *Load) {
7232 if (!Load->isSimple() || !Load->getType()->isIntOrPtrTy())
7233 return false;
7234
7235 // Skip loads we've already transformed.
7236 if (Load->hasOneUse() &&
7237 InsertedInsts.count(cast<Instruction>(*Load->user_begin())))
7238 return false;
7239
7240 // Look at all uses of Load, looking through phis, to determine how many bits
7241 // of the loaded value are needed.
7242 SmallVector<Instruction *, 8> WorkList;
7243 SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 16> Visited;
7244 SmallVector<Instruction *, 8> AndsToMaybeRemove;
7245 SmallVector<Instruction *, 8> DropFlags;
7246 for (auto *U : Load->users())
7247 WorkList.push_back(cast<Instruction>(U));
7248
7249 EVT LoadResultVT = TLI->getValueType(*DL, Load->getType());
7250 unsigned BitWidth = LoadResultVT.getSizeInBits();
7251 // If the BitWidth is 0, do not try to optimize the type
7252 if (BitWidth == 0)
7253 return false;
7254
7255 APInt DemandBits(BitWidth, 0);
7256 APInt WidestAndBits(BitWidth, 0);
7257
7258 while (!WorkList.empty()) {
7259 Instruction *I = WorkList.pop_back_val();
7260
7261 // Break use-def graph loops.
7262 if (!Visited.insert(I).second)
7263 continue;
7264
7265 // For a PHI node, push all of its users.
7266 if (auto *Phi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I)) {
7267 for (auto *U : Phi->users())
7268 WorkList.push_back(cast<Instruction>(U));
7269 continue;
7270 }
7271
7272 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7273 case Instruction::And: {
7274 auto *AndC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1));
7275 if (!AndC)
7276 return false;
7277 APInt AndBits = AndC->getValue();
7278 DemandBits |= AndBits;
7279 // Keep track of the widest and mask we see.
7280 if (AndBits.ugt(WidestAndBits))
7281 WidestAndBits = AndBits;
7282 if (AndBits == WidestAndBits && I->getOperand(0) == Load)
7283 AndsToMaybeRemove.push_back(I);
7284 break;
7285 }
7286
7287 case Instruction::Shl: {
7288 auto *ShlC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1));
7289 if (!ShlC)
7290 return false;
7291 uint64_t ShiftAmt = ShlC->getLimitedValue(BitWidth - 1);
7292 DemandBits.setLowBits(BitWidth - ShiftAmt);
7293 DropFlags.push_back(I);
7294 break;
7295 }
7296
7297 case Instruction::Trunc: {
7298 EVT TruncVT = TLI->getValueType(*DL, I->getType());
7299 unsigned TruncBitWidth = TruncVT.getSizeInBits();
7300 DemandBits.setLowBits(TruncBitWidth);
7301 DropFlags.push_back(I);
7302 break;
7303 }
7304
7305 default:
7306 return false;
7307 }
7308 }
7309
7310 uint32_t ActiveBits = DemandBits.getActiveBits();
7311 // Avoid hoisting (and (load x) 1) since it is unlikely to be folded by the
7312 // target even if isLoadExtLegal says an i1 EXTLOAD is valid. For example,
7313 // for the AArch64 target isLoadExtLegal(ZEXTLOAD, i32, i1) returns true, but
7314 // (and (load x) 1) is not matched as a single instruction, rather as a LDR
7315 // followed by an AND.
7316 // TODO: Look into removing this restriction by fixing backends to either
7317 // return false for isLoadExtLegal for i1 or have them select this pattern to
7318 // a single instruction.
7319 //
7320 // Also avoid hoisting if we didn't see any ands with the exact DemandBits
7321 // mask, since these are the only ands that will be removed by isel.
7322 if (ActiveBits <= 1 || !DemandBits.isMask(ActiveBits) ||
7323 WidestAndBits != DemandBits)
7324 return false;
7325
7326 LLVMContext &Ctx = Load->getType()->getContext();
7327 Type *TruncTy = Type::getIntNTy(Ctx, ActiveBits);
7328 EVT TruncVT = TLI->getValueType(*DL, TruncTy);
7329
7330 // Reject cases that won't be matched as extloads.
7331 if (!LoadResultVT.bitsGT(TruncVT) || !TruncVT.isRound() ||
7332 !TLI->isLoadExtLegal(ISD::ZEXTLOAD, LoadResultVT, TruncVT))
7333 return false;
7334
7335 IRBuilder<> Builder(Load->getNextNonDebugInstruction());
7336 auto *NewAnd = cast<Instruction>(
7337 Builder.CreateAnd(Load, ConstantInt::get(Ctx, DemandBits)));
7338 // Mark this instruction as "inserted by CGP", so that other
7339 // optimizations don't touch it.
7340 InsertedInsts.insert(NewAnd);
7341
7342 // Replace all uses of load with new and (except for the use of load in the
7343 // new and itself).
7344 replaceAllUsesWith(Load, NewAnd, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
7345 NewAnd->setOperand(0, Load);
7346
7347 // Remove any and instructions that are now redundant.
7348 for (auto *And : AndsToMaybeRemove)
7349 // Check that the and mask is the same as the one we decided to put on the
7350 // new and.
7351 if (cast<ConstantInt>(And->getOperand(1))->getValue() == DemandBits) {
7352 replaceAllUsesWith(And, NewAnd, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
7353 if (&*CurInstIterator == And)
7354 CurInstIterator = std::next(And->getIterator());
7355 And->eraseFromParent();
7356 ++NumAndUses;
7357 }
7358
7359 // NSW flags may not longer hold.
7360 for (auto *Inst : DropFlags)
7361 Inst->setHasNoSignedWrap(false);
7362
7363 ++NumAndsAdded;
7364 return true;
7365 }
7366
7367 /// Check if V (an operand of a select instruction) is an expensive instruction
7368 /// that is only used once.
sinkSelectOperand(const TargetTransformInfo * TTI,Value * V)7369 static bool sinkSelectOperand(const TargetTransformInfo *TTI, Value *V) {
7370 auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
7371 // If it's safe to speculatively execute, then it should not have side
7372 // effects; therefore, it's safe to sink and possibly *not* execute.
7373 return I && I->hasOneUse() && isSafeToSpeculativelyExecute(I) &&
7374 TTI->isExpensiveToSpeculativelyExecute(I);
7375 }
7376
7377 /// Returns true if a SelectInst should be turned into an explicit branch.
isFormingBranchFromSelectProfitable(const TargetTransformInfo * TTI,const TargetLowering * TLI,SelectInst * SI)7378 static bool isFormingBranchFromSelectProfitable(const TargetTransformInfo *TTI,
7379 const TargetLowering *TLI,
7380 SelectInst *SI) {
7381 // If even a predictable select is cheap, then a branch can't be cheaper.
7382 if (!TLI->isPredictableSelectExpensive())
7383 return false;
7384
7385 // FIXME: This should use the same heuristics as IfConversion to determine
7386 // whether a select is better represented as a branch.
7387
7388 // If metadata tells us that the select condition is obviously predictable,
7389 // then we want to replace the select with a branch.
7390 uint64_t TrueWeight, FalseWeight;
7391 if (extractBranchWeights(*SI, TrueWeight, FalseWeight)) {
7392 uint64_t Max = std::max(TrueWeight, FalseWeight);
7393 uint64_t Sum = TrueWeight + FalseWeight;
7394 if (Sum != 0) {
7395 auto Probability = BranchProbability::getBranchProbability(Max, Sum);
7396 if (Probability > TTI->getPredictableBranchThreshold())
7397 return true;
7398 }
7399 }
7400
7401 CmpInst *Cmp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(SI->getCondition());
7402
7403 // If a branch is predictable, an out-of-order CPU can avoid blocking on its
7404 // comparison condition. If the compare has more than one use, there's
7405 // probably another cmov or setcc around, so it's not worth emitting a branch.
7406 if (!Cmp || !Cmp->hasOneUse())
7407 return false;
7408
7409 // If either operand of the select is expensive and only needed on one side
7410 // of the select, we should form a branch.
7411 if (sinkSelectOperand(TTI, SI->getTrueValue()) ||
7412 sinkSelectOperand(TTI, SI->getFalseValue()))
7413 return true;
7414
7415 return false;
7416 }
7417
7418 /// If \p isTrue is true, return the true value of \p SI, otherwise return
7419 /// false value of \p SI. If the true/false value of \p SI is defined by any
7420 /// select instructions in \p Selects, look through the defining select
7421 /// instruction until the true/false value is not defined in \p Selects.
7422 static Value *
getTrueOrFalseValue(SelectInst * SI,bool isTrue,const SmallPtrSet<const Instruction *,2> & Selects)7423 getTrueOrFalseValue(SelectInst *SI, bool isTrue,
7424 const SmallPtrSet<const Instruction *, 2> &Selects) {
7425 Value *V = nullptr;
7426
7427 for (SelectInst *DefSI = SI; DefSI != nullptr && Selects.count(DefSI);
7428 DefSI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(V)) {
7429 assert(DefSI->getCondition() == SI->getCondition() &&
7430 "The condition of DefSI does not match with SI");
7431 V = (isTrue ? DefSI->getTrueValue() : DefSI->getFalseValue());
7432 }
7433
7434 assert(V && "Failed to get select true/false value");
7435 return V;
7436 }
7437
optimizeShiftInst(BinaryOperator * Shift)7438 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeShiftInst(BinaryOperator *Shift) {
7439 assert(Shift->isShift() && "Expected a shift");
7440
7441 // If this is (1) a vector shift, (2) shifts by scalars are cheaper than
7442 // general vector shifts, and (3) the shift amount is a select-of-splatted
7443 // values, hoist the shifts before the select:
7444 // shift Op0, (select Cond, TVal, FVal) -->
7445 // select Cond, (shift Op0, TVal), (shift Op0, FVal)
7446 //
7447 // This is inverting a generic IR transform when we know that the cost of a
7448 // general vector shift is more than the cost of 2 shift-by-scalars.
7449 // We can't do this effectively in SDAG because we may not be able to
7450 // determine if the select operands are splats from within a basic block.
7451 Type *Ty = Shift->getType();
7452 if (!Ty->isVectorTy() || !TTI->isVectorShiftByScalarCheap(Ty))
7453 return false;
7454 Value *Cond, *TVal, *FVal;
7455 if (!match(Shift->getOperand(1),
7456 m_OneUse(m_Select(m_Value(Cond), m_Value(TVal), m_Value(FVal)))))
7457 return false;
7458 if (!isSplatValue(TVal) || !isSplatValue(FVal))
7459 return false;
7460
7461 IRBuilder<> Builder(Shift);
7462 BinaryOperator::BinaryOps Opcode = Shift->getOpcode();
7463 Value *NewTVal = Builder.CreateBinOp(Opcode, Shift->getOperand(0), TVal);
7464 Value *NewFVal = Builder.CreateBinOp(Opcode, Shift->getOperand(0), FVal);
7465 Value *NewSel = Builder.CreateSelect(Cond, NewTVal, NewFVal);
7466 replaceAllUsesWith(Shift, NewSel, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
7467 Shift->eraseFromParent();
7468 return true;
7469 }
7470
optimizeFunnelShift(IntrinsicInst * Fsh)7471 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeFunnelShift(IntrinsicInst *Fsh) {
7472 Intrinsic::ID Opcode = Fsh->getIntrinsicID();
7473 assert((Opcode == Intrinsic::fshl || Opcode == Intrinsic::fshr) &&
7474 "Expected a funnel shift");
7475
7476 // If this is (1) a vector funnel shift, (2) shifts by scalars are cheaper
7477 // than general vector shifts, and (3) the shift amount is select-of-splatted
7478 // values, hoist the funnel shifts before the select:
7479 // fsh Op0, Op1, (select Cond, TVal, FVal) -->
7480 // select Cond, (fsh Op0, Op1, TVal), (fsh Op0, Op1, FVal)
7481 //
7482 // This is inverting a generic IR transform when we know that the cost of a
7483 // general vector shift is more than the cost of 2 shift-by-scalars.
7484 // We can't do this effectively in SDAG because we may not be able to
7485 // determine if the select operands are splats from within a basic block.
7486 Type *Ty = Fsh->getType();
7487 if (!Ty->isVectorTy() || !TTI->isVectorShiftByScalarCheap(Ty))
7488 return false;
7489 Value *Cond, *TVal, *FVal;
7490 if (!match(Fsh->getOperand(2),
7491 m_OneUse(m_Select(m_Value(Cond), m_Value(TVal), m_Value(FVal)))))
7492 return false;
7493 if (!isSplatValue(TVal) || !isSplatValue(FVal))
7494 return false;
7495
7496 IRBuilder<> Builder(Fsh);
7497 Value *X = Fsh->getOperand(0), *Y = Fsh->getOperand(1);
7498 Value *NewTVal = Builder.CreateIntrinsic(Opcode, Ty, {X, Y, TVal});
7499 Value *NewFVal = Builder.CreateIntrinsic(Opcode, Ty, {X, Y, FVal});
7500 Value *NewSel = Builder.CreateSelect(Cond, NewTVal, NewFVal);
7501 replaceAllUsesWith(Fsh, NewSel, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
7502 Fsh->eraseFromParent();
7503 return true;
7504 }
7505
7506 /// If we have a SelectInst that will likely profit from branch prediction,
7507 /// turn it into a branch.
optimizeSelectInst(SelectInst * SI)7508 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeSelectInst(SelectInst *SI) {
7509 if (DisableSelectToBranch)
7510 return false;
7511
7512 // If the SelectOptimize pass is enabled, selects have already been optimized.
7513 if (!getCGPassBuilderOption().DisableSelectOptimize)
7514 return false;
7515
7516 // Find all consecutive select instructions that share the same condition.
7517 SmallVector<SelectInst *, 2> ASI;
7518 ASI.push_back(SI);
7519 for (BasicBlock::iterator It = ++BasicBlock::iterator(SI);
7520 It != SI->getParent()->end(); ++It) {
7521 SelectInst *I = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(&*It);
7522 if (I && SI->getCondition() == I->getCondition()) {
7523 ASI.push_back(I);
7524 } else {
7525 break;
7526 }
7527 }
7528
7529 SelectInst *LastSI = ASI.back();
7530 // Increment the current iterator to skip all the rest of select instructions
7531 // because they will be either "not lowered" or "all lowered" to branch.
7532 CurInstIterator = std::next(LastSI->getIterator());
7533 // Examine debug-info attached to the consecutive select instructions. They
7534 // won't be individually optimised by optimizeInst, so we need to perform
7535 // DbgVariableRecord maintenence here instead.
7536 for (SelectInst *SI : ArrayRef(ASI).drop_front())
7537 fixupDbgVariableRecordsOnInst(*SI);
7538
7539 bool VectorCond = !SI->getCondition()->getType()->isIntegerTy(1);
7540
7541 // Can we convert the 'select' to CF ?
7542 if (VectorCond || SI->getMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_unpredictable))
7543 return false;
7544
7545 TargetLowering::SelectSupportKind SelectKind;
7546 if (SI->getType()->isVectorTy())
7547 SelectKind = TargetLowering::ScalarCondVectorVal;
7548 else
7549 SelectKind = TargetLowering::ScalarValSelect;
7550
7551 if (TLI->isSelectSupported(SelectKind) &&
7552 (!isFormingBranchFromSelectProfitable(TTI, TLI, SI) ||
7553 llvm::shouldOptimizeForSize(SI->getParent(), PSI, BFI.get())))
7554 return false;
7555
7556 // The DominatorTree needs to be rebuilt by any consumers after this
7557 // transformation. We simply reset here rather than setting the ModifiedDT
7558 // flag to avoid restarting the function walk in runOnFunction for each
7559 // select optimized.
7560 DT.reset();
7561
7562 // Transform a sequence like this:
7563 // start:
7564 // %cmp = cmp uge i32 %a, %b
7565 // %sel = select i1 %cmp, i32 %c, i32 %d
7566 //
7567 // Into:
7568 // start:
7569 // %cmp = cmp uge i32 %a, %b
7570 // %cmp.frozen = freeze %cmp
7571 // br i1 %cmp.frozen, label %select.true, label %select.false
7572 // select.true:
7573 // br label %select.end
7574 // select.false:
7575 // br label %select.end
7576 // select.end:
7577 // %sel = phi i32 [ %c, %select.true ], [ %d, %select.false ]
7578 //
7579 // %cmp should be frozen, otherwise it may introduce undefined behavior.
7580 // In addition, we may sink instructions that produce %c or %d from
7581 // the entry block into the destination(s) of the new branch.
7582 // If the true or false blocks do not contain a sunken instruction, that
7583 // block and its branch may be optimized away. In that case, one side of the
7584 // first branch will point directly to select.end, and the corresponding PHI
7585 // predecessor block will be the start block.
7586
7587 // Collect values that go on the true side and the values that go on the false
7588 // side.
7589 SmallVector<Instruction *> TrueInstrs, FalseInstrs;
7590 for (SelectInst *SI : ASI) {
7591 if (Value *V = SI->getTrueValue(); sinkSelectOperand(TTI, V))
7592 TrueInstrs.push_back(cast<Instruction>(V));
7593 if (Value *V = SI->getFalseValue(); sinkSelectOperand(TTI, V))
7594 FalseInstrs.push_back(cast<Instruction>(V));
7595 }
7596
7597 // Split the select block, according to how many (if any) values go on each
7598 // side.
7599 BasicBlock *StartBlock = SI->getParent();
7600 BasicBlock::iterator SplitPt = std::next(BasicBlock::iterator(LastSI));
7601 // We should split before any debug-info.
7602 SplitPt.setHeadBit(true);
7603
7604 IRBuilder<> IB(SI);
7605 auto *CondFr = IB.CreateFreeze(SI->getCondition(), SI->getName() + ".frozen");
7606
7607 BasicBlock *TrueBlock = nullptr;
7608 BasicBlock *FalseBlock = nullptr;
7609 BasicBlock *EndBlock = nullptr;
7610 BranchInst *TrueBranch = nullptr;
7611 BranchInst *FalseBranch = nullptr;
7612 if (TrueInstrs.size() == 0) {
7613 FalseBranch = cast<BranchInst>(SplitBlockAndInsertIfElse(
7614 CondFr, SplitPt, false, nullptr, nullptr, LI));
7615 FalseBlock = FalseBranch->getParent();
7616 EndBlock = cast<BasicBlock>(FalseBranch->getOperand(0));
7617 } else if (FalseInstrs.size() == 0) {
7618 TrueBranch = cast<BranchInst>(SplitBlockAndInsertIfThen(
7619 CondFr, SplitPt, false, nullptr, nullptr, LI));
7620 TrueBlock = TrueBranch->getParent();
7621 EndBlock = cast<BasicBlock>(TrueBranch->getOperand(0));
7622 } else {
7623 Instruction *ThenTerm = nullptr;
7624 Instruction *ElseTerm = nullptr;
7625 SplitBlockAndInsertIfThenElse(CondFr, SplitPt, &ThenTerm, &ElseTerm,
7626 nullptr, nullptr, LI);
7627 TrueBranch = cast<BranchInst>(ThenTerm);
7628 FalseBranch = cast<BranchInst>(ElseTerm);
7629 TrueBlock = TrueBranch->getParent();
7630 FalseBlock = FalseBranch->getParent();
7631 EndBlock = cast<BasicBlock>(TrueBranch->getOperand(0));
7632 }
7633
7634 EndBlock->setName("select.end");
7635 if (TrueBlock)
7636 TrueBlock->setName("select.true.sink");
7637 if (FalseBlock)
7638 FalseBlock->setName(FalseInstrs.size() == 0 ? "select.false"
7639 : "select.false.sink");
7640
7641 if (IsHugeFunc) {
7642 if (TrueBlock)
7643 FreshBBs.insert(TrueBlock);
7644 if (FalseBlock)
7645 FreshBBs.insert(FalseBlock);
7646 FreshBBs.insert(EndBlock);
7647 }
7648
7649 BFI->setBlockFreq(EndBlock, BFI->getBlockFreq(StartBlock));
7650
7651 static const unsigned MD[] = {
7652 LLVMContext::MD_prof, LLVMContext::MD_unpredictable,
7653 LLVMContext::MD_make_implicit, LLVMContext::MD_dbg};
7654 StartBlock->getTerminator()->copyMetadata(*SI, MD);
7655
7656 // Sink expensive instructions into the conditional blocks to avoid executing
7657 // them speculatively.
7658 for (Instruction *I : TrueInstrs)
7659 I->moveBefore(TrueBranch->getIterator());
7660 for (Instruction *I : FalseInstrs)
7661 I->moveBefore(FalseBranch->getIterator());
7662
7663 // If we did not create a new block for one of the 'true' or 'false' paths
7664 // of the condition, it means that side of the branch goes to the end block
7665 // directly and the path originates from the start block from the point of
7666 // view of the new PHI.
7667 if (TrueBlock == nullptr)
7668 TrueBlock = StartBlock;
7669 else if (FalseBlock == nullptr)
7670 FalseBlock = StartBlock;
7671
7672 SmallPtrSet<const Instruction *, 2> INS(llvm::from_range, ASI);
7673 // Use reverse iterator because later select may use the value of the
7674 // earlier select, and we need to propagate value through earlier select
7675 // to get the PHI operand.
7676 for (SelectInst *SI : llvm::reverse(ASI)) {
7677 // The select itself is replaced with a PHI Node.
7678 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(SI->getType(), 2, "");
7679 PN->insertBefore(EndBlock->begin());
7680 PN->takeName(SI);
7681 PN->addIncoming(getTrueOrFalseValue(SI, true, INS), TrueBlock);
7682 PN->addIncoming(getTrueOrFalseValue(SI, false, INS), FalseBlock);
7683 PN->setDebugLoc(SI->getDebugLoc());
7684
7685 replaceAllUsesWith(SI, PN, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
7686 SI->eraseFromParent();
7687 INS.erase(SI);
7688 ++NumSelectsExpanded;
7689 }
7690
7691 // Instruct OptimizeBlock to skip to the next block.
7692 CurInstIterator = StartBlock->end();
7693 return true;
7694 }
7695
7696 /// Some targets only accept certain types for splat inputs. For example a VDUP
7697 /// in MVE takes a GPR (integer) register, and the instruction that incorporate
7698 /// a VDUP (such as a VADD qd, qm, rm) also require a gpr register.
optimizeShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst * SVI)7699 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
7700 // Accept shuf(insertelem(undef/poison, val, 0), undef/poison, <0,0,..>) only
7701 if (!match(SVI, m_Shuffle(m_InsertElt(m_Undef(), m_Value(), m_ZeroInt()),
7702 m_Undef(), m_ZeroMask())))
7703 return false;
7704 Type *NewType = TLI->shouldConvertSplatType(SVI);
7705 if (!NewType)
7706 return false;
7707
7708 auto *SVIVecType = cast<FixedVectorType>(SVI->getType());
7709 assert(!NewType->isVectorTy() && "Expected a scalar type!");
7710 assert(NewType->getScalarSizeInBits() == SVIVecType->getScalarSizeInBits() &&
7711 "Expected a type of the same size!");
7712 auto *NewVecType =
7713 FixedVectorType::get(NewType, SVIVecType->getNumElements());
7714
7715 // Create a bitcast (shuffle (insert (bitcast(..))))
7716 IRBuilder<> Builder(SVI->getContext());
7717 Builder.SetInsertPoint(SVI);
7718 Value *BC1 = Builder.CreateBitCast(
7719 cast<Instruction>(SVI->getOperand(0))->getOperand(1), NewType);
7720 Value *Shuffle = Builder.CreateVectorSplat(NewVecType->getNumElements(), BC1);
7721 Value *BC2 = Builder.CreateBitCast(Shuffle, SVIVecType);
7722
7723 replaceAllUsesWith(SVI, BC2, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
7724 RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(
7725 SVI, TLInfo, nullptr,
7726 [&](Value *V) { removeAllAssertingVHReferences(V); });
7727
7728 // Also hoist the bitcast up to its operand if it they are not in the same
7729 // block.
7730 if (auto *BCI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(BC1))
7731 if (auto *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(BCI->getOperand(0)))
7732 if (BCI->getParent() != Op->getParent() && !isa<PHINode>(Op) &&
7733 !Op->isTerminator() && !Op->isEHPad())
7734 BCI->moveAfter(Op);
7735
7736 return true;
7737 }
7738
tryToSinkFreeOperands(Instruction * I)7739 bool CodeGenPrepare::tryToSinkFreeOperands(Instruction *I) {
7740 // If the operands of I can be folded into a target instruction together with
7741 // I, duplicate and sink them.
7742 SmallVector<Use *, 4> OpsToSink;
7743 if (!TTI->isProfitableToSinkOperands(I, OpsToSink))
7744 return false;
7745
7746 // OpsToSink can contain multiple uses in a use chain (e.g.
7747 // (%u1 with %u1 = shufflevector), (%u2 with %u2 = zext %u1)). The dominating
7748 // uses must come first, so we process the ops in reverse order so as to not
7749 // create invalid IR.
7750 BasicBlock *TargetBB = I->getParent();
7751 bool Changed = false;
7752 SmallVector<Use *, 4> ToReplace;
7753 Instruction *InsertPoint = I;
7754 DenseMap<const Instruction *, unsigned long> InstOrdering;
7755 unsigned long InstNumber = 0;
7756 for (const auto &I : *TargetBB)
7757 InstOrdering[&I] = InstNumber++;
7758
7759 for (Use *U : reverse(OpsToSink)) {
7760 auto *UI = cast<Instruction>(U->get());
7761 if (isa<PHINode>(UI))
7762 continue;
7763 if (UI->getParent() == TargetBB) {
7764 if (InstOrdering[UI] < InstOrdering[InsertPoint])
7765 InsertPoint = UI;
7766 continue;
7767 }
7768 ToReplace.push_back(U);
7769 }
7770
7771 SetVector<Instruction *> MaybeDead;
7772 DenseMap<Instruction *, Instruction *> NewInstructions;
7773 for (Use *U : ToReplace) {
7774 auto *UI = cast<Instruction>(U->get());
7775 Instruction *NI = UI->clone();
7776
7777 if (IsHugeFunc) {
7778 // Now we clone an instruction, its operands' defs may sink to this BB
7779 // now. So we put the operands defs' BBs into FreshBBs to do optimization.
7780 for (Value *Op : NI->operands())
7781 if (auto *OpDef = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op))
7782 FreshBBs.insert(OpDef->getParent());
7783 }
7784
7785 NewInstructions[UI] = NI;
7786 MaybeDead.insert(UI);
7787 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Sinking " << *UI << " to user " << *I << "\n");
7788 NI->insertBefore(InsertPoint->getIterator());
7789 InsertPoint = NI;
7790 InsertedInsts.insert(NI);
7791
7792 // Update the use for the new instruction, making sure that we update the
7793 // sunk instruction uses, if it is part of a chain that has already been
7794 // sunk.
7795 Instruction *OldI = cast<Instruction>(U->getUser());
7796 if (auto It = NewInstructions.find(OldI); It != NewInstructions.end())
7797 It->second->setOperand(U->getOperandNo(), NI);
7798 else
7799 U->set(NI);
7800 Changed = true;
7801 }
7802
7803 // Remove instructions that are dead after sinking.
7804 for (auto *I : MaybeDead) {
7805 if (!I->hasNUsesOrMore(1)) {
7806 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Removing dead instruction: " << *I << "\n");
7807 I->eraseFromParent();
7808 }
7809 }
7810
7811 return Changed;
7812 }
7813
optimizeSwitchType(SwitchInst * SI)7814 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeSwitchType(SwitchInst *SI) {
7815 Value *Cond = SI->getCondition();
7816 Type *OldType = Cond->getType();
7817 LLVMContext &Context = Cond->getContext();
7818 EVT OldVT = TLI->getValueType(*DL, OldType);
7819 MVT RegType = TLI->getPreferredSwitchConditionType(Context, OldVT);
7820 unsigned RegWidth = RegType.getSizeInBits();
7821
7822 if (RegWidth <= cast<IntegerType>(OldType)->getBitWidth())
7823 return false;
7824
7825 // If the register width is greater than the type width, expand the condition
7826 // of the switch instruction and each case constant to the width of the
7827 // register. By widening the type of the switch condition, subsequent
7828 // comparisons (for case comparisons) will not need to be extended to the
7829 // preferred register width, so we will potentially eliminate N-1 extends,
7830 // where N is the number of cases in the switch.
7831 auto *NewType = Type::getIntNTy(Context, RegWidth);
7832
7833 // Extend the switch condition and case constants using the target preferred
7834 // extend unless the switch condition is a function argument with an extend
7835 // attribute. In that case, we can avoid an unnecessary mask/extension by
7836 // matching the argument extension instead.
7837 Instruction::CastOps ExtType = Instruction::ZExt;
7838 // Some targets prefer SExt over ZExt.
7839 if (TLI->isSExtCheaperThanZExt(OldVT, RegType))
7840 ExtType = Instruction::SExt;
7841
7842 if (auto *Arg = dyn_cast<Argument>(Cond)) {
7843 if (Arg->hasSExtAttr())
7844 ExtType = Instruction::SExt;
7845 if (Arg->hasZExtAttr())
7846 ExtType = Instruction::ZExt;
7847 }
7848
7849 auto *ExtInst = CastInst::Create(ExtType, Cond, NewType);
7850 ExtInst->insertBefore(SI->getIterator());
7851 ExtInst->setDebugLoc(SI->getDebugLoc());
7852 SI->setCondition(ExtInst);
7853 for (auto Case : SI->cases()) {
7854 const APInt &NarrowConst = Case.getCaseValue()->getValue();
7855 APInt WideConst = (ExtType == Instruction::ZExt)
7856 ? NarrowConst.zext(RegWidth)
7857 : NarrowConst.sext(RegWidth);
7858 Case.setValue(ConstantInt::get(Context, WideConst));
7859 }
7860
7861 return true;
7862 }
7863
optimizeSwitchPhiConstants(SwitchInst * SI)7864 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeSwitchPhiConstants(SwitchInst *SI) {
7865 // The SCCP optimization tends to produce code like this:
7866 // switch(x) { case 42: phi(42, ...) }
7867 // Materializing the constant for the phi-argument needs instructions; So we
7868 // change the code to:
7869 // switch(x) { case 42: phi(x, ...) }
7870
7871 Value *Condition = SI->getCondition();
7872 // Avoid endless loop in degenerate case.
7873 if (isa<ConstantInt>(*Condition))
7874 return false;
7875
7876 bool Changed = false;
7877 BasicBlock *SwitchBB = SI->getParent();
7878 Type *ConditionType = Condition->getType();
7879
7880 for (const SwitchInst::CaseHandle &Case : SI->cases()) {
7881 ConstantInt *CaseValue = Case.getCaseValue();
7882 BasicBlock *CaseBB = Case.getCaseSuccessor();
7883 // Set to true if we previously checked that `CaseBB` is only reached by
7884 // a single case from this switch.
7885 bool CheckedForSinglePred = false;
7886 for (PHINode &PHI : CaseBB->phis()) {
7887 Type *PHIType = PHI.getType();
7888 // If ZExt is free then we can also catch patterns like this:
7889 // switch((i32)x) { case 42: phi((i64)42, ...); }
7890 // and replace `(i64)42` with `zext i32 %x to i64`.
7891 bool TryZExt =
7892 PHIType->isIntegerTy() &&
7893 PHIType->getIntegerBitWidth() > ConditionType->getIntegerBitWidth() &&
7894 TLI->isZExtFree(ConditionType, PHIType);
7895 if (PHIType == ConditionType || TryZExt) {
7896 // Set to true to skip this case because of multiple preds.
7897 bool SkipCase = false;
7898 Value *Replacement = nullptr;
7899 for (unsigned I = 0, E = PHI.getNumIncomingValues(); I != E; I++) {
7900 Value *PHIValue = PHI.getIncomingValue(I);
7901 if (PHIValue != CaseValue) {
7902 if (!TryZExt)
7903 continue;
7904 ConstantInt *PHIValueInt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(PHIValue);
7905 if (!PHIValueInt ||
7906 PHIValueInt->getValue() !=
7907 CaseValue->getValue().zext(PHIType->getIntegerBitWidth()))
7908 continue;
7909 }
7910 if (PHI.getIncomingBlock(I) != SwitchBB)
7911 continue;
7912 // We cannot optimize if there are multiple case labels jumping to
7913 // this block. This check may get expensive when there are many
7914 // case labels so we test for it last.
7915 if (!CheckedForSinglePred) {
7916 CheckedForSinglePred = true;
7917 if (SI->findCaseDest(CaseBB) == nullptr) {
7918 SkipCase = true;
7919 break;
7920 }
7921 }
7922
7923 if (Replacement == nullptr) {
7924 if (PHIValue == CaseValue) {
7925 Replacement = Condition;
7926 } else {
7927 IRBuilder<> Builder(SI);
7928 Replacement = Builder.CreateZExt(Condition, PHIType);
7929 }
7930 }
7931 PHI.setIncomingValue(I, Replacement);
7932 Changed = true;
7933 }
7934 if (SkipCase)
7935 break;
7936 }
7937 }
7938 }
7939 return Changed;
7940 }
7941
optimizeSwitchInst(SwitchInst * SI)7942 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeSwitchInst(SwitchInst *SI) {
7943 bool Changed = optimizeSwitchType(SI);
7944 Changed |= optimizeSwitchPhiConstants(SI);
7945 return Changed;
7946 }
7947
7948 namespace {
7949
7950 /// Helper class to promote a scalar operation to a vector one.
7951 /// This class is used to move downward extractelement transition.
7952 /// E.g.,
7953 /// a = vector_op <2 x i32>
7954 /// b = extractelement <2 x i32> a, i32 0
7955 /// c = scalar_op b
7956 /// store c
7957 ///
7958 /// =>
7959 /// a = vector_op <2 x i32>
7960 /// c = vector_op a (equivalent to scalar_op on the related lane)
7961 /// * d = extractelement <2 x i32> c, i32 0
7962 /// * store d
7963 /// Assuming both extractelement and store can be combine, we get rid of the
7964 /// transition.
7965 class VectorPromoteHelper {
7966 /// DataLayout associated with the current module.
7967 const DataLayout &DL;
7968
7969 /// Used to perform some checks on the legality of vector operations.
7970 const TargetLowering &TLI;
7971
7972 /// Used to estimated the cost of the promoted chain.
7973 const TargetTransformInfo &TTI;
7974
7975 /// The transition being moved downwards.
7976 Instruction *Transition;
7977
7978 /// The sequence of instructions to be promoted.
7979 SmallVector<Instruction *, 4> InstsToBePromoted;
7980
7981 /// Cost of combining a store and an extract.
7982 unsigned StoreExtractCombineCost;
7983
7984 /// Instruction that will be combined with the transition.
7985 Instruction *CombineInst = nullptr;
7986
7987 /// The instruction that represents the current end of the transition.
7988 /// Since we are faking the promotion until we reach the end of the chain
7989 /// of computation, we need a way to get the current end of the transition.
getEndOfTransition() const7990 Instruction *getEndOfTransition() const {
7991 if (InstsToBePromoted.empty())
7992 return Transition;
7993 return InstsToBePromoted.back();
7994 }
7995
7996 /// Return the index of the original value in the transition.
7997 /// E.g., for "extractelement <2 x i32> c, i32 1" the original value,
7998 /// c, is at index 0.
getTransitionOriginalValueIdx() const7999 unsigned getTransitionOriginalValueIdx() const {
8000 assert(isa<ExtractElementInst>(Transition) &&
8001 "Other kind of transitions are not supported yet");
8002 return 0;
8003 }
8004
8005 /// Return the index of the index in the transition.
8006 /// E.g., for "extractelement <2 x i32> c, i32 0" the index
8007 /// is at index 1.
getTransitionIdx() const8008 unsigned getTransitionIdx() const {
8009 assert(isa<ExtractElementInst>(Transition) &&
8010 "Other kind of transitions are not supported yet");
8011 return 1;
8012 }
8013
8014 /// Get the type of the transition.
8015 /// This is the type of the original value.
8016 /// E.g., for "extractelement <2 x i32> c, i32 1" the type of the
8017 /// transition is <2 x i32>.
getTransitionType() const8018 Type *getTransitionType() const {
8019 return Transition->getOperand(getTransitionOriginalValueIdx())->getType();
8020 }
8021
8022 /// Promote \p ToBePromoted by moving \p Def downward through.
8023 /// I.e., we have the following sequence:
8024 /// Def = Transition <ty1> a to <ty2>
8025 /// b = ToBePromoted <ty2> Def, ...
8026 /// =>
8027 /// b = ToBePromoted <ty1> a, ...
8028 /// Def = Transition <ty1> ToBePromoted to <ty2>
8029 void promoteImpl(Instruction *ToBePromoted);
8030
8031 /// Check whether or not it is profitable to promote all the
8032 /// instructions enqueued to be promoted.
isProfitableToPromote()8033 bool isProfitableToPromote() {
8034 Value *ValIdx = Transition->getOperand(getTransitionOriginalValueIdx());
8035 unsigned Index = isa<ConstantInt>(ValIdx)
8036 ? cast<ConstantInt>(ValIdx)->getZExtValue()
8037 : -1;
8038 Type *PromotedType = getTransitionType();
8039
8040 StoreInst *ST = cast<StoreInst>(CombineInst);
8041 unsigned AS = ST->getPointerAddressSpace();
8042 // Check if this store is supported.
8043 if (!TLI.allowsMisalignedMemoryAccesses(
8044 TLI.getValueType(DL, ST->getValueOperand()->getType()), AS,
8045 ST->getAlign())) {
8046 // If this is not supported, there is no way we can combine
8047 // the extract with the store.
8048 return false;
8049 }
8050
8051 // The scalar chain of computation has to pay for the transition
8052 // scalar to vector.
8053 // The vector chain has to account for the combining cost.
8054 enum TargetTransformInfo::TargetCostKind CostKind =
8055 TargetTransformInfo::TCK_RecipThroughput;
8056 InstructionCost ScalarCost =
8057 TTI.getVectorInstrCost(*Transition, PromotedType, CostKind, Index);
8058 InstructionCost VectorCost = StoreExtractCombineCost;
8059 for (const auto &Inst : InstsToBePromoted) {
8060 // Compute the cost.
8061 // By construction, all instructions being promoted are arithmetic ones.
8062 // Moreover, one argument is a constant that can be viewed as a splat
8063 // constant.
8064 Value *Arg0 = Inst->getOperand(0);
8065 bool IsArg0Constant = isa<UndefValue>(Arg0) || isa<ConstantInt>(Arg0) ||
8066 isa<ConstantFP>(Arg0);
8067 TargetTransformInfo::OperandValueInfo Arg0Info, Arg1Info;
8068 if (IsArg0Constant)
8069 Arg0Info.Kind = TargetTransformInfo::OK_UniformConstantValue;
8070 else
8071 Arg1Info.Kind = TargetTransformInfo::OK_UniformConstantValue;
8072
8073 ScalarCost += TTI.getArithmeticInstrCost(
8074 Inst->getOpcode(), Inst->getType(), CostKind, Arg0Info, Arg1Info);
8075 VectorCost += TTI.getArithmeticInstrCost(Inst->getOpcode(), PromotedType,
8076 CostKind, Arg0Info, Arg1Info);
8077 }
8078 LLVM_DEBUG(
8079 dbgs() << "Estimated cost of computation to be promoted:\nScalar: "
8080 << ScalarCost << "\nVector: " << VectorCost << '\n');
8081 return ScalarCost > VectorCost;
8082 }
8083
8084 /// Generate a constant vector with \p Val with the same
8085 /// number of elements as the transition.
8086 /// \p UseSplat defines whether or not \p Val should be replicated
8087 /// across the whole vector.
8088 /// In other words, if UseSplat == true, we generate <Val, Val, ..., Val>,
8089 /// otherwise we generate a vector with as many poison as possible:
8090 /// <poison, ..., poison, Val, poison, ..., poison> where \p Val is only
8091 /// used at the index of the extract.
getConstantVector(Constant * Val,bool UseSplat) const8092 Value *getConstantVector(Constant *Val, bool UseSplat) const {
8093 unsigned ExtractIdx = std::numeric_limits<unsigned>::max();
8094 if (!UseSplat) {
8095 // If we cannot determine where the constant must be, we have to
8096 // use a splat constant.
8097 Value *ValExtractIdx = Transition->getOperand(getTransitionIdx());
8098 if (ConstantInt *CstVal = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ValExtractIdx))
8099 ExtractIdx = CstVal->getSExtValue();
8100 else
8101 UseSplat = true;
8102 }
8103
8104 ElementCount EC = cast<VectorType>(getTransitionType())->getElementCount();
8105 if (UseSplat)
8106 return ConstantVector::getSplat(EC, Val);
8107
8108 if (!EC.isScalable()) {
8109 SmallVector<Constant *, 4> ConstVec;
8110 PoisonValue *PoisonVal = PoisonValue::get(Val->getType());
8111 for (unsigned Idx = 0; Idx != EC.getKnownMinValue(); ++Idx) {
8112 if (Idx == ExtractIdx)
8113 ConstVec.push_back(Val);
8114 else
8115 ConstVec.push_back(PoisonVal);
8116 }
8117 return ConstantVector::get(ConstVec);
8118 } else
8119 llvm_unreachable(
8120 "Generate scalable vector for non-splat is unimplemented");
8121 }
8122
8123 /// Check if promoting to a vector type an operand at \p OperandIdx
8124 /// in \p Use can trigger undefined behavior.
canCauseUndefinedBehavior(const Instruction * Use,unsigned OperandIdx)8125 static bool canCauseUndefinedBehavior(const Instruction *Use,
8126 unsigned OperandIdx) {
8127 // This is not safe to introduce undef when the operand is on
8128 // the right hand side of a division-like instruction.
8129 if (OperandIdx != 1)
8130 return false;
8131 switch (Use->getOpcode()) {
8132 default:
8133 return false;
8134 case Instruction::SDiv:
8135 case Instruction::UDiv:
8136 case Instruction::SRem:
8137 case Instruction::URem:
8138 return true;
8139 case Instruction::FDiv:
8140 case Instruction::FRem:
8141 return !Use->hasNoNaNs();
8142 }
8143 llvm_unreachable(nullptr);
8144 }
8145
8146 public:
VectorPromoteHelper(const DataLayout & DL,const TargetLowering & TLI,const TargetTransformInfo & TTI,Instruction * Transition,unsigned CombineCost)8147 VectorPromoteHelper(const DataLayout &DL, const TargetLowering &TLI,
8148 const TargetTransformInfo &TTI, Instruction *Transition,
8149 unsigned CombineCost)
8150 : DL(DL), TLI(TLI), TTI(TTI), Transition(Transition),
8151 StoreExtractCombineCost(CombineCost) {
8152 assert(Transition && "Do not know how to promote null");
8153 }
8154
8155 /// Check if we can promote \p ToBePromoted to \p Type.
canPromote(const Instruction * ToBePromoted) const8156 bool canPromote(const Instruction *ToBePromoted) const {
8157 // We could support CastInst too.
8158 return isa<BinaryOperator>(ToBePromoted);
8159 }
8160
8161 /// Check if it is profitable to promote \p ToBePromoted
8162 /// by moving downward the transition through.
shouldPromote(const Instruction * ToBePromoted) const8163 bool shouldPromote(const Instruction *ToBePromoted) const {
8164 // Promote only if all the operands can be statically expanded.
8165 // Indeed, we do not want to introduce any new kind of transitions.
8166 for (const Use &U : ToBePromoted->operands()) {
8167 const Value *Val = U.get();
8168 if (Val == getEndOfTransition()) {
8169 // If the use is a division and the transition is on the rhs,
8170 // we cannot promote the operation, otherwise we may create a
8171 // division by zero.
8172 if (canCauseUndefinedBehavior(ToBePromoted, U.getOperandNo()))
8173 return false;
8174 continue;
8175 }
8176 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Val) && !isa<UndefValue>(Val) &&
8177 !isa<ConstantFP>(Val))
8178 return false;
8179 }
8180 // Check that the resulting operation is legal.
8181 int ISDOpcode = TLI.InstructionOpcodeToISD(ToBePromoted->getOpcode());
8182 if (!ISDOpcode)
8183 return false;
8184 return StressStoreExtract ||
8185 TLI.isOperationLegalOrCustom(
8186 ISDOpcode, TLI.getValueType(DL, getTransitionType(), true));
8187 }
8188
8189 /// Check whether or not \p Use can be combined
8190 /// with the transition.
8191 /// I.e., is it possible to do Use(Transition) => AnotherUse?
canCombine(const Instruction * Use)8192 bool canCombine(const Instruction *Use) { return isa<StoreInst>(Use); }
8193
8194 /// Record \p ToBePromoted as part of the chain to be promoted.
enqueueForPromotion(Instruction * ToBePromoted)8195 void enqueueForPromotion(Instruction *ToBePromoted) {
8196 InstsToBePromoted.push_back(ToBePromoted);
8197 }
8198
8199 /// Set the instruction that will be combined with the transition.
recordCombineInstruction(Instruction * ToBeCombined)8200 void recordCombineInstruction(Instruction *ToBeCombined) {
8201 assert(canCombine(ToBeCombined) && "Unsupported instruction to combine");
8202 CombineInst = ToBeCombined;
8203 }
8204
8205 /// Promote all the instructions enqueued for promotion if it is
8206 /// is profitable.
8207 /// \return True if the promotion happened, false otherwise.
promote()8208 bool promote() {
8209 // Check if there is something to promote.
8210 // Right now, if we do not have anything to combine with,
8211 // we assume the promotion is not profitable.
8212 if (InstsToBePromoted.empty() || !CombineInst)
8213 return false;
8214
8215 // Check cost.
8216 if (!StressStoreExtract && !isProfitableToPromote())
8217 return false;
8218
8219 // Promote.
8220 for (auto &ToBePromoted : InstsToBePromoted)
8221 promoteImpl(ToBePromoted);
8222 InstsToBePromoted.clear();
8223 return true;
8224 }
8225 };
8226
8227 } // end anonymous namespace
8228
promoteImpl(Instruction * ToBePromoted)8229 void VectorPromoteHelper::promoteImpl(Instruction *ToBePromoted) {
8230 // At this point, we know that all the operands of ToBePromoted but Def
8231 // can be statically promoted.
8232 // For Def, we need to use its parameter in ToBePromoted:
8233 // b = ToBePromoted ty1 a
8234 // Def = Transition ty1 b to ty2
8235 // Move the transition down.
8236 // 1. Replace all uses of the promoted operation by the transition.
8237 // = ... b => = ... Def.
8238 assert(ToBePromoted->getType() == Transition->getType() &&
8239 "The type of the result of the transition does not match "
8240 "the final type");
8241 ToBePromoted->replaceAllUsesWith(Transition);
8242 // 2. Update the type of the uses.
8243 // b = ToBePromoted ty2 Def => b = ToBePromoted ty1 Def.
8244 Type *TransitionTy = getTransitionType();
8245 ToBePromoted->mutateType(TransitionTy);
8246 // 3. Update all the operands of the promoted operation with promoted
8247 // operands.
8248 // b = ToBePromoted ty1 Def => b = ToBePromoted ty1 a.
8249 for (Use &U : ToBePromoted->operands()) {
8250 Value *Val = U.get();
8251 Value *NewVal = nullptr;
8252 if (Val == Transition)
8253 NewVal = Transition->getOperand(getTransitionOriginalValueIdx());
8254 else if (isa<UndefValue>(Val) || isa<ConstantInt>(Val) ||
8255 isa<ConstantFP>(Val)) {
8256 // Use a splat constant if it is not safe to use undef.
8257 NewVal = getConstantVector(
8258 cast<Constant>(Val),
8259 isa<UndefValue>(Val) ||
8260 canCauseUndefinedBehavior(ToBePromoted, U.getOperandNo()));
8261 } else
8262 llvm_unreachable("Did you modified shouldPromote and forgot to update "
8263 "this?");
8264 ToBePromoted->setOperand(U.getOperandNo(), NewVal);
8265 }
8266 Transition->moveAfter(ToBePromoted);
8267 Transition->setOperand(getTransitionOriginalValueIdx(), ToBePromoted);
8268 }
8269
8270 /// Some targets can do store(extractelement) with one instruction.
8271 /// Try to push the extractelement towards the stores when the target
8272 /// has this feature and this is profitable.
optimizeExtractElementInst(Instruction * Inst)8273 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeExtractElementInst(Instruction *Inst) {
8274 unsigned CombineCost = std::numeric_limits<unsigned>::max();
8275 if (DisableStoreExtract ||
8276 (!StressStoreExtract &&
8277 !TLI->canCombineStoreAndExtract(Inst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
8278 Inst->getOperand(1), CombineCost)))
8279 return false;
8280
8281 // At this point we know that Inst is a vector to scalar transition.
8282 // Try to move it down the def-use chain, until:
8283 // - We can combine the transition with its single use
8284 // => we got rid of the transition.
8285 // - We escape the current basic block
8286 // => we would need to check that we are moving it at a cheaper place and
8287 // we do not do that for now.
8288 BasicBlock *Parent = Inst->getParent();
8289 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Found an interesting transition: " << *Inst << '\n');
8290 VectorPromoteHelper VPH(*DL, *TLI, *TTI, Inst, CombineCost);
8291 // If the transition has more than one use, assume this is not going to be
8292 // beneficial.
8293 while (Inst->hasOneUse()) {
8294 Instruction *ToBePromoted = cast<Instruction>(*Inst->user_begin());
8295 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Use: " << *ToBePromoted << '\n');
8296
8297 if (ToBePromoted->getParent() != Parent) {
8298 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Instruction to promote is in a different block ("
8299 << ToBePromoted->getParent()->getName()
8300 << ") than the transition (" << Parent->getName()
8301 << ").\n");
8302 return false;
8303 }
8304
8305 if (VPH.canCombine(ToBePromoted)) {
8306 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Assume " << *Inst << '\n'
8307 << "will be combined with: " << *ToBePromoted << '\n');
8308 VPH.recordCombineInstruction(ToBePromoted);
8309 bool Changed = VPH.promote();
8310 NumStoreExtractExposed += Changed;
8311 return Changed;
8312 }
8313
8314 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Try promoting.\n");
8315 if (!VPH.canPromote(ToBePromoted) || !VPH.shouldPromote(ToBePromoted))
8316 return false;
8317
8318 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Promoting is possible... Enqueue for promotion!\n");
8319
8320 VPH.enqueueForPromotion(ToBePromoted);
8321 Inst = ToBePromoted;
8322 }
8323 return false;
8324 }
8325
8326 /// For the instruction sequence of store below, F and I values
8327 /// are bundled together as an i64 value before being stored into memory.
8328 /// Sometimes it is more efficient to generate separate stores for F and I,
8329 /// which can remove the bitwise instructions or sink them to colder places.
8330 ///
8331 /// (store (or (zext (bitcast F to i32) to i64),
8332 /// (shl (zext I to i64), 32)), addr) -->
8333 /// (store F, addr) and (store I, addr+4)
8334 ///
8335 /// Similarly, splitting for other merged store can also be beneficial, like:
8336 /// For pair of {i32, i32}, i64 store --> two i32 stores.
8337 /// For pair of {i32, i16}, i64 store --> two i32 stores.
8338 /// For pair of {i16, i16}, i32 store --> two i16 stores.
8339 /// For pair of {i16, i8}, i32 store --> two i16 stores.
8340 /// For pair of {i8, i8}, i16 store --> two i8 stores.
8341 ///
8342 /// We allow each target to determine specifically which kind of splitting is
8343 /// supported.
8344 ///
8345 /// The store patterns are commonly seen from the simple code snippet below
8346 /// if only std::make_pair(...) is sroa transformed before inlined into hoo.
8347 /// void goo(const std::pair<int, float> &);
8348 /// hoo() {
8349 /// ...
8350 /// goo(std::make_pair(tmp, ftmp));
8351 /// ...
8352 /// }
8353 ///
8354 /// Although we already have similar splitting in DAG Combine, we duplicate
8355 /// it in CodeGenPrepare to catch the case in which pattern is across
8356 /// multiple BBs. The logic in DAG Combine is kept to catch case generated
8357 /// during code expansion.
splitMergedValStore(StoreInst & SI,const DataLayout & DL,const TargetLowering & TLI)8358 static bool splitMergedValStore(StoreInst &SI, const DataLayout &DL,
8359 const TargetLowering &TLI) {
8360 // Handle simple but common cases only.
8361 Type *StoreType = SI.getValueOperand()->getType();
8362
8363 // The code below assumes shifting a value by <number of bits>,
8364 // whereas scalable vectors would have to be shifted by
8365 // <2log(vscale) + number of bits> in order to store the
8366 // low/high parts. Bailing out for now.
8367 if (StoreType->isScalableTy())
8368 return false;
8369
8370 if (!DL.typeSizeEqualsStoreSize(StoreType) ||
8371 DL.getTypeSizeInBits(StoreType) == 0)
8372 return false;
8373
8374 unsigned HalfValBitSize = DL.getTypeSizeInBits(StoreType) / 2;
8375 Type *SplitStoreType = Type::getIntNTy(SI.getContext(), HalfValBitSize);
8376 if (!DL.typeSizeEqualsStoreSize(SplitStoreType))
8377 return false;
8378
8379 // Don't split the store if it is volatile.
8380 if (SI.isVolatile())
8381 return false;
8382
8383 // Match the following patterns:
8384 // (store (or (zext LValue to i64),
8385 // (shl (zext HValue to i64), 32)), HalfValBitSize)
8386 // or
8387 // (store (or (shl (zext HValue to i64), 32)), HalfValBitSize)
8388 // (zext LValue to i64),
8389 // Expect both operands of OR and the first operand of SHL have only
8390 // one use.
8391 Value *LValue, *HValue;
8392 if (!match(SI.getValueOperand(),
8393 m_c_Or(m_OneUse(m_ZExt(m_Value(LValue))),
8394 m_OneUse(m_Shl(m_OneUse(m_ZExt(m_Value(HValue))),
8395 m_SpecificInt(HalfValBitSize))))))
8396 return false;
8397
8398 // Check LValue and HValue are int with size less or equal than 32.
8399 if (!LValue->getType()->isIntegerTy() ||
8400 DL.getTypeSizeInBits(LValue->getType()) > HalfValBitSize ||
8401 !HValue->getType()->isIntegerTy() ||
8402 DL.getTypeSizeInBits(HValue->getType()) > HalfValBitSize)
8403 return false;
8404
8405 // If LValue/HValue is a bitcast instruction, use the EVT before bitcast
8406 // as the input of target query.
8407 auto *LBC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(LValue);
8408 auto *HBC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(HValue);
8409 EVT LowTy = LBC ? EVT::getEVT(LBC->getOperand(0)->getType())
8410 : EVT::getEVT(LValue->getType());
8411 EVT HighTy = HBC ? EVT::getEVT(HBC->getOperand(0)->getType())
8412 : EVT::getEVT(HValue->getType());
8413 if (!ForceSplitStore && !TLI.isMultiStoresCheaperThanBitsMerge(LowTy, HighTy))
8414 return false;
8415
8416 // Start to split store.
8417 IRBuilder<> Builder(SI.getContext());
8418 Builder.SetInsertPoint(&SI);
8419
8420 // If LValue/HValue is a bitcast in another BB, create a new one in current
8421 // BB so it may be merged with the splitted stores by dag combiner.
8422 if (LBC && LBC->getParent() != SI.getParent())
8423 LValue = Builder.CreateBitCast(LBC->getOperand(0), LBC->getType());
8424 if (HBC && HBC->getParent() != SI.getParent())
8425 HValue = Builder.CreateBitCast(HBC->getOperand(0), HBC->getType());
8426
8427 bool IsLE = SI.getDataLayout().isLittleEndian();
8428 auto CreateSplitStore = [&](Value *V, bool Upper) {
8429 V = Builder.CreateZExtOrBitCast(V, SplitStoreType);
8430 Value *Addr = SI.getPointerOperand();
8431 Align Alignment = SI.getAlign();
8432 const bool IsOffsetStore = (IsLE && Upper) || (!IsLE && !Upper);
8433 if (IsOffsetStore) {
8434 Addr = Builder.CreateGEP(
8435 SplitStoreType, Addr,
8436 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(SI.getContext()), 1));
8437
8438 // When splitting the store in half, naturally one half will retain the
8439 // alignment of the original wider store, regardless of whether it was
8440 // over-aligned or not, while the other will require adjustment.
8441 Alignment = commonAlignment(Alignment, HalfValBitSize / 8);
8442 }
8443 Builder.CreateAlignedStore(V, Addr, Alignment);
8444 };
8445
8446 CreateSplitStore(LValue, false);
8447 CreateSplitStore(HValue, true);
8448
8449 // Delete the old store.
8450 SI.eraseFromParent();
8451 return true;
8452 }
8453
8454 // Return true if the GEP has two operands, the first operand is of a sequential
8455 // type, and the second operand is a constant.
GEPSequentialConstIndexed(GetElementPtrInst * GEP)8456 static bool GEPSequentialConstIndexed(GetElementPtrInst *GEP) {
8457 gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*GEP);
8458 return GEP->getNumOperands() == 2 && I.isSequential() &&
8459 isa<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(1));
8460 }
8461
8462 // Try unmerging GEPs to reduce liveness interference (register pressure) across
8463 // IndirectBr edges. Since IndirectBr edges tend to touch on many blocks,
8464 // reducing liveness interference across those edges benefits global register
8465 // allocation. Currently handles only certain cases.
8466 //
8467 // For example, unmerge %GEPI and %UGEPI as below.
8468 //
8469 // ---------- BEFORE ----------
8470 // SrcBlock:
8471 // ...
8472 // %GEPIOp = ...
8473 // ...
8474 // %GEPI = gep %GEPIOp, Idx
8475 // ...
8476 // indirectbr ... [ label %DstB0, label %DstB1, ... label %DstBi ... ]
8477 // (* %GEPI is alive on the indirectbr edges due to other uses ahead)
8478 // (* %GEPIOp is alive on the indirectbr edges only because of it's used by
8479 // %UGEPI)
8480 //
8481 // DstB0: ... (there may be a gep similar to %UGEPI to be unmerged)
8482 // DstB1: ... (there may be a gep similar to %UGEPI to be unmerged)
8483 // ...
8484 //
8485 // DstBi:
8486 // ...
8487 // %UGEPI = gep %GEPIOp, UIdx
8488 // ...
8489 // ---------------------------
8490 //
8491 // ---------- AFTER ----------
8492 // SrcBlock:
8493 // ... (same as above)
8494 // (* %GEPI is still alive on the indirectbr edges)
8495 // (* %GEPIOp is no longer alive on the indirectbr edges as a result of the
8496 // unmerging)
8497 // ...
8498 //
8499 // DstBi:
8500 // ...
8501 // %UGEPI = gep %GEPI, (UIdx-Idx)
8502 // ...
8503 // ---------------------------
8504 //
8505 // The register pressure on the IndirectBr edges is reduced because %GEPIOp is
8506 // no longer alive on them.
8507 //
8508 // We try to unmerge GEPs here in CodGenPrepare, as opposed to limiting merging
8509 // of GEPs in the first place in InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst() so as
8510 // not to disable further simplications and optimizations as a result of GEP
8511 // merging.
8512 //
8513 // Note this unmerging may increase the length of the data flow critical path
8514 // (the path from %GEPIOp to %UGEPI would go through %GEPI), which is a tradeoff
8515 // between the register pressure and the length of data-flow critical
8516 // path. Restricting this to the uncommon IndirectBr case would minimize the
8517 // impact of potentially longer critical path, if any, and the impact on compile
8518 // time.
tryUnmergingGEPsAcrossIndirectBr(GetElementPtrInst * GEPI,const TargetTransformInfo * TTI)8519 static bool tryUnmergingGEPsAcrossIndirectBr(GetElementPtrInst *GEPI,
8520 const TargetTransformInfo *TTI) {
8521 BasicBlock *SrcBlock = GEPI->getParent();
8522 // Check that SrcBlock ends with an IndirectBr. If not, give up. The common
8523 // (non-IndirectBr) cases exit early here.
8524 if (!isa<IndirectBrInst>(SrcBlock->getTerminator()))
8525 return false;
8526 // Check that GEPI is a simple gep with a single constant index.
8527 if (!GEPSequentialConstIndexed(GEPI))
8528 return false;
8529 ConstantInt *GEPIIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(GEPI->getOperand(1));
8530 // Check that GEPI is a cheap one.
8531 if (TTI->getIntImmCost(GEPIIdx->getValue(), GEPIIdx->getType(),
8532 TargetTransformInfo::TCK_SizeAndLatency) >
8533 TargetTransformInfo::TCC_Basic)
8534 return false;
8535 Value *GEPIOp = GEPI->getOperand(0);
8536 // Check that GEPIOp is an instruction that's also defined in SrcBlock.
8537 if (!isa<Instruction>(GEPIOp))
8538 return false;
8539 auto *GEPIOpI = cast<Instruction>(GEPIOp);
8540 if (GEPIOpI->getParent() != SrcBlock)
8541 return false;
8542 // Check that GEP is used outside the block, meaning it's alive on the
8543 // IndirectBr edge(s).
8544 if (llvm::none_of(GEPI->users(), [&](User *Usr) {
8545 if (auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Usr)) {
8546 if (I->getParent() != SrcBlock) {
8547 return true;
8548 }
8549 }
8550 return false;
8551 }))
8552 return false;
8553 // The second elements of the GEP chains to be unmerged.
8554 std::vector<GetElementPtrInst *> UGEPIs;
8555 // Check each user of GEPIOp to check if unmerging would make GEPIOp not alive
8556 // on IndirectBr edges.
8557 for (User *Usr : GEPIOp->users()) {
8558 if (Usr == GEPI)
8559 continue;
8560 // Check if Usr is an Instruction. If not, give up.
8561 if (!isa<Instruction>(Usr))
8562 return false;
8563 auto *UI = cast<Instruction>(Usr);
8564 // Check if Usr in the same block as GEPIOp, which is fine, skip.
8565 if (UI->getParent() == SrcBlock)
8566 continue;
8567 // Check if Usr is a GEP. If not, give up.
8568 if (!isa<GetElementPtrInst>(Usr))
8569 return false;
8570 auto *UGEPI = cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Usr);
8571 // Check if UGEPI is a simple gep with a single constant index and GEPIOp is
8572 // the pointer operand to it. If so, record it in the vector. If not, give
8573 // up.
8574 if (!GEPSequentialConstIndexed(UGEPI))
8575 return false;
8576 if (UGEPI->getOperand(0) != GEPIOp)
8577 return false;
8578 if (UGEPI->getSourceElementType() != GEPI->getSourceElementType())
8579 return false;
8580 if (GEPIIdx->getType() !=
8581 cast<ConstantInt>(UGEPI->getOperand(1))->getType())
8582 return false;
8583 ConstantInt *UGEPIIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(UGEPI->getOperand(1));
8584 if (TTI->getIntImmCost(UGEPIIdx->getValue(), UGEPIIdx->getType(),
8585 TargetTransformInfo::TCK_SizeAndLatency) >
8586 TargetTransformInfo::TCC_Basic)
8587 return false;
8588 UGEPIs.push_back(UGEPI);
8589 }
8590 if (UGEPIs.size() == 0)
8591 return false;
8592 // Check the materializing cost of (Uidx-Idx).
8593 for (GetElementPtrInst *UGEPI : UGEPIs) {
8594 ConstantInt *UGEPIIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(UGEPI->getOperand(1));
8595 APInt NewIdx = UGEPIIdx->getValue() - GEPIIdx->getValue();
8596 InstructionCost ImmCost = TTI->getIntImmCost(
8597 NewIdx, GEPIIdx->getType(), TargetTransformInfo::TCK_SizeAndLatency);
8598 if (ImmCost > TargetTransformInfo::TCC_Basic)
8599 return false;
8600 }
8601 // Now unmerge between GEPI and UGEPIs.
8602 for (GetElementPtrInst *UGEPI : UGEPIs) {
8603 UGEPI->setOperand(0, GEPI);
8604 ConstantInt *UGEPIIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(UGEPI->getOperand(1));
8605 Constant *NewUGEPIIdx = ConstantInt::get(
8606 GEPIIdx->getType(), UGEPIIdx->getValue() - GEPIIdx->getValue());
8607 UGEPI->setOperand(1, NewUGEPIIdx);
8608 // If GEPI is not inbounds but UGEPI is inbounds, change UGEPI to not
8609 // inbounds to avoid UB.
8610 if (!GEPI->isInBounds()) {
8611 UGEPI->setIsInBounds(false);
8612 }
8613 }
8614 // After unmerging, verify that GEPIOp is actually only used in SrcBlock (not
8615 // alive on IndirectBr edges).
8616 assert(llvm::none_of(GEPIOp->users(),
8617 [&](User *Usr) {
8618 return cast<Instruction>(Usr)->getParent() != SrcBlock;
8619 }) &&
8620 "GEPIOp is used outside SrcBlock");
8621 return true;
8622 }
8623
optimizeBranch(BranchInst * Branch,const TargetLowering & TLI,SmallSet<BasicBlock *,32> & FreshBBs,bool IsHugeFunc)8624 static bool optimizeBranch(BranchInst *Branch, const TargetLowering &TLI,
8625 SmallSet<BasicBlock *, 32> &FreshBBs,
8626 bool IsHugeFunc) {
8627 // Try and convert
8628 // %c = icmp ult %x, 8
8629 // br %c, bla, blb
8630 // %tc = lshr %x, 3
8631 // to
8632 // %tc = lshr %x, 3
8633 // %c = icmp eq %tc, 0
8634 // br %c, bla, blb
8635 // Creating the cmp to zero can be better for the backend, especially if the
8636 // lshr produces flags that can be used automatically.
8637 if (!TLI.preferZeroCompareBranch() || !Branch->isConditional())
8638 return false;
8639
8640 ICmpInst *Cmp = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Branch->getCondition());
8641 if (!Cmp || !isa<ConstantInt>(Cmp->getOperand(1)) || !Cmp->hasOneUse())
8642 return false;
8643
8644 Value *X = Cmp->getOperand(0);
8645 if (!X->hasUseList())
8646 return false;
8647
8648 APInt CmpC = cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp->getOperand(1))->getValue();
8649
8650 for (auto *U : X->users()) {
8651 Instruction *UI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(U);
8652 // A quick dominance check
8653 if (!UI ||
8654 (UI->getParent() != Branch->getParent() &&
8655 UI->getParent() != Branch->getSuccessor(0) &&
8656 UI->getParent() != Branch->getSuccessor(1)) ||
8657 (UI->getParent() != Branch->getParent() &&
8658 !UI->getParent()->getSinglePredecessor()))
8659 continue;
8660
8661 if (CmpC.isPowerOf2() && Cmp->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
8662 match(UI, m_Shr(m_Specific(X), m_SpecificInt(CmpC.logBase2())))) {
8663 IRBuilder<> Builder(Branch);
8664 if (UI->getParent() != Branch->getParent())
8665 UI->moveBefore(Branch->getIterator());
8666 UI->dropPoisonGeneratingFlags();
8667 Value *NewCmp = Builder.CreateCmp(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, UI,
8668 ConstantInt::get(UI->getType(), 0));
8669 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Converting " << *Cmp << "\n");
8670 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << " to compare on zero: " << *NewCmp << "\n");
8671 replaceAllUsesWith(Cmp, NewCmp, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
8672 return true;
8673 }
8674 if (Cmp->isEquality() &&
8675 (match(UI, m_Add(m_Specific(X), m_SpecificInt(-CmpC))) ||
8676 match(UI, m_Sub(m_Specific(X), m_SpecificInt(CmpC))) ||
8677 match(UI, m_Xor(m_Specific(X), m_SpecificInt(CmpC))))) {
8678 IRBuilder<> Builder(Branch);
8679 if (UI->getParent() != Branch->getParent())
8680 UI->moveBefore(Branch->getIterator());
8681 UI->dropPoisonGeneratingFlags();
8682 Value *NewCmp = Builder.CreateCmp(Cmp->getPredicate(), UI,
8683 ConstantInt::get(UI->getType(), 0));
8684 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Converting " << *Cmp << "\n");
8685 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << " to compare on zero: " << *NewCmp << "\n");
8686 replaceAllUsesWith(Cmp, NewCmp, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
8687 return true;
8688 }
8689 }
8690 return false;
8691 }
8692
optimizeInst(Instruction * I,ModifyDT & ModifiedDT)8693 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeInst(Instruction *I, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT) {
8694 bool AnyChange = false;
8695 AnyChange = fixupDbgVariableRecordsOnInst(*I);
8696
8697 // Bail out if we inserted the instruction to prevent optimizations from
8698 // stepping on each other's toes.
8699 if (InsertedInsts.count(I))
8700 return AnyChange;
8701
8702 // TODO: Move into the switch on opcode below here.
8703 if (PHINode *P = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I)) {
8704 // It is possible for very late stage optimizations (such as SimplifyCFG)
8705 // to introduce PHI nodes too late to be cleaned up. If we detect such a
8706 // trivial PHI, go ahead and zap it here.
8707 if (Value *V = simplifyInstruction(P, {*DL, TLInfo})) {
8708 LargeOffsetGEPMap.erase(P);
8709 replaceAllUsesWith(P, V, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
8710 P->eraseFromParent();
8711 ++NumPHIsElim;
8712 return true;
8713 }
8714 return AnyChange;
8715 }
8716
8717 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(I)) {
8718 // If the source of the cast is a constant, then this should have
8719 // already been constant folded. The only reason NOT to constant fold
8720 // it is if something (e.g. LSR) was careful to place the constant
8721 // evaluation in a block other than then one that uses it (e.g. to hoist
8722 // the address of globals out of a loop). If this is the case, we don't
8723 // want to forward-subst the cast.
8724 if (isa<Constant>(CI->getOperand(0)))
8725 return AnyChange;
8726
8727 if (OptimizeNoopCopyExpression(CI, *TLI, *DL))
8728 return true;
8729
8730 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(I) || isa<SIToFPInst>(I) || isa<FPToUIInst>(I) ||
8731 isa<TruncInst>(I)) &&
8732 TLI->optimizeExtendOrTruncateConversion(
8733 I, LI->getLoopFor(I->getParent()), *TTI))
8734 return true;
8735
8736 if (isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
8737 /// Sink a zext or sext into its user blocks if the target type doesn't
8738 /// fit in one register
8739 if (TLI->getTypeAction(CI->getContext(),
8740 TLI->getValueType(*DL, CI->getType())) ==
8741 TargetLowering::TypeExpandInteger) {
8742 return SinkCast(CI);
8743 } else {
8744 if (TLI->optimizeExtendOrTruncateConversion(
8745 I, LI->getLoopFor(I->getParent()), *TTI))
8746 return true;
8747
8748 bool MadeChange = optimizeExt(I);
8749 return MadeChange | optimizeExtUses(I);
8750 }
8751 }
8752 return AnyChange;
8753 }
8754
8755 if (auto *Cmp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
8756 if (optimizeCmp(Cmp, ModifiedDT))
8757 return true;
8758
8759 if (match(I, m_URem(m_Value(), m_Value())))
8760 if (optimizeURem(I))
8761 return true;
8762
8763 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
8764 LI->setMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_invariant_group, nullptr);
8765 bool Modified = optimizeLoadExt(LI);
8766 unsigned AS = LI->getPointerAddressSpace();
8767 Modified |= optimizeMemoryInst(I, I->getOperand(0), LI->getType(), AS);
8768 return Modified;
8769 }
8770
8771 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(I)) {
8772 if (splitMergedValStore(*SI, *DL, *TLI))
8773 return true;
8774 SI->setMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_invariant_group, nullptr);
8775 unsigned AS = SI->getPointerAddressSpace();
8776 return optimizeMemoryInst(I, SI->getOperand(1),
8777 SI->getOperand(0)->getType(), AS);
8778 }
8779
8780 if (AtomicRMWInst *RMW = dyn_cast<AtomicRMWInst>(I)) {
8781 unsigned AS = RMW->getPointerAddressSpace();
8782 return optimizeMemoryInst(I, RMW->getPointerOperand(), RMW->getType(), AS);
8783 }
8784
8785 if (AtomicCmpXchgInst *CmpX = dyn_cast<AtomicCmpXchgInst>(I)) {
8786 unsigned AS = CmpX->getPointerAddressSpace();
8787 return optimizeMemoryInst(I, CmpX->getPointerOperand(),
8788 CmpX->getCompareOperand()->getType(), AS);
8789 }
8790
8791 BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I);
8792
8793 if (BinOp && BinOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && EnableAndCmpSinking &&
8794 sinkAndCmp0Expression(BinOp, *TLI, InsertedInsts))
8795 return true;
8796
8797 // TODO: Move this into the switch on opcode - it handles shifts already.
8798 if (BinOp && (BinOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr ||
8799 BinOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)) {
8800 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BinOp->getOperand(1));
8801 if (CI && TLI->hasExtractBitsInsn())
8802 if (OptimizeExtractBits(BinOp, CI, *TLI, *DL))
8803 return true;
8804 }
8805
8806 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(I)) {
8807 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
8808 /// The GEP operand must be a pointer, so must its result -> BitCast
8809 Instruction *NC = new BitCastInst(GEPI->getOperand(0), GEPI->getType(),
8810 GEPI->getName(), GEPI->getIterator());
8811 NC->setDebugLoc(GEPI->getDebugLoc());
8812 replaceAllUsesWith(GEPI, NC, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
8813 RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(
8814 GEPI, TLInfo, nullptr,
8815 [&](Value *V) { removeAllAssertingVHReferences(V); });
8816 ++NumGEPsElim;
8817 optimizeInst(NC, ModifiedDT);
8818 return true;
8819 }
8820 if (tryUnmergingGEPsAcrossIndirectBr(GEPI, TTI)) {
8821 return true;
8822 }
8823 }
8824
8825 if (FreezeInst *FI = dyn_cast<FreezeInst>(I)) {
8826 // freeze(icmp a, const)) -> icmp (freeze a), const
8827 // This helps generate efficient conditional jumps.
8828 Instruction *CmpI = nullptr;
8829 if (ICmpInst *II = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(FI->getOperand(0)))
8830 CmpI = II;
8831 else if (FCmpInst *F = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(FI->getOperand(0)))
8832 CmpI = F->getFastMathFlags().none() ? F : nullptr;
8833
8834 if (CmpI && CmpI->hasOneUse()) {
8835 auto Op0 = CmpI->getOperand(0), Op1 = CmpI->getOperand(1);
8836 bool Const0 = isa<ConstantInt>(Op0) || isa<ConstantFP>(Op0) ||
8837 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0);
8838 bool Const1 = isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<ConstantFP>(Op1) ||
8839 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1);
8840 if (Const0 || Const1) {
8841 if (!Const0 || !Const1) {
8842 auto *F = new FreezeInst(Const0 ? Op1 : Op0, "", CmpI->getIterator());
8843 F->takeName(FI);
8844 CmpI->setOperand(Const0 ? 1 : 0, F);
8845 }
8846 replaceAllUsesWith(FI, CmpI, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
8847 FI->eraseFromParent();
8848 return true;
8849 }
8850 }
8851 return AnyChange;
8852 }
8853
8854 if (tryToSinkFreeOperands(I))
8855 return true;
8856
8857 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8858 case Instruction::Shl:
8859 case Instruction::LShr:
8860 case Instruction::AShr:
8861 return optimizeShiftInst(cast<BinaryOperator>(I));
8862 case Instruction::Call:
8863 return optimizeCallInst(cast<CallInst>(I), ModifiedDT);
8864 case Instruction::Select:
8865 return optimizeSelectInst(cast<SelectInst>(I));
8866 case Instruction::ShuffleVector:
8867 return optimizeShuffleVectorInst(cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I));
8868 case Instruction::Switch:
8869 return optimizeSwitchInst(cast<SwitchInst>(I));
8870 case Instruction::ExtractElement:
8871 return optimizeExtractElementInst(cast<ExtractElementInst>(I));
8872 case Instruction::Br:
8873 return optimizeBranch(cast<BranchInst>(I), *TLI, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
8874 }
8875
8876 return AnyChange;
8877 }
8878
8879 /// Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bitreverse
8880 /// idiom. If so, insert the new intrinsic and return true.
makeBitReverse(Instruction & I)8881 bool CodeGenPrepare::makeBitReverse(Instruction &I) {
8882 if (!I.getType()->isIntegerTy() ||
8883 !TLI->isOperationLegalOrCustom(ISD::BITREVERSE,
8884 TLI->getValueType(*DL, I.getType(), true)))
8885 return false;
8886
8887 SmallVector<Instruction *, 4> Insts;
8888 if (!recognizeBSwapOrBitReverseIdiom(&I, false, true, Insts))
8889 return false;
8890 Instruction *LastInst = Insts.back();
8891 replaceAllUsesWith(&I, LastInst, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
8892 RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(
8893 &I, TLInfo, nullptr,
8894 [&](Value *V) { removeAllAssertingVHReferences(V); });
8895 return true;
8896 }
8897
8898 // In this pass we look for GEP and cast instructions that are used
8899 // across basic blocks and rewrite them to improve basic-block-at-a-time
8900 // selection.
optimizeBlock(BasicBlock & BB,ModifyDT & ModifiedDT)8901 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeBlock(BasicBlock &BB, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT) {
8902 SunkAddrs.clear();
8903 bool MadeChange = false;
8904
8905 do {
8906 CurInstIterator = BB.begin();
8907 ModifiedDT = ModifyDT::NotModifyDT;
8908 while (CurInstIterator != BB.end()) {
8909 MadeChange |= optimizeInst(&*CurInstIterator++, ModifiedDT);
8910 if (ModifiedDT != ModifyDT::NotModifyDT) {
8911 // For huge function we tend to quickly go though the inner optmization
8912 // opportunities in the BB. So we go back to the BB head to re-optimize
8913 // each instruction instead of go back to the function head.
8914 if (IsHugeFunc) {
8915 DT.reset();
8916 getDT(*BB.getParent());
8917 break;
8918 } else {
8919 return true;
8920 }
8921 }
8922 }
8923 } while (ModifiedDT == ModifyDT::ModifyInstDT);
8924
8925 bool MadeBitReverse = true;
8926 while (MadeBitReverse) {
8927 MadeBitReverse = false;
8928 for (auto &I : reverse(BB)) {
8929 if (makeBitReverse(I)) {
8930 MadeBitReverse = MadeChange = true;
8931 break;
8932 }
8933 }
8934 }
8935 MadeChange |= dupRetToEnableTailCallOpts(&BB, ModifiedDT);
8936
8937 return MadeChange;
8938 }
8939
8940 // Some CGP optimizations may move or alter what's computed in a block. Check
8941 // whether a dbg.value intrinsic could be pointed at a more appropriate operand.
fixupDbgValue(Instruction * I)8942 bool CodeGenPrepare::fixupDbgValue(Instruction *I) {
8943 assert(isa<DbgValueInst>(I));
8944 DbgValueInst &DVI = *cast<DbgValueInst>(I);
8945
8946 // Does this dbg.value refer to a sunk address calculation?
8947 bool AnyChange = false;
8948 SmallDenseSet<Value *> LocationOps(DVI.location_ops().begin(),
8949 DVI.location_ops().end());
8950 for (Value *Location : LocationOps) {
8951 WeakTrackingVH SunkAddrVH = SunkAddrs[Location];
8952 Value *SunkAddr = SunkAddrVH.pointsToAliveValue() ? SunkAddrVH : nullptr;
8953 if (SunkAddr) {
8954 // Point dbg.value at locally computed address, which should give the best
8955 // opportunity to be accurately lowered. This update may change the type
8956 // of pointer being referred to; however this makes no difference to
8957 // debugging information, and we can't generate bitcasts that may affect
8958 // codegen.
8959 DVI.replaceVariableLocationOp(Location, SunkAddr);
8960 AnyChange = true;
8961 }
8962 }
8963 return AnyChange;
8964 }
8965
fixupDbgVariableRecordsOnInst(Instruction & I)8966 bool CodeGenPrepare::fixupDbgVariableRecordsOnInst(Instruction &I) {
8967 bool AnyChange = false;
8968 for (DbgVariableRecord &DVR : filterDbgVars(I.getDbgRecordRange()))
8969 AnyChange |= fixupDbgVariableRecord(DVR);
8970 return AnyChange;
8971 }
8972
8973 // FIXME: should updating debug-info really cause the "changed" flag to fire,
8974 // which can cause a function to be reprocessed?
fixupDbgVariableRecord(DbgVariableRecord & DVR)8975 bool CodeGenPrepare::fixupDbgVariableRecord(DbgVariableRecord &DVR) {
8976 if (DVR.Type != DbgVariableRecord::LocationType::Value &&
8977 DVR.Type != DbgVariableRecord::LocationType::Assign)
8978 return false;
8979
8980 // Does this DbgVariableRecord refer to a sunk address calculation?
8981 bool AnyChange = false;
8982 SmallDenseSet<Value *> LocationOps(DVR.location_ops().begin(),
8983 DVR.location_ops().end());
8984 for (Value *Location : LocationOps) {
8985 WeakTrackingVH SunkAddrVH = SunkAddrs[Location];
8986 Value *SunkAddr = SunkAddrVH.pointsToAliveValue() ? SunkAddrVH : nullptr;
8987 if (SunkAddr) {
8988 // Point dbg.value at locally computed address, which should give the best
8989 // opportunity to be accurately lowered. This update may change the type
8990 // of pointer being referred to; however this makes no difference to
8991 // debugging information, and we can't generate bitcasts that may affect
8992 // codegen.
8993 DVR.replaceVariableLocationOp(Location, SunkAddr);
8994 AnyChange = true;
8995 }
8996 }
8997 return AnyChange;
8998 }
8999
DbgInserterHelper(DbgValueInst * DVI,BasicBlock::iterator VI)9000 static void DbgInserterHelper(DbgValueInst *DVI, BasicBlock::iterator VI) {
9001 DVI->removeFromParent();
9002 if (isa<PHINode>(VI))
9003 DVI->insertBefore(VI->getParent()->getFirstInsertionPt());
9004 else
9005 DVI->insertAfter(VI);
9006 }
9007
DbgInserterHelper(DbgVariableRecord * DVR,BasicBlock::iterator VI)9008 static void DbgInserterHelper(DbgVariableRecord *DVR, BasicBlock::iterator VI) {
9009 DVR->removeFromParent();
9010 BasicBlock *VIBB = VI->getParent();
9011 if (isa<PHINode>(VI))
9012 VIBB->insertDbgRecordBefore(DVR, VIBB->getFirstInsertionPt());
9013 else
9014 VIBB->insertDbgRecordAfter(DVR, &*VI);
9015 }
9016
9017 // A llvm.dbg.value may be using a value before its definition, due to
9018 // optimizations in this pass and others. Scan for such dbg.values, and rescue
9019 // them by moving the dbg.value to immediately after the value definition.
9020 // FIXME: Ideally this should never be necessary, and this has the potential
9021 // to re-order dbg.value intrinsics.
placeDbgValues(Function & F)9022 bool CodeGenPrepare::placeDbgValues(Function &F) {
9023 bool MadeChange = false;
9024 DominatorTree DT(F);
9025
9026 auto DbgProcessor = [&](auto *DbgItem, Instruction *Position) {
9027 SmallVector<Instruction *, 4> VIs;
9028 for (Value *V : DbgItem->location_ops())
9029 if (Instruction *VI = dyn_cast_or_null<Instruction>(V))
9030 VIs.push_back(VI);
9031
9032 // This item may depend on multiple instructions, complicating any
9033 // potential sink. This block takes the defensive approach, opting to
9034 // "undef" the item if it has more than one instruction and any of them do
9035 // not dominate iem.
9036 for (Instruction *VI : VIs) {
9037 if (VI->isTerminator())
9038 continue;
9039
9040 // If VI is a phi in a block with an EHPad terminator, we can't insert
9041 // after it.
9042 if (isa<PHINode>(VI) && VI->getParent()->getTerminator()->isEHPad())
9043 continue;
9044
9045 // If the defining instruction dominates the dbg.value, we do not need
9046 // to move the dbg.value.
9047 if (DT.dominates(VI, Position))
9048 continue;
9049
9050 // If we depend on multiple instructions and any of them doesn't
9051 // dominate this DVI, we probably can't salvage it: moving it to
9052 // after any of the instructions could cause us to lose the others.
9053 if (VIs.size() > 1) {
9054 LLVM_DEBUG(
9055 dbgs()
9056 << "Unable to find valid location for Debug Value, undefing:\n"
9057 << *DbgItem);
9058 DbgItem->setKillLocation();
9059 break;
9060 }
9061
9062 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Moving Debug Value before :\n"
9063 << *DbgItem << ' ' << *VI);
9064 DbgInserterHelper(DbgItem, VI->getIterator());
9065 MadeChange = true;
9066 ++NumDbgValueMoved;
9067 }
9068 };
9069
9070 for (BasicBlock &BB : F) {
9071 for (Instruction &Insn : llvm::make_early_inc_range(BB)) {
9072 // Process dbg.value intrinsics.
9073 DbgValueInst *DVI = dyn_cast<DbgValueInst>(&Insn);
9074 if (DVI) {
9075 DbgProcessor(DVI, DVI);
9076 continue;
9077 }
9078
9079 // If this isn't a dbg.value, process any attached DbgVariableRecord
9080 // records attached to this instruction.
9081 for (DbgVariableRecord &DVR : llvm::make_early_inc_range(
9082 filterDbgVars(Insn.getDbgRecordRange()))) {
9083 if (DVR.Type != DbgVariableRecord::LocationType::Value)
9084 continue;
9085 DbgProcessor(&DVR, &Insn);
9086 }
9087 }
9088 }
9089
9090 return MadeChange;
9091 }
9092
9093 // Group scattered pseudo probes in a block to favor SelectionDAG. Scattered
9094 // probes can be chained dependencies of other regular DAG nodes and block DAG
9095 // combine optimizations.
placePseudoProbes(Function & F)9096 bool CodeGenPrepare::placePseudoProbes(Function &F) {
9097 bool MadeChange = false;
9098 for (auto &Block : F) {
9099 // Move the rest probes to the beginning of the block.
9100 auto FirstInst = Block.getFirstInsertionPt();
9101 while (FirstInst != Block.end() && FirstInst->isDebugOrPseudoInst())
9102 ++FirstInst;
9103 BasicBlock::iterator I(FirstInst);
9104 I++;
9105 while (I != Block.end()) {
9106 if (auto *II = dyn_cast<PseudoProbeInst>(I++)) {
9107 II->moveBefore(FirstInst);
9108 MadeChange = true;
9109 }
9110 }
9111 }
9112 return MadeChange;
9113 }
9114
9115 /// Scale down both weights to fit into uint32_t.
scaleWeights(uint64_t & NewTrue,uint64_t & NewFalse)9116 static void scaleWeights(uint64_t &NewTrue, uint64_t &NewFalse) {
9117 uint64_t NewMax = (NewTrue > NewFalse) ? NewTrue : NewFalse;
9118 uint32_t Scale = (NewMax / std::numeric_limits<uint32_t>::max()) + 1;
9119 NewTrue = NewTrue / Scale;
9120 NewFalse = NewFalse / Scale;
9121 }
9122
9123 /// Some targets prefer to split a conditional branch like:
9124 /// \code
9125 /// %0 = icmp ne i32 %a, 0
9126 /// %1 = icmp ne i32 %b, 0
9127 /// %or.cond = or i1 %0, %1
9128 /// br i1 %or.cond, label %TrueBB, label %FalseBB
9129 /// \endcode
9130 /// into multiple branch instructions like:
9131 /// \code
9132 /// bb1:
9133 /// %0 = icmp ne i32 %a, 0
9134 /// br i1 %0, label %TrueBB, label %bb2
9135 /// bb2:
9136 /// %1 = icmp ne i32 %b, 0
9137 /// br i1 %1, label %TrueBB, label %FalseBB
9138 /// \endcode
9139 /// This usually allows instruction selection to do even further optimizations
9140 /// and combine the compare with the branch instruction. Currently this is
9141 /// applied for targets which have "cheap" jump instructions.
9142 ///
9143 /// FIXME: Remove the (equivalent?) implementation in SelectionDAG.
9144 ///
splitBranchCondition(Function & F,ModifyDT & ModifiedDT)9145 bool CodeGenPrepare::splitBranchCondition(Function &F, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT) {
9146 if (!TM->Options.EnableFastISel || TLI->isJumpExpensive())
9147 return false;
9148
9149 bool MadeChange = false;
9150 for (auto &BB : F) {
9151 // Does this BB end with the following?
9152 // %cond1 = icmp|fcmp|binary instruction ...
9153 // %cond2 = icmp|fcmp|binary instruction ...
9154 // %cond.or = or|and i1 %cond1, cond2
9155 // br i1 %cond.or label %dest1, label %dest2"
9156 Instruction *LogicOp;
9157 BasicBlock *TBB, *FBB;
9158 if (!match(BB.getTerminator(),
9159 m_Br(m_OneUse(m_Instruction(LogicOp)), TBB, FBB)))
9160 continue;
9161
9162 auto *Br1 = cast<BranchInst>(BB.getTerminator());
9163 if (Br1->getMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_unpredictable))
9164 continue;
9165
9166 // The merging of mostly empty BB can cause a degenerate branch.
9167 if (TBB == FBB)
9168 continue;
9169
9170 unsigned Opc;
9171 Value *Cond1, *Cond2;
9172 if (match(LogicOp,
9173 m_LogicalAnd(m_OneUse(m_Value(Cond1)), m_OneUse(m_Value(Cond2)))))
9174 Opc = Instruction::And;
9175 else if (match(LogicOp, m_LogicalOr(m_OneUse(m_Value(Cond1)),
9176 m_OneUse(m_Value(Cond2)))))
9177 Opc = Instruction::Or;
9178 else
9179 continue;
9180
9181 auto IsGoodCond = [](Value *Cond) {
9182 return match(
9183 Cond,
9184 m_CombineOr(m_Cmp(), m_CombineOr(m_LogicalAnd(m_Value(), m_Value()),
9185 m_LogicalOr(m_Value(), m_Value()))));
9186 };
9187 if (!IsGoodCond(Cond1) || !IsGoodCond(Cond2))
9188 continue;
9189
9190 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Before branch condition splitting\n"; BB.dump());
9191
9192 // Create a new BB.
9193 auto *TmpBB =
9194 BasicBlock::Create(BB.getContext(), BB.getName() + ".cond.split",
9195 BB.getParent(), BB.getNextNode());
9196 if (IsHugeFunc)
9197 FreshBBs.insert(TmpBB);
9198
9199 // Update original basic block by using the first condition directly by the
9200 // branch instruction and removing the no longer needed and/or instruction.
9201 Br1->setCondition(Cond1);
9202 LogicOp->eraseFromParent();
9203
9204 // Depending on the condition we have to either replace the true or the
9205 // false successor of the original branch instruction.
9206 if (Opc == Instruction::And)
9207 Br1->setSuccessor(0, TmpBB);
9208 else
9209 Br1->setSuccessor(1, TmpBB);
9210
9211 // Fill in the new basic block.
9212 auto *Br2 = IRBuilder<>(TmpBB).CreateCondBr(Cond2, TBB, FBB);
9213 if (auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond2)) {
9214 I->removeFromParent();
9215 I->insertBefore(Br2->getIterator());
9216 }
9217
9218 // Update PHI nodes in both successors. The original BB needs to be
9219 // replaced in one successor's PHI nodes, because the branch comes now from
9220 // the newly generated BB (NewBB). In the other successor we need to add one
9221 // incoming edge to the PHI nodes, because both branch instructions target
9222 // now the same successor. Depending on the original branch condition
9223 // (and/or) we have to swap the successors (TrueDest, FalseDest), so that
9224 // we perform the correct update for the PHI nodes.
9225 // This doesn't change the successor order of the just created branch
9226 // instruction (or any other instruction).
9227 if (Opc == Instruction::Or)
9228 std::swap(TBB, FBB);
9229
9230 // Replace the old BB with the new BB.
9231 TBB->replacePhiUsesWith(&BB, TmpBB);
9232
9233 // Add another incoming edge from the new BB.
9234 for (PHINode &PN : FBB->phis()) {
9235 auto *Val = PN.getIncomingValueForBlock(&BB);
9236 PN.addIncoming(Val, TmpBB);
9237 }
9238
9239 // Update the branch weights (from SelectionDAGBuilder::
9240 // FindMergedConditions).
9241 if (Opc == Instruction::Or) {
9242 // Codegen X | Y as:
9243 // BB1:
9244 // jmp_if_X TBB
9245 // jmp TmpBB
9246 // TmpBB:
9247 // jmp_if_Y TBB
9248 // jmp FBB
9249 //
9250
9251 // We have flexibility in setting Prob for BB1 and Prob for NewBB.
9252 // The requirement is that
9253 // TrueProb for BB1 + (FalseProb for BB1 * TrueProb for TmpBB)
9254 // = TrueProb for original BB.
9255 // Assuming the original weights are A and B, one choice is to set BB1's
9256 // weights to A and A+2B, and set TmpBB's weights to A and 2B. This choice
9257 // assumes that
9258 // TrueProb for BB1 == FalseProb for BB1 * TrueProb for TmpBB.
9259 // Another choice is to assume TrueProb for BB1 equals to TrueProb for
9260 // TmpBB, but the math is more complicated.
9261 uint64_t TrueWeight, FalseWeight;
9262 if (extractBranchWeights(*Br1, TrueWeight, FalseWeight)) {
9263 uint64_t NewTrueWeight = TrueWeight;
9264 uint64_t NewFalseWeight = TrueWeight + 2 * FalseWeight;
9265 scaleWeights(NewTrueWeight, NewFalseWeight);
9266 Br1->setMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_prof,
9267 MDBuilder(Br1->getContext())
9268 .createBranchWeights(TrueWeight, FalseWeight,
9269 hasBranchWeightOrigin(*Br1)));
9270
9271 NewTrueWeight = TrueWeight;
9272 NewFalseWeight = 2 * FalseWeight;
9273 scaleWeights(NewTrueWeight, NewFalseWeight);
9274 Br2->setMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_prof,
9275 MDBuilder(Br2->getContext())
9276 .createBranchWeights(TrueWeight, FalseWeight));
9277 }
9278 } else {
9279 // Codegen X & Y as:
9280 // BB1:
9281 // jmp_if_X TmpBB
9282 // jmp FBB
9283 // TmpBB:
9284 // jmp_if_Y TBB
9285 // jmp FBB
9286 //
9287 // This requires creation of TmpBB after CurBB.
9288
9289 // We have flexibility in setting Prob for BB1 and Prob for TmpBB.
9290 // The requirement is that
9291 // FalseProb for BB1 + (TrueProb for BB1 * FalseProb for TmpBB)
9292 // = FalseProb for original BB.
9293 // Assuming the original weights are A and B, one choice is to set BB1's
9294 // weights to 2A+B and B, and set TmpBB's weights to 2A and B. This choice
9295 // assumes that
9296 // FalseProb for BB1 == TrueProb for BB1 * FalseProb for TmpBB.
9297 uint64_t TrueWeight, FalseWeight;
9298 if (extractBranchWeights(*Br1, TrueWeight, FalseWeight)) {
9299 uint64_t NewTrueWeight = 2 * TrueWeight + FalseWeight;
9300 uint64_t NewFalseWeight = FalseWeight;
9301 scaleWeights(NewTrueWeight, NewFalseWeight);
9302 Br1->setMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_prof,
9303 MDBuilder(Br1->getContext())
9304 .createBranchWeights(TrueWeight, FalseWeight));
9305
9306 NewTrueWeight = 2 * TrueWeight;
9307 NewFalseWeight = FalseWeight;
9308 scaleWeights(NewTrueWeight, NewFalseWeight);
9309 Br2->setMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_prof,
9310 MDBuilder(Br2->getContext())
9311 .createBranchWeights(TrueWeight, FalseWeight));
9312 }
9313 }
9314
9315 ModifiedDT = ModifyDT::ModifyBBDT;
9316 MadeChange = true;
9317
9318 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "After branch condition splitting\n"; BB.dump();
9319 TmpBB->dump());
9320 }
9321 return MadeChange;
9322 }
9323